Advanced Functions and Introductory Calculus
Advanced Functions and Introductory Calculus
AUTHORS
Ronald Dunkley
Enzo Carli
Ronald Scoins
Ruth Malinowski
Dean Murray
Jeffrey Shifrin
Loraine Wilson
ISBN 0-7747-1454-9
HARCOURT MATHEMATICS 12
Advanced Functions and Introductory Calculus
EDITORS
HARCOURT MATHEMATICS 12
Authors
Ronald Dunkley
Enzo Carli
Ronald Scoins
Ruth Malinowski
Dean Murray
Jeffrey Shifrin
Loraine Wilson
Performance Assessment
Consultant
Contributors
Richard Long
Hastings and Prince Edward
District School Board
Ray MacDonald
Bluewater District School Board
Gordon Nicholls
Frank Rachich
Technology Consultant
C. Gary Reid
York Region District School Board
Atul Kotecha
Limestone District School Board
Anita Santin
Dan Schnabel
York Region District School Board
515
C2002-900446-2
Acknowledgements
A special thanks to the reviewers listed below for their helpful observations and recommendations. Feedback from
reviewers has been extremely valuable in creating a text that fulfills the requirements of both teachers and students
in Ontario.
Michael Cafferata
Head of Mathematics
Agincourt Collegiate Institute
Toronto District School Board
Atul Kotecha
Mathematics Teacher
Frontenac Secondary School
Limestone District School Board
David McKay
Mathematics Teacher
Westdale Secondary School
Hamilton-Wentworth District School Board
Ed DAndrea
Head of Mathematics
Father John Redmond Catholic
Secondary School
Toronto Catholic District School Board
Stephanie Leonard
Mathematics Teacher
Napanee District Secondary School
Limestone District School Board
Henry Mengers
Mathematics Teacher
John Diefenbaker Secondary School
Bluewater District School Board
David Nicholson
Mathematics Teacher
St. Marys College
Huron-Superior Catholic District
School Board
Linda Obermeyer
Department Head of Mathematics
Notre Dame Secondary School
Halton Catholic District School Board
Marjorie Tellis
Mathematics Teacher
Norwood District High School
Kawartha Pine Ridge District School Board
Joan Tomiuk
Mathematics Teacher
Glebe Collegiate Institute
Ottawa-Carleton District School Board
Elizabeth Fraser
Mathematics Department Head
Glebe Collegiate Institute
Ottawa-Carleton District School Board
Mike McGibbon
Head of Mathematics
Aurora High School
York Region District School Board
Colleen Morgulis
Curriculum Chair of Mathematics
All Saints Catholic Secondary School
Durham Catholic District School Board
Susan Smith
Mathematics Teacher
Bramalea Secondary School
Peel District School Board
Paul Wren
Mathematics and Computer Teacher
Georgetown District High School
Halton District School Board
Gene Yawny
Chair of Mathematics
St. Theresas High School
Simcoe Muskoka Catholic District
School Board
We gratefully acknowledge the following educators for participating in our mathematics discussion group meetings throughout Ontario.
Jeff Anderson
Head of Mathematics
Forest Heights Collegiate Institute
Waterloo Region District School Board
Lorenzo Ciapanna
Head of Mathematics
St. Jean de Brebeuf Catholic Secondary
School
Hamilton-Wentworth Catholic District
School Board
Ken Billey
Head of Mathematics
Holy Names High School
Windsor-Essex Catholic District
School Board
W.K. Dutton
Mathematics Teacher
Lester B. Pearson High School
Halton District School Board
Chris Brady
Mathematics Teacher
Sherwood Secondary School
Hamilton-Wentworth District School Board
Wendy Fitzsimmons
Mathematics Teacher
Milton District Secondary School
Halton District School Board
continued
iii
Michele Goveia
Head of Mathematics
Father Henry Carr
Toronto Catholic District School Board
Patrick Grew
Head of Mathematics
Frontenac Secondary School
Limestone District School Board
John C. Holden
Math Teacher
Ridgemont High School
Ottawa-Carleton District School Board
Garry Kiziak
Head of Mathematics and Science
Burlington Central High School
Halton District School Board
Mike Lawson
Head of Mathematics
Father Michael Goetz Secondary School
Dufferin-Peel Catholic District
School Board
Frank LoForte
Head of Mathematics
Riverdale Collegiate Institute
Toronto District School Board
Darren Luoma
Mathematics Teacher
Bear Creek Secondary School
Simcoe County District School Board
Cheryl McQueen
Head of Mathematics
Central Elgin Collegiate Institute
Thames Valley District School Board
Mark Pankratz
Math Teacher
Hillcrest High School
Ottawa-Carleton District School Board
John Santarelli
Head of Mathematics
Cathedral High School
Hamilton-Wentworth Catholic District
School Board
Scott Taylor
Head of Mathematics
Bell High School
Ottawa-Carleton District School Board
Peter Wei
Head of Mathematics
North Toronto Collegiate Institute
Toronto District School Board
Laurie A. Zahnow
Head of Mathematics
Silverthorn Collegiate Institute
Toronto District School Board
iv
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
Glenn McDermott
Head of Mathematics
Woodstock Collegiate Institute
Thames Valley District School Board
Chris Monk
Head of Mathematics
Marc Garneau Collegiate
Toronto District School Board
C. Gary Reid
Head of Mathematics
Sutton District High School
York Region District School Board
Dwight Stead
Head of Mathematics
Cardinal Leger Secondary School
Dufferin-Peel Catholic District
School Board
Joan Tomiuk
Mathematics Teacher
Glebe Collegiate Institute
Ottawa-Carleton District School Board
Shelley Wilton
Head of Mathematics
Westminster Secondary School
Thames Valley District School Board
John Yakopich
Head of Mathematics
Sandwich Secondary School
Greater Essex County District
School Board
Bob McRoberts
Head of Mathematics
Dr. G.W. Williams Secondary School
York Region District School Board
Peter OHara
Mathematics Teacher
Glendale High School
Thames Valley District School Board
David Rushby
Head of Mathematics
Martingrove Collegiate Institute
Toronto District School Board
Jenny Stillman
Head of Mathematics
Central Secondary School
Thames Valley District School Board
Jane Uloth
Mathematics Teacher
Lester B. Pearson High School
Halton District School Board
Beryl Wong
Mathematics Teacher
Holy Name of Mary Secondary School
Dufferin-Peel Catholic District
School Board
Contents
A Guided Tour of Your Textbook ix
CHAPTER 1
Polynomial Functions
1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
2.6
31
Introduction to Calculus
71
Derivatives
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
4.6
121
Applications of Derivatives
171
CONTENTS
6.1
6.2
6.3
6.4
6.5
225
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
7.5
257
vii
CHAPTER 8
8.1
8.2
8.3
8.4
8.5
Curve Sketching
9.1
9.2
9.3
9.4
9.5
335
A: Derivatives 388
B: Antiderivatives 406
C: Technical Assistance 424
D: Performance Assessment and
Career Link Letterhead Tasks 448
Glossary 455
Answers 462
Index 481
viii
CONTENTS
CHAPTER OPENER
You will be introduced to each
chapter by reading about some
real-life applications of the
mathematical concepts that will
be presented within the chapter.
A colourful image accompanies this
introduction.
Chapter 6
THE EXPONENTIAL
FUNCTION
Are you thinking of buying a computer? Moores
Law suggests that the processing power of
computers doubles every eighteen months, which
means that in a year and a half from today,
computers will be twice as powerful as they are
now! This is an example of exponential growth. In
this chapter, you will study the exponential
functions that can be used to describe and make
predictions about the growth of biological
populations, including human populations and
populations of cancerous cells, the growth of
financial investments, the growth of the Internet,
and the decaying of radioactive substances.
Another application of exponential functions
occurs in psychology, where it has been noted
that, in certain circumstances, there is an
exponential relationship between the size of a
stimulus and a nerves response to the stimulus.
The common feature in all these situations and
many others is that the amount of growth or
decline at any point in time is directly
proportional to the size of the thing that is
growing or declining.
CHAPTER EXPECTATIONS In this chapter, you will
A G U I D E D TO U R O F YO U R T E X T B O O K
ix
Common Factor
4x2 8x 4x(x 2)
Grouping
By grouping terms together it is often possible to factor the grouped terms.
Factor fully ax cx ay cy (ax cx) (ay cy)
x(a c) y(a c)
(a c)(x y)
Trinomial Factoring
Factor fully 3x2 7x 4.
Solution 1 (by decomposition)
3x2 7x 4 3x2 3x 4x 4
3x(x 1) 4(x 1)
(x 1)(3x 4)
Exercise
1. Factor fully.
a. p2 2pr r2
b. 16n2 8n 1
c. 9u2 30u 25
d. v2 4v 3
e. 2w2 3w 1
f. 3k2 7k 2
g. 7y2 15y 2
h. 5x2 16x 3
i. 3v2 11v 10
a. 25x2 y2
b. m2 p2
c. 1 16r2
d. 49m2 64
e. p2r2 100x2
2. Factor fully.
g. (x
n)2
9
h.
49u2
(x
f. 3 48y2
y)2
i. x4 16
3. Factor fully.
a. kx px ky py
b. fx gy gx fy
c. h3 h2 h 1
d. x d (x d)2
e. 4y2 4yz z2 1
f. x2 y2 z2 2xz
A G U I D E D TO U R O F YO U R T E X T B O O K
20 20 10 10
1 2
2 4
Difference of Squares
2 2
4 20 20 10 10
1 1
Notice that what looks like a lot of work can be greatly simplified when numbers
in the upper right that have common factors with 12, 6, and 4 are crossed out.
From the numbers that remain, we see that 4 (4) 16, and 3 5 15
gives 16 15 1. Therefore, 12x2 x 20 (4x 5)(3x 4).
Special Cases
12
12
4 20
20
LESSONS
Lessons and investigations provide
you with opportunities to explore
concepts independently or working with
others.
EXAMPLE 1
6
x3 2x2
x2 5x
2
x 2x
3x 6
3x 6
0
2 . 1 T H E FA C TO R T H E O R E M
EXERCISES
Exercises follow each lesson, and are
organized by level of difficulty.
Questions allow you to master essential
mathematical skills, communicate about
mathematics, and attempt more
challenging and thought-provoking
problems.
Exercise 2.5
Part A
Knowledge/
Understanding
(ii) f (x) 0
c.
b.
y
y
y = f(x)
x
4
y = f(x)
y = f(x)
x
x
2
01
Part B
2. Solve each of the following, x R.
t chnology
e
b. (x 3)(x 1) 0
c. x2 7x 10 0
d. 2x2 5x 3 0
f. x3 9x 0
g. x3 5x2 x 5
h. 2x3 x2 5x 2 0
i. x3 10x 2 0
j. x2 1 0
3. The viscosity, v, of oil used in cars is related to its temperature, t, by the formula v t 3 9t2 27t 21, where each unit of t is equivalent to 50C.
a. Graph the function of v t3 9t2 27t 21 on your graphing
calculator.
b. Determine the value of t for v 0, correct to two decimal places.
c. Determine the value of t for v 20, correct to two decimal places.
Application
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
a. x(x 2) 0
e. x2 4x 4 0
59
A G U I D E D TO U R O F YO U R T E X T B O O K
xi
CAREER LINK
The Career Link feature at the beginning
of each chapter presents a real-world
scenario and allows students the
opportunity to apply their learning to
real issues.
investigate
C H A P T E R 8 : R AT E - O F - C H A N G E M O D E L S I N M I C R O B I O L O G Y
How would you find the slope of the function
5
2x
6
y
3
using each of the Power, Product, Quotient, and Chain Rules? While this task
would be very difficult using traditional methods of differentiation, it will be painfree when you use the logarithmic and exponential differential calculus methods
of this chapter. In addition to developing ideas and skills, you will also take the
logarithmic and exponential models constructed in Chapters 6 and 7 and utilize
them in rate-of-change applications.
Case Study Microbiologist
Microbiologists contribute their expertise to many fields, including
medicine, environmental science, and biotechnology. Enumerating, the
process of counting bacteria, allows microbiologists to build mathematical
models that predict populations. Once they can predict a population
accurately, the model could be used in
Time
Population
medicine, for example, to predict the dose of
(in hours)
medication required to kill a certain bacterial
0
1000
infection. The data set in the table was used by
a microbiologist to produce a polynomial0.5
1649
based mathematical model to predict
1.0
2718
population p(t), as a function of time t, in
1.5
4482
hours, for the growth of a certain bacteria:
2.0
7389
1 5
t
p(t) 1000 1 t 12 t2 16 t3 21
t4
4
120
DISCUSSION QUESTIONS
1. How well does the equation fit the data set? Use the equation, a graph,
and/or the graphing calculator to comment on the goodness of fit.
2. What is the population after 0.5 h? How fast is the population growing at
this time? (Use calculus to determine this.) Complete these calculations for the
1.0 h point.
3. What pattern did you notice in your calculations? Explain this pattern by
examining the terms of this equation to find the reason why.
The polynomial function in this case is an approximation of the special function
in mathematics, natural science, and economics, f(x) e x, where e has a value
of 2.718 28. At the end of this chapter, you will complete a task on rates of
change of exponential growth in a biotechnology case study.
298 C H A P T E R 8
wrap-up
C H A P T E R 8 : R AT E - O F - C H A N G E M O D E L S I N M I C R O B I O L O G Y
To combat the widespread problem of soil and groundwater contamination,
scientists and engineers have investigated and engineered bacteria capable of
destroying environmental toxicants. The use of bacteria in environmental
clean-ups, known as bioremediation, has been proven effective in destroying
toxic compounds ranging from PCBs to gasoline additives such as benzene. An
environmental engineer conducting a lab study found the growth in mass of a
quantity of bioremediation bacteria follows a logistic growth pattern. The
logistic model is characterized by the familiar S-shaped graph and equation as
follows:
m(t)
mb (t)
Lm
0 Lkt
1
e
m
0
b
DO2 10(mc ) d
[litres per hour]
t
xii
A G U I D E D TO U R O F YO U R T E X T B O O K
329
TECHNOLOGY
Technology features are integrated
throughout in a flexible and optional
manner.
The purpose of this investigation is to determine how the derivative can be used in
determining the maximum (largest) value or the minimum (smallest) value of
a function on a given interval.
1. For each of the following functions, determine, by completing the square, the
value of x that produces a maximum or minimum function value on the given
interval.
a. f(x) x2 6x 3, interval 0 x 5
b. f(x) x2 2x 11, interval 3 x 4
c. f(x) 4x2 12x 7, interval 1 x 4
2. For each function, determine the value of c such that f (c) 0.
3. Compare the values obtained in Questions 1 and 2 for each function.
t chnology
e
APPENDIX P. 444
4. Using your calculator, graph each of the following functions and determine all
values of x that produce a maximum or minimum function value on the given
interval.
a. f(x) x3 3x2 8x 10, interval 2 x 4
t chnology
7. From your conclusions in Questions 3 and 6, state a method for using the
derivative of a function to determine values of the variable that determine
maximum or minimum values of the function.
8. Repeat Question 4 for the following functions, using the indicated intervals.
a. f(x) x2 6x 3, interval 4 x 8
b. f(x) 4x2 12x 7, interval 2 x 6
c. f(x) x3 3x2 9x 10, interval 2 x 6
d. f(x) x3 12x 5, interval 0 x 5.
e. f(x) x3 5x2 3x 7, interval 2 x 5
196 C H A P T E R 5
A G U I D E D TO U R O F YO U R T E X T B O O K
xiii
4 3 2 1
4
3
2
1
3 2 1
4
3
2
1
y = ex
x
1 2 3 4 5
Cubic
x
1 2 3 4 5
y
y = ln x
x
4 3 2 1
y
y=
4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5
4 3 2 1
3
2
1
4
3
2
1
y = x2
4
3
2
1
1
x
x
1 2 3 4 5
y
y=
1 2 3
4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4
1
x2 k
376 C H A P T E R 9
REVIEW EXERCISE
The chapter Review Exercise addresses
and integrates the principles taught
throughout the chapter, allowing
you to practise and reinforce your
understanding of the concepts and skills
you have learned.
Review Exercise
1. a. If f(3) 0, state a factor of f (x).
2. a. Find the family of cubic functions whose x-intercepts are 4, 1, and 2.
b. Find the particular member of the above family whose graph passes
through the point (3, 10).
3. a. Determine if x 2 is a factor of x5 4x3 x2 3.
b. Determine if x 3 is a factor of x3 x2 11x 3.
4. Use the Factor Theorem to factor x3 6x2 6x 5.
5. a. If x 1 is a factor of x3 3x2 4kx 1, what is the value of k?
b. If x 3 is a factor of kx3 4x2 2kx 1, what is the value of k?
6. Factor each of the following:
a. x3 2x2 2x 1
b. x3 6x2 11x 6
c. 8x3 27y3
b. 2x3 x2 13x 5
b. x3 25x 0
c. x3 8 0
d. x3 x2 9x 9 0
e. x4 12x2 64 0
f. x3 4x2 3 0
REVIEW EXERCISE
xiv
A G U I D E D TO U R O F YO U R T E X T B O O K
67
CHAPTER TEST
The Chapter Test allows you to
measure your understanding and
allows you and your teachers to relate
results to the curriculum achievement
charts.
Chapter 2 Test
Achievement Category
Questions
Knowledge/Understanding
1, 2, 3, 4, 7
Thinking/Inquiry/Problem Solving
Communication
Application
5, 9
b. 2x3 7x2 9
c. x4 2x3 2x 1
3. Use your graphing calculator to factor 3x3 4x2 2x 4.
4. Solve for x, x C.
a. 2x3 54 0
b. x3 4x2 6x 3 0
c. 2x3 7x2 3x 0
d. x4 5x2 4 0
5. Find the quadratic equation whose roots are each three greater than the roots
of x2 2x 5 0.
6. The Math Wizard states that the x-intercepts of the graph of
f (x) x3 9x2 26x 24 cannot be positive. Is the Math Wizard correct?
Explain.
7. Solve for x, x R.
a. (x 3)(x 2)2 0
c. 2x 5 9
b. x3 4x 0
CHAPTER 2 TEST
69
C U M U L AT I V E R E V I E W
This feature appears at the end of
chapters 4, 7, and 9.
Concepts covered in the preceding
chapters are further practised
through additional exercises and
word problems.
Cumulative Review
CHAPTERS 57
dy
1. Find d
for the following:
x
b. 4x2 16y2 64
a. x2 y2 324
d. 2x2 xy 2y 5
c. x2 16y2 5x 4y
e. 1x y 1
f. (2x 3y)2 10
b. x3 y3 y 21 at (3, 2)
3x 9
at (1, 2)
d. y2
7x2 4
2
2
b. f (x)
x2
4
c. f (x)
d. f (x) x4 x1 4
d 2y
C U M U L AT I V E R E V I E W C H A P T E R S 5 7
291
A G U I D E D TO U R O F YO U R T E X T B O O K
xv
APPENDICES
The Technical Assistance Appendix teaches
techniques for using the graphing calculator.
The Derivatives Appendix takes concepts
covered in the text and extends and applies
them to the area of trigonometric functions.
DERI
VAT I V
ES OF
TRIGO
Appen
dix A
E
NOM
TRIC
So far in
FUNC
ou
exponenti r study of ca
TION
lcu
S
modelli al, and logarithm lus, we have
wo
ng oscil
rked wi
latory ph ic functions.
the rise
th
po
lynomial
Tr
en
an
igonome
, rational,
will deve d fall of tides, omena and pe
tri
c
fu
nctions
riodic mo
an
lop the
are centr power,
ous prob
derivati d the current
tio
n,
su
al in
in electr
ves of the
ch as pla
lems.
ica
ne
trigono
metric fu l circuits. In thi tary orbits,
s
nctions
and apply appendix, we
Review
them in
variof Basi
c Prop
erties
Radian
Measu
re
A radian
is the me
at the ce
asure of
ntr
to the rad e of a circle by an angle subte
nded
ius
an arc eq
of
the
radian
ual in len
s 180 circle.
gth
The Sine
and Co
sine Fu
Domain
nctions
xR
Range
1 sin
1 co x 1
Periodic
s x 1
ity
sin(x
2
cos(x ) sin x
2
) co
Transfor
sx
mations
of Sine
For y
and Co
a sin k(x
sine Fu
p)
nctions
the ampli
d
an
d
tude is
y a co
a,
s k(x
the perio
p) d,
d is 2
the phas
k ,
e shift is
the verti
p, and
cal trans
lation is
d.
= 1 rad
r
ian
y
1
0
1
y = sin
x
y = cos
x
IX A
Appendix C
T E C H N I C A L A S S I S TA N C E
OVERVIEW
xB
ndi
e
p
Ap
are
they re
how they a g
oin
ons d how
ncti
re g
n
of fu lated, a ix, we a dix, it
s
e
v
n
u
d
ti
e
riva are calc appen is app
is
e de
th
S
E
d th ow they s. In th tle for
ie
V
d
stu on, h
lem ative ti
TI
ti
ave
prob
I VA
we h terpreta pes of an altern
in
ty
text,
ER
the metric ferent to give
S
TID
out
ugh eir geo solve dif e were rds.
IVE
ro
AN
h
w
a
th
AT
T
. If
help
ned,
ackw
RIV
defi edto process ing B
IDE
e
rk
T
li
o
p
th
N
p
W
e
a
A
ed
vers
e
to re be call
ING
quir
4x.
IND
could
we re ves
x2
F
then derivati a3
B1
nd,
v
f (x)
N
is
to fi d for
deri
O
e
I
ying learne and the
CT
vativ
tr
ri
E
2
e
e
re
d
S
e a that w 3 is 3x , 2x2 .
hose
at w
s
x
x.
x3
on w
on th the rule tive of
2 4
)
ncti
ncti
3x
a fu
e fu . Using deriva then F(x
x)
e
Find
,
x
of th
t F (
me x2 4 that th x2 4x
e
a
g
n
3
w
e
to
1
tion F be th (x) we kno x) 3
),
gF
lu
n
(x
le
o
f
ti
(
p
S
m
ntia
)
or F
if F
rds,
e let
Exa
fere
F(x
If w ) f (x) backwa 4x. So
y dif
that
4x.
er b
F (x inking 2(2x)
x2 such
th
answ
3
n
on F
our
and f 2x2 is
f (x) can co
ncti
o
eck
h
fu
e
e
c
e of
v
ti
n
nd a of f.
vativ ? No, w
e ca
fi
ri
e
n
W
d
x
e
4
:
ti
tiv
e ca
n an 3x2 llows: ero, so e that
Note
if w tideriva
2 is a
fo t is z
n
on f,
2x
(x) , as
we sebe
n
ncti is an a
x3 ve of f x, say G consta
fact,
n
a fu
F
4
fa
f. In that ca
(x) vati
For y that
e, F antideri 3x2 vative o tive of
4x
v
sa
o
x2 .
2
b
a
a
we
nly f f (x) e deri tideriv 3x x3 2
ple
o
e
m
th
o
n
a
)
e ex3 2x2 th vative ow that other a of f (x stants to
th
s
ri
A
P
P
E
N
D
I
X
C
n
424
n
C is
From ) x r antide . We kn G is a rivative rent co
(x)
d
(x
e
1
e
at F
Is F t anoth 2x2 f (x), an f antid g) diffe
y th
n
o
c
e sa nt.
stru x3 2 4x umber btracti
w
,
a
))
n
su
)
(x const
ite
(or
G(x ) 3x
)=f
y
ing
infin
F(x C is an
G (x are an by add
(i.e.,
e
there d simply
of f f , wher
tive
f
foun
riva ative o
e
d
anti deriv
is an anti
If F eneral
g
the
406
xvi
APP
END
IX B
A G U I D E D TO U R O F YO U R T E X T B O O K
This appendix provides an overview of the instructions for using a graphing calculator. Use this appendix whenever you are not sure of the next step to take with
your calculator. For more detailed information on using a graphing calculator,
you may wish to refer to a more comprehensive graphing calculator guidebook.
Contents
Instructions for the TI83 Plus Graphing Calculator
Home Screen
Entering an Equation
Changing the Viewing Window
Displaying the Format Settings
Changing the Number of Decimal Places Displayed
Plotting the Function
Free-Moving Cursor
Trace
Zoom
Split Screens
Graphing a Family of Curves
Establishing a Table of Values for a Function
Calculating Roots and Zeroes of a Function
Finding the Intersection of Functions
Exploring Function Transformations
Graphing Functions and Inverses
Graphing Inequalities
Graphing Piecewise Functions and Exploring Continuity
Drawing Line Segments
Drawing Tangents
Using a Table of Values to Explore Limits of Functions
Finding the Numerical Derivative at a Given Point
Calculating Max/Min Values
Instructions for Zap-A-Graph
Technology Extension for Section 8.1
425
425
425
426
427
PER
427
CAR FORMA
427
EER
N
428
LIN CE AS
428
S
K L
Adva
ETT ESSM
429
nced
E
ERH
En
Fu
432
d of
EADNT AN
Chap nctions a
nd
ter Ta
433
This
TA S D
sk Ge Introdu
st
ud
KS
434
ctory
neric
forman ent rubr
C
R
ic
a
ubric
ce re
lculu
m
435 use
s Stu
this ge lated to ay assist yo
dent
Car
435
neral
u
Rubri
iden
rubric eer Link in unders
c
436
tify w
Wraptandin
to
ha
Up ta
g
t to pa
437 outline
sks an general as
y atte
th
d othe
se
ntion
437 help sp e criteria
r mat ssment cr
to;
cl
ot an
hemat
it
438 deve
d solv early;
ics as eria and de
lop m
e wea
signm
440
ore in
knesse
ents. sired leve
Howev
form
ls
You m
s in yo
ative
441
ay wis of perlop m er, it is im
ur ow
feedba
portan
ore sp
n
h to
w
ck
442
or
many
ec
t
k and
abou
decisi ific coachi to note th
t
in
st
re
443
th
minin
ngths
e gene
ons, in
e wor
ng or
and ar
k of ot
444 g levels, de cluding de scoring ric nature
eas th
hers;
criteri
of this
velopi
fi
at
ni
an
ng
ne
a.
d
446
ng de
ed im
Asse
script quality, de Helpful ru rubric. You
provem
ss
447
ors, an
br
te
ca
Cate ment
ent.
gory
d tran rmining cr ics are clea n work w
slatin
ite
Know
g leve ria, weigh r rubrics an ith your te
LEVE
Unde ledge/
achers
L1
ls to m
d
in
rstan
ding
to deve
A ma
arks or g criteria, therefore
the
may
setting
grades
generat matical mo
LE
VEL
a stan involve
.
2
errors ed with sig del is
dard,
nificant
A ma
deter De
thema
App
end
ix D
mons
tical
generat
LEVE
algorithmtrates, throu
ed with model is
L3
Demo
minor
underst ic work, gh
A co
errors
ns
a lim
anding
rre
algorithmtrates, throu
of conc ited
model ct mathema
LEVE
Lim
epts
tic
is gene
underst ic work, gh
L4
ited ma
so
rated al
an
Demo
din
reasonin thematic
g of co me
A co
ns
al
ncepts
rre
g
algorithmtrates, throu
Sequ
model ct mathema
Some
en
conside ic work, gh
verified is generated tical
a
ma
with lim ces and sel
of conc rable unde
reasonin thematic
and
Com
ited eff ects too
rstandin
al
mun
epts
Demo
g
ls
ectiven
icatio
g
Sequ
ns
ess
n
Co
en
algorithmtrates, throu
nside
Expla
with so ces and sel
underst ic work, gh
reasonin rable mathe
na
ec
me eff
a tho
anding
matical
justifica tions and
ectiven ts tools
g
of conc rough
Sequ
ess
detail tions have
Thoro
epts
ences
and lac
limited
ug
an
wi
Explana
d selec
th co
k clarity
Infreq
reasonin h mathema
effectiv nsiderable ts tools
justifica tions and
ue
general g extende tical
eness
mathe ntly uses
d to the
underst tions are pa
case
ma
termino tical sym
Sequ
Expla
detail andable, wi rtially
bo
Appl
en
na
icatio
th some
correctl logy, and co ls,
efficie ces and sel
justifica tions and
n
y
nventio
Uses
ntly an
ec
ns
d effec ts tools
underst tions are cle
mathe
Ap
ma
tively
ter
ar
an
tical
mino
dable
and
plies
Explana
Uses
tions an
correctl logy, and co symbols,
procedu concepts an
jus
ma
tifica
y some
nv
d
termino thematical
setting res in an un d
of the entions
clear an tions are pa
Ap
time
correctl logy, and co symbols,
d thorou rticularly
significa correctly on familiar
plies
448
y most
nv
Co
ghly de
nt assis ly with
procedu concepts an
APPE
nsist
of the entions
tailed
tance
NDIX
time
uses maently and me
setting res in an un d
D
Ind
termino thematical ticulously
assistan correctly wi familiar
epen
th some
ce
correctl logy, and co symbols,
concep dently appli
y
nventio
correctl ts and proce es
ns
du
y
Ind
setting in an unfam res
epen
iliar
concep dently appli
an un ts and proce es
fam
new or iliar settin dures in
g using
modif
ied str
ategie
s
Thinki
Prob ng/Inquiry
lem So
/
lving
Chapter 1
P O LY N O M I A L
FUNCTIONS
Have you ever wondered how computer graphics
software is able to so quickly draw the smooth,
life-like faces that we see in video games and
animated movies? Or how in architectural projects
builders compensate for the fact that a horizontal
beam, fixed in position at both ends, will bend
under its own weight? Can you imagine how
computers mould automotive body panels?
Believe it or not, all three tasks are possible
thanks to polynomials! Polynomials are composed
by applying addition, subtraction, and
multiplication to numbers and variables. The
information needed to perform certain tasks like
the ones listed above is reduced to the
polynomial segments between key points. Much
like words in language, polynomials are the
vocabulary of algebra, and, as such, they are used
in a wide variety of applications by designers,
engineers, and others. Calculus, the study of
motion and rates of change, requires a clear
understanding of polynomials, so well begin our
study there.
CHAPTER EXPECTATIONS In this chapter, you will
Common Factor
4x2 8x 4x(x 2)
Grouping
By grouping terms together it is often possible to factor the grouped terms.
Factor fully ax cx ay cy (ax cx) (ay cy)
x(a c) y(a c)
(a c)(x y)
Trinomial Factoring
Factor fully 3x2 7x 4.
Solution 1 (by decomposition)
3x2 7x 4 3x2 3x 4x 4
3x(x 1) 4(x 1)
(x 1)(3x 4)
20 20 10 10
1 2
2 4
1 1
2 2
4 20 20 10 10
Notice that what looks like a lot of work can be greatly simplified when numbers
in the upper right that have common factors with 12, 6, and 4 are crossed out.
The reduced chart is
CHAPTER 1
12
4 20
20
From the numbers that remain, we see that 4 (4) 16, and 3 5 15
gives 16 15 1. Therefore, 12x2 x 20 (4x 5)(3x 4).
Difference of Squares
Because (a b)(a b) a2 b2, it is always possible to factor the difference
between two perfect squares.
16x2 81 (4x 9)(4x 9)
Special Cases
Sometimes by grouping terms, the difference between squares can be created.
a2 p2 1 2a (a2 2a 1) p2
(a 1)2 p2
[(a 1) p][(a 1) p]
(a 1 p)(a 1 p)
Exercise
1. Factor fully.
a. p2 2pr r2
b. 16n2 8n 1
c. 9u2 30u 25
d. v2 4v 3
e. 2w2 3w 1
f. 3k2 7k 2
g. 7y2 15y 2
h. 5x2 16x 3
i. 3v2 11v 10
a. 25x2 y2
b. m2 p2
c. 1 16r2
d. 49m2 64
e. p2r2 100x2
f. 3 48y2
g. (x n)2 9
h. 49u2 (x y)2
i. x4 16
a. kx px ky py
b. fx gy gx fy
c. h3 h2 h 1
d. x d (x d)2
e. 4y2 4yz z2 1
f. x2 y2 z2 2xz
2. Factor fully.
3. Factor fully.
4. Factor fully.
a. 4x2 2x 6
c. y2 (r n)2
d. 8 24m 80m2
e. 6x2 13x 6
f. y3 y2 5y 5
h. 10x2 38x 20
i. 27x2 48
5. Factor fully.
a. 36(2x y)2 25(u 2y)2
b. g(1 x) gx gx2
c. y5 y4 y3 y2 y 1
d. n4 2n2w2 w4
CHAPTER 1
g. p2 2p 1 y2 2yz z2
h. 9y4 12y2 4
j. x2 2 x12
investigate
C H A P T E R 1 : M O D E L L I N G WAT E R D E M A N D
Imagine if you woke up one morning looking forward to a shower only to have
your mom tell you the local water utility ran out of water because they made a
mistake in predicting demand. That does not happen, in part, because water
utilities develop reliable mathematical models that accurately predict water
demand. Of particular use in mathematical modelling are the polynomial
functions that you will investigate in this chapter. You are already familiar with
two classes of polynomials: the linear (y mx b) and the quadratic (y ax2
bx c). You can find polynomial mathematical models in a multitude of places,
from computers (e.g., Internet encryption), to business (e.g., the mathematics of
investment), to science (e.g., population dynamics of wildlife).
Case Study Municipal Engineer/Technologist
Civil Engineers and Technologists frequently model the relationship
between municipal water demand and time of day to ensure that
water supply meets demand plus a factor of safety for fire flows.
Water demand data for a city with a population of 150 000 is
presented in the table below.
Water
Ontario
WaterDemand
Demand for
for Blueborough,
Blueborough, Ontario
Time of Day
t
(in hours)
Water Demand
(in cubic metres per hour)
13:00
5103
14:00
4968
15:00
5643
16:00
7128
17:00
8775
18:00
9288
19:00
6723
DISCUSSION QUESTIONS
1. Plot a rough sketch of the data in the table above. What kind of relationship,
if any, does the data show? Remember that you have been investigating
linear, quadratic, rational, and periodic functions. Does the hour-to-hour
trend in the data make sense? Explain.
2. Sketch the water demand over a 24-h period for your community. Use an
average daily demand of 600 L per capita and a peak hourly flow of about
2.5 times the average hourly flow. Explain the peaks and valleys.
3. Find out how much water costs in your community and estimate the cost per
hour of operating your communitys water distribution system at the peak
flow rate determined in Question 1.
At the end of this chapter you will develop and utilize a mathematical model for
the data presented in this case study.
CAREER LINK
Graph
Number of x-intercepts
f (x) 2x 1
1
y
f(x)
x
f (x) 2
No x-intercepts
y
f(x)
x
1
x2
Graph
Number of x-intercepts
7x 10
2
y
f(x)
x
chart continued
CHAPTER 1
f (x) x2 6x 9
1
y
f(x)
f (x) 2x2 3x 4
0
f(x)
INVESTIGATION 1:
CUBIC FUNCTIONS
e
t chnology
APPENDIX P. 427
b. y x3 2x
c. y x3 2x2
d. y 2x3 3
e. y 2x3 5x2 8x 12
f. y x3 3x 2
h. y x3 5x2 2x 8
i. y (x 2)(x 1)(3x 1)
2. From your observations, list the possible numbers of real roots for a cubic
equation.
3. a. Explain how you would graph the cubic function y (x 2)(x 3)(x 4)
without using a graphing calculator.
b. Draw a sketch of the function in part a.
1 . 1 G R A P H S O F P O LY N O M I A L F U N C T I O N S
4. Sketch two possible general shapes for the graph of a cubic function that has
a coefficient of x3 that is positive.
5. For the functions in Question 1, change the coefficient of x3 from positive to
negative and redraw the graphs. For example, y x3 2x2 changes to
y x3 2x2. What observation do you make for the general shape of the
graph of a cubic function that has a coefficient of x3 that is negative?
b. y x4 4
c. y x4 3x3
d. y x4 3x3 12x2
e. y x4 3x3 6x2 2x 3
2. From your observations, list the possible numbers of real roots for a quartic
equation.
3. a. Explain how you would graph the quartic function
y (x 3)(x 2)(x 1)(x 4) without using a graphing calculator.
b. Draw a sketch of the function in part a.
4. Sketch two possible general shapes for the graph of a quartic function that has
a coefficient of x4 that is positive.
5. For the functions in Question 1, change the coefficient of x4 from positive to
negative and redraw the graphs. For example, y x4 3x3 changes to
y x4 3x3. What observation do you make for the general shape of the
graph of a quartic function that has a coefficient of x4 that is negative?
INVESTIGATION 3
e
t chnology
c. y (x 2)2(x 2)2
Based on these graphs, draw a sketch of what you think the graph of
y (x 2)(x 1)2 looks like.
CHAPTER 1
b. y x(x 3)3
c. y (x 1)2(x 1)3
Based on these graphs, draw a sketch of what you think the graph of
y (x 1)(x 1)3 looks like.
Exercise 1.1
Part A
Knowledge/
Understanding
t chnology
1. Check your conclusions about the shape of the graphs of functions by using
your graphing calculator to draw each of the following:
a. y x3 12x 16
b. y x3 x2 10x 15
c. y 2x3 11x 6
d. y 2x4 3x3 5
f. y (x 1)(x2 3)(9x2 4)
h. y x5 4x3 x2 3x 3
Part B
Application
Communication
b. y (x 2)(x 1)(x 3)
d. y (x 1)(x 2)2
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
4. You have investigated the general shape of the graphs of cubic and quartic functions. Sketch a possible general shape for the graphs of each of the following:
a. A fifth-degree function that has a coefficient of x5 that is
(i) positive
(ii) negative
(ii) negative
1 . 1 G R A P H S O F P O LY N O M I A L F U N C T I O N S
f(x)
f(x)
211
321
431
m1
m1
m (m 1) 1
m1m1
m1
m1
INVESTIGATION
f(x)
f(x)
first difference
1
2
3
m2
m1
m
m1
m2
*2
10
CHAPTER 1
2f(x)*
second difference
3f(x)
third difference
2. For the function f(x) x3, copy and complete the table below, calculating first
differences, second differences, and so on, to determine whether or not the
sequence of entries becomes constant.
x
f(x)
f(x)
2f(x)*
3f(x)
first difference
second difference
third difference
1
2
3
m2
m1
m
m1
m2
*2
If the set {m 2, m 1, m, m 1, m 2} describes every set of five consecutive x values, can you make a general statement about the pattern of successive
finite differences for polynomial functions?
EXAMPLE
e
t chnology
Given that the points (1,1), (2, 3), (3, 5), (4, 37), (5, 105), and (6, 221) lie on the
graph of a polynomial function, determine a possible expression for the function
having integer coefficients.
Solution
Input the data in your graphing calculator as follows:
1. Select the
STAT
ENTER
STAT
3. Move the cursor to the L3 column. Select 2nd
for the LIST
function. Move the cursor to OPS and then select option 7:List(.
4. Enter L2 in the List (L2) to obtain the first finite differences for L2.
5. Move the cursor to the L4 column. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to obtain the second
finite differences for L3. Note: Enter L3 in the List (L3).
6. Move the cursor to the L5 column. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to obtain the third
finite differences for L3. Note: Enter L4 in the List (L4).
1 . 2 P O LY N O M I A L F U N C T I O N S F R O M D ATA
11
If the first finite difference is constant, then f(x) is a linear function. If the second
finite difference is constant, then f(x) is a quadratic function.
The third finite difference in column L 5 is
constant. If f(x) is a polynomial function,
then it must be cubic, of the form
f(x) ax3 bx2 cx d. Use the CubicReg
function to obtain the following result. The
CubicReg function is located in the CALC
mode on the STAT key.
Note that c 2.4 1011 is a very small
number, so let c 0 and the required result
is f(x) 2x3 6x2 5.
A second method, using algebra, is as follows.
Let the function be f(x).
Using differences, we obtain the following:
f(x)
f(x)
3
2f(x)
3f(x)
4
12
12
24
12
32
36
12
48
37
68
105
116
221
CHAPTER 1
1
2
3
4
24 2b 12
b 6
5
Substituting into
14 18 c 4
5
6
7
8
9
c0
1 260d1
Substituting into
d5
Therefore, the function is f(x) 2x3 6x2 5.
Exercise 1.2
Part A
e
t chnology
Knowledge/
Understanding
In each of the following, you are given a set of points that lie on the graph of a
function. Determine, if possible, the equation of the polynomial function using
a graphing calculator or the algebraic method.
1. (1, 0), (2, 2), (3, 2), (4, 0), (5, 4), (6, 10)
2. (1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 5), (4, 8), (5, 11), (6, 14)
3. (1, 4), (2, 15), (3, 30), (4, 49), (5, 72), (6, 99)
4. (1, 9), (2, 10), (3, 7), (4, 0), (5, 11), (6, 26)
5. (1, 12), (2, 10), (3, 18), (4, 0), (5, 56), (6, 162)
6. (1, 34), (2, 42), (3, 38), (4, 16), (5, 30), (6, 106)
7. (1, 10), (2, 0), (3, 0), (4, 16), (5, 54), (6, 120), (7, 220)
8. (1, 4), (2, 0), (3, 30), (4, 98), (5, 216), (6, 396)
9. (1, 2), (2, 4), (3, 6), (4, 8), (5, 14), (6, 108), (7, 346)
10. (1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 4), (4, 8), (5, 16), (6, 32), (7, 64)
1 . 2 P O LY N O M I A L F U N C T I O N S F R O M D ATA
13
Part B
Application
t chnology
11. The volume, V, of air in the lungs during a 5 s respiratory cycle is given
by a cubic function (with time t as the independent variable).
a. The following data was recorded:
t (in seconds)
V (in litres)
0.2877
0.6554
0.8787
0.7332
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
Population
1981
4031
1982
4008
1983
3937
1984
3824
1985
3675
1986
3496
b. The town seemed destined to become a ghost town until oil was
discovered there and the population started to increase. In what year did
this happen?
c. If the function continues to describe the population correctly, what will the
population be in 2030?
14
CHAPTER 1
EXAMPLE 1
Divide 579 by 8.
Solution
72
8579
56
19
16
3
We can state the results in the form of the division statement 579 8 72 3.
Division with polynomials follows the same procedure. When you are performing
division, you should write both the divisor and dividend in descending powers of
the variable.
EXAMPLE 2
Divide x2 7x 10 by x 2.
Solution
x9
x2
x2
x
7
0
1
x2 2x
9x 10
9x 18
8
Perform the following divisions and express the answers in the form
f(x) d(x)q(x) r(x).
a. (2x3 3x2 4x 3) (x 3)
b. (x3 x2 4) (x 2)
1 . 3 D I V I S I O N O F P O LY N O M I A L S
15
Solution
a.
2x2 3x 5
3
x 3 2
x
x
32
x
4
3
3
2x 6x2
3x2 4x
3x2 9x
5x 3
5x 15
12
Perform the following division and express the answer in the form
f(x) d(x)q(x) r(x).
(3x 4 2x3 4x2 7x 4) (x2 3x 1).
Solution
3x2 7x 22
x2 3x 1 3
x4
x
234
x2
x
7
4
4
3
2
3x 9x 3x
7x3 x2 7x
7x3 21x2 7x
22x2 14x 4
22x2 66x 22
52x 18
Since the remainder, r(x) 52x 18, is of a lower degree than the divisor,
x2 3x 1, the division is complete.
3x 4 2x3 4x2 7x 4 (x2 3x 1)(3x2 7x 22) (52x 18)
EXAMPLE 5
16
CHAPTER 1
b. x 23
Solution
a.
3x2 x 23
3x 2 9
x3
x
32
x
4
2
9x3 6x2
3x2 4x
3x2 2x
2x 2
2x 43
9x2 3x 2
b.
x 23 9
x3
x
32
x
4
2
9x3 6x2
3x2 4x
3x2 2x
2x 2
2x 43
2
3
2
3
The remainders are equal. Is this always true if a function is divided by px t and
by x pt? Suppose that f(x) divided by d(x) px t produces quotient q(x) and
remainder r(x). We can write f(x) (px t)q(x) r(x).
Now f(x) (px t)q(x) r(x)
px ptq (x) r(x)
x pt[p q (x)] r(x).
From this it is clear that division by x pt produces a quotient greater by
a factor p than that of division by (px t), but the remainders are the same.
Exercise 1.3
Part A
1. Perform each of the following divisions and express the result in the form
dividend divisor quotient remainder.
a. 17 5
d. 90 6
Communication
b. 42 7
e. 103 10
c. 73 12
f. 75 15
1 . 3 D I V I S I O N O F P O LY N O M I A L S
17
Communication
Knowledge/
Understanding
Application
Communication
Knowledge/
Understanding
a. (x3 3x2 x 2) (x 2)
b. (x3 4x2 3x 2) (x 1)
d. (3x3 x2 x 6) (x 1)
e. (3x2 4) (x 4)
f. (x3 2x 4) (x 2)
d. (x5 1) (x 1)
18
CHAPTER 1
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
16. If x and y are natural numbers and y x, then whole numbers q and r must
exist such that x yq r.
a. What is the value of r if y is a factor of x?
b. If y is not a factor of x, what are the possible values of r
if y 5, y 7, or y n?
17. a. Divide f(x) x3 4x2 5x 9 by x 2 and write your answer in the
form f(x) (x 2)q (x) r1. Now divide q(x) by x 1 and write your
answer in the form q (x) (x 1)Q(x) r2.
b. If f (x) is divided by (x 2)(x 1) x2 x 2, is Q(x) in part a the
quotient obtained? Justify your answer.
c. When f(x) is divided by (x 2)(x 1), can the remainder be expressed in
terms of r1 and r2?
1 . 3 D I V I S I O N O F P O LY N O M I A L S
19
INVESTIGATION
20
CHAPTER 1
EXAMPLE 1
Show that for the function f(x) x3 x2 4x 2, the value of f(2) is equal to
the remainder obtained when f(x) is divided by (x 2).
Solution
f(2) (2)3 (2)2 4(2) 2
8 4 8 2
6
x2
x2 3x 2
3
2 x
x
x
4
2
x3 2x2
3x2 4x
3x2 6x
2x 2
2x 4
6
21
EXAMPLE 2
b. x 1
Solution
Let f(x) x3 4x2 5x 1; therefore,
a. when f(x) is divided by x 2, the remainder is f(2).
r f(2)
(2)3 4(2)2 5(2) 1
1
b. when f(x) is divided by x 1, the remainder is f(1).
r f(1)
( 1)3 4(1)2 5(1) 1
11
What do we do if the divisor is not of the form (x p), but of the form (kx p)?
We have already seen that the remainder in dividing by (kx p) is the same as in
dividing by x pk, so there is no difficulty. In this case, r f pk.
EXAMPLE 3
78.
EXAMPLE 4
22
CHAPTER 1
We have noted that the remainder is always of a degree lower than that of the
divisor. In the examples so far, the divisor was a linear function, so the remainder
had to be a constant. In the next example, the divisor is a quadratic expression, so
the remainder can be a linear expression.
EXAMPLE 5
23
Exercise 1.4
Part A
Communication
b. x 1
2 c.
x1
d. 2x 3
b. (x3 x2 x 2) (x 1)
c. (2x3 4x 1) (x 2)
d. (3x4 2) (x 1)
e. (x4 x2 5) (x 2)
f. (2x4 3x2 x 2) (x 2)
Part B
Knowledge/
Understanding
Application
b. (x4 x3 x2 3x 4) (x 3)
c. (x3 3x2 7) (x 2)
d. (x5 1) (x 1)
g. (x3 3x2 x 2) (x 3)
h. (3x5 5x2 4x 1) (x 1)
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
24
CHAPTER 1
Part C
8. Determine the remainder when (x3 3x2 x 2) is divided by (x 3)(x 5).
9. Determine the remainder when (3x5 5x2 4x 1) is divided by
(x 1)(x 2).
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
10. When x 2 is divided into f(x), the remainder is 3. Determine the remainder
when x 2 is divided into each of the following:
a. f(x) 1
b. f(x) x 2
c. f(x) (4x 7)
d. 2f(x) 7
e. [f(x)]2
11. If f(x) (x 5)q (x) (x 3), what is the first multiple of (x 5) greater
than f(x)?
12. The expression x4 x2 1 cannot be factored using known techniques.
However, by adding and subtracting x2, we obtain x4 2x2 1 x2.
Therefore, x4 2x2 1 x2 (x2 1)2 x2
(x2 x 1)(x2 x 1).
Use this approach to factor each of the following:
a. x4 5x2 9
b. 9y4 8y2 4
c. x4 6x2 25
d. 4x4 8x2 9
25
Factoring Types
You should be able to identify and simplify expressions of the following types:
common
trinomial
grouping
difference of squares
Division of Polynomials
Remainder Theorem
If f(x) is divided by (x a), giving a quotient q(x) and a remainder r, then r
f(a).
26
CHAPTER 1
wrap-up
C H A P T E R 1 : M O D E L S F O R WAT E R F L O W R AT E S
1. Using the data presented in the Career Link, develop and utilize a
polynomial mathematical model of the flow-rate and time relationship
[Q f(t)] by
a. determining the degree of the polynomial, then using the graphing
calculator to obtain an algebraic model for Q f(t) with the appropriate
polynomial regression function.
b. using the graphing calculator to determine the peak flow. When does this
occur? Is this a reasonable time for a peak daily flow? Explain.
c. determining an algebraic model for the velocity [V(t)] of the water in the
pipe (metres per hour) leaving the water plant if the cross-sectional area
[A(t)] of the pipe changes over time with the relationship:
A(t) 0.1t 0.4
where A(t) is cross-sectional area in square metres, t is time in hours,
and Q(t) A(t) V(t).
d. verifying that your model in part c is correct using the graphing calculator.
Explain how you did this.
2. Water travelling at high velocities can cause damage due to excessive
forces at bends (elbows) in pipe networks. If the maximum allowable
velocity in this specific pipe is 2.5 m/s, will the pipe be damaged at the
peak flow rate?
27
Review Exercise
1. Draw a sketch of each of the following without using your graphing calculator.
a. y (x 2)(x 3)
b. y (x 3)2 1
c. y x(x 1)(x 3)
d. y (x 2)(x 4)(x 2)
e. y (x 2)3
g. y (x 2)2 (x 4)
h. y (x 2)2(x 1)2
i. y x2(x 3)(x 2)
k. y (x 2)3(x 3)
l. y x(x 2)(x 3)
2. In each of the following, you are given a set of points that lie on the graph of
a polynomial function. If possible, determine the equation of the function.
a. (1, 27), (0, 11), (1, 5), (2, 3), (3, 1), (4, 13)
b. (0, 4), (1, 15), (2, 32), (3, 67), (4, 132), (5, 239)
c. (1, 9), (2, 31), (3, 31), (4, 51), (5, 299), (6, 821)
d. (1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 5), (4, 16)
e. (2, 75), (1, 11), (0, 21), (1, 27), (2, 53)
3. Perform the following divisions:
a. (x3 2x2 3x 1) (x 3)
b. (2x3 5x 4) (x 2)
28
CHAPTER 1
5. Divide each polynomial by the factor given, then express each polynomial in
factored form.
a. x3 2x2 x 2, given x 1 is a factor.
b. x3 3x2 x 3, given x 3 is a factor.
c. 6x3 31x2 25x 12, given 2x 3 is a factor.
6. a. When x3 3kx2 x 5 is divided by x 2, the remainder is 9.
Find the value of k.
b. When rx3 gx2 4x 1 is divided by x 1, the remainder is 12. When
it is divided by x 3, the remainder is 20. Find the values of r and g.
REVIEW EXERCISE
29
Chapter 1 Test
Achievement Category
Questions
Knowledge/Understanding
1, 3, 5, 7b
Thinking/Inquiry/Problem Solving
Communication
Application
2, 6, 7a, 9
b. pm3 m2 pm 1
c. 12x2 26x 12
d. x2 6y y2 9
b. y x2(x 2)
CHAPTER 1
Chapter 2
P O LY N O M I A L E Q U AT I O N S A N D I N E Q U A L I T I E S
2x 3 6x 13
2x6x 3 13
4x 16
4x 16
x 4.
12x2 7x 10 0
(3x 2)(4x 5) 0
3x 2 0 or 4x 5 0
x 23 or x 54
For 6x2 x 2 0, a 6,
b 1, c 2.
1
1 4(6)(2)
x
12
17
12
x 23 or x 12
For 6x2 2x 3 0, a 6,
b 2, c 3.
2
4 4(6)(3)
x
12
2 76
12
2 219
12
1 19
6
x 0.6 or 0.9
32
CHAPTER 2
Exercise
1. Solve.
a. 3x 1 x 5
b. 3(x 2) 7 3(x 7)
c. 7x 2(x 3) 9x 5
d. (x 3)(x 2) x2 5x
b. 5x 4 7x 8
c. 4x 5 2(x 7)
d. 4x 7 9x 17
b. f (2)
c. f (3)
d. f 12
b. f (2)
c. f (3)
d. f 12
b. y2 3y 2
c. 3x2 10x 7
d. 3x3 75x
e. 6x2 7x 3
f. x3 x2 56x
g. 4x2 20x
h. 3x3 12x
i. 6x2 14x 12
a. x(x 4) 0
b. (x 3)(x 2) 0
c. x2 5x 6 0
d. y2 9y 18 0
e. x2 2x 15 0
f. 7x2 3x 4 0
g. 3x2 10x 7 0
h. x3 9x 0
i. 3x2 13x 4 0
6. Solve.
b. 3y2 5y 4 0
c. 3x2 x 3 0
d. x2 5x 4 0
e. 2x2 3 5x
f. 6y2 5y 6
g. 2p2 3p 5 0
h. x2 5x 6 0
33
investigate
C H A P T E R 2 : R E S E A R C H I N G D O S E R E S P O N S E R E L AT I O N S H I P S
In response to the health concerns of Canadas aging population, the
pharmaceutical industry has dramatically increased its investment in research over
the past ten years. A key component of the research process is the generation of
mathematical models that predict dose-response relationships. Dose refers to
the quantity of medication administered to a patient, and response refers to the
effect on the patient. For example, the dose-response relationship for asthma
medication may be in terms of the mass of drug administered versus the
percentage increase in lung capacity. Polynomial equations are often used to
model the dose-response relationship because they can be fit to a data set that
changes slope a number of times and may cross the x-axis multiple times (i.e., it
may feature multiple roots). In this chapter, you will develop the algebraic tools to
solve polynomial equations and inequalities, then you will investigate the
properties of polynomial roots and the absolute-value function.
Case Study Pharmaceutical Researcher
Pharmaceutical companies are, of course, also interested
in modelling the side-effect responses of medication. For
example, the equation
9 2
R(t) 5t4 4t3 14
t 32t
can be used to model the side-effect response [R(t)] in
degrees Celsius above or below the normal body
temperature (36.9C) of an experimental drug t hours
after it was administered. The equation is valid for
0 t 2.2 hours. Due to the stress of temperature
change on the body, a second drug is administered at the
moment the patients temperature starts to exceed 36.9C.
DISCUSSION QUESTIONS
1. Within the context of the problem, what happens when R(t) crosses the t-axis?
2. Using your prior knowledge of linear and quadratic functions and your work
in Chapter 1, predict how many times the second drug will have to be
administered. (Hint: Think about the degree of the function.) Explain using a
rough sketch. Do not make a table of values or plot the graph.
3. Once again using your prior knowledge of linear and quadratic functions and
your work in Chapter 1, predict how many times the patients temperature
can spike (i.e., reach a maximum or minimum). Explain using a rough
sketch.
At the end of this chapter you will apply the tools of solving polynomial
equations and inequalities in assessing the performance of the experimental drug
introduced above.
34
CHAPTER 2
EXAMPLE 1
x2 x 3
3
2x
x
32
x
5
6
x3 2x2
x2 5x
x2 2x
3x 6
3x 6
0
2 . 1 T H E FA C TO R T H E O R E M
35
Since the remainder is zero, x 2 is a factor of x3 3x2 5x 6. Both solutions verify that x 2 is a factor. Note that Solution 2 tells us that the second
factor is x2 x 3.
EXAMPLE 2
EXAMPLE 3
36
CHAPTER 2
t chnology
EXAMPLE 5
2 . 1 T H E FA C TO R T H E O R E M
37
t chnology
Solution
Possible values of p such that f(p) 0 are 1, 2, 3, 4, 6, and 12. From
the graph, values to check are p 6, p 1, and p 1. Note that the fourth
x-intercept is between 2 and 3 and is not an integer. Graph y f (x) and use
the 1:value mode under the CALCULATE menu or substitute to evaluate f (6), f (1),
and f(1).
f(6) 64 3(6)3 13(6)2 3(6) 12
210
f(1) 1 3 13 3 12
0
f(1) 1 3 13 3 12
0
Therefore x 1 and x 1 are factors of f (x).
To determine the other factor(s), use the method
of comparing coefficients.
x4 3x3 13x2 3x 12 (x 1)(x 1)(x2 kx 12)
(x2 1)(x2 kx 12)
x4 kx3 12x2 x2 kx 12
x4 kx3 11x2 kx 12
Since kx3 3x3, k 3.
Now x4 3x3 13x2 3x 12 (x2 1)(x2 3x 12).
All examples considered here involve monic polynomials. A monic polynomial
has one as the coefficient of its highest degree term. In the next section, we will
consider the use of the Factor Theorem with polynomials having first-term coefficients other than one.
EXAMPLE 6
Factor x3 y3.
Solution
Consider this as a function of x. That is, f(x) x3 y3.
Since f(y) y3y3
0,
then, by the Factor Theorem, (x y) is a factor of x3 y3. Divide to obtain the
other factor(s).
x2 xy y2
3
2
2
x yx
x
0y
xy
0
y3
3
2
x xy
x2y 0xy2
x2y xy2
xy2 y3
xy2 y3
0
3
3
Therefore x y (x y)(x2 xy y2).
38
CHAPTER 2
EXAMPLE 7
Exercise 2.1
Part A
1. If (x 8) is a factor of f(x), then what is the value of f(8)?
Communication
b. x 2; f(x) x2 8x 6
c. x 2; f(x) x3 3x2 4x 12
d. x 3; f(x) x3 6x2 2x 3
e. x 1; f(x) x3 5x2 4x 3
39
Part B
Knowledge/
Understanding
5. If f(x) x3 2x2 2x 3,
a. show that f (3) 0.
b. what is a linear factor of f (x)?
c. find the quadratic factor by long division.
6. If g(x) x3 2x2 5x 6,
a. show that g(2) 0.
b. what is a linear factor of g(x)?
c. find the quadratic factor by the method of comparing coefficients.
Application
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
b. x3 2x2 x 2
c. y3 19y2 19y 1
d. x3 2x2 5x 4
e. y3 y2 y 2
f. x3 9x2 22x 8
h. x4 6x3 15x2 6x 16
Knowledge/
Understanding
10. Using the formulas for factoring the sum or difference of cubes, factor each of
the following:
a. x3 27
b. y3 8
c. 125u3 64r3
d. 2000w3 2y3
e. (x y)3 u3z3
Part C
11. Use the Factor Theorem to prove that x3 6x2 3x 10 is divisible by
x2 x 2.
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
40
CHAPTER 2
2 . 1 T H E FA C TO R T H E O R E M
41
EXAMPLE 1
t chnology
APPENDIX P. 428
we can use is 3 (because 3 and 1 are the only divisors of the coefficient of x3).
Of these, only 13 is a possible value for k, because the numerator must
be a divisor of 7. Since f 13 0, 3x 1 is a factor. By long division, or the
42
CHAPTER 2
EXAMPLE 2
t chnology
EXAMPLE 3
t chnology
Exercise 2.2
Part A
Communication
1. For each of the following, explain how you could find the values pq of x that
potentially could make the polynomial have a value of zero. State all the
possible values of pq.
a. 2x2 9x 5
b. 3x3 4x2 7x 8
e. 6x3 7x2 4x 3
f. 2x3 8x2 5x 6
2 . 2 T H E FA C TO R T H E O R E M E X T E N D E D
43
Part B
Application
2. A cubic function f (x) with integral coefficients has the following properties:
f 32 0, (x 2) is a factor of f (x), and f (4) 50. Determine f (x).
3. A cubic function g(x) with integral coefficients has the following properties:
g(3) 0, g34 0, (x 2) is a factor of g(x), g(1) 84.
Determine g(x).
Knowledge/
Understanding
d. 6x3 x2 46x 15
e. 5x4 x3 22x2 4x 8
f. 18x3 15x2 x 2
g. 3x4 5x3 x2 4x 4
Part C
5. Factor fully the following expressions:
a. px3 (p q)x2 (2p q)x 2q
b. abx3 (a 2b ab)x2 (2b a 2)x 2
44
CHAPTER 2
There are formulas for solving a general cubic equation and a general quartic
equation, but they are quite complicated. The following examples demonstrate
strategies that you can use in solving cubic, quartic, and other higher-order equations. Any equation of the form f(x) 0 can be solved if f(x) can be expressed as
a combination of linear and quadratic factors. The first strategy, then, is to factor
f(x). It may be possible to factor f(x) by familiar methods, such as grouping terms.
If not, we can employ the Factor Theorem.
We will assume that unless otherwise stated, we are to solve all equations using
the set of complex numbers, C, as the domain.
In general, if the domain is C, a polynomial equation of degree n has n roots.
EXAMPLE 1
t chnology
Solve x3 x2 9x 9 0.
Solution
The pattern of coefficients (1, 1, 9, 9)
suggests grouping the terms.
x3 x2 9x 9 0
x2(x 1) 9(x 1) 0
(x 1)(x2 9) 0
(x 1)(x 3)(x 3) 0
Then x1 0 or x 3 0 or x 3 0
so x 1 or x 3 or x 3.
Note that 1, 3, and 3 are the x-intercepts of the graph of the corresponding cubic
function y x3 x2 9x 9.
EXAMPLE 2
Solve x3 4x 5 0.
Solution
Since there is no obvious way of grouping, the Factor Theorem is employed.
The factors of 5 are 1, and 5.
If
f(x) x3 4x 5,
then f(1) 1 4 5 0,
therefore (x 1) is a factor.
2 . 3 S O LV I N G P O LY N O M I A L E Q UAT I O N S
45
There are two methods we can use for finding the second factor:
Comparing Coefficients
x3 4x 5 (x 1)(x2 kx 5)
x3 kx2 5x x2 kx 5
x3 x2(k 1) x(5 k) 5
Therefore k 1 0 or 5 k 4
k1
k1
x2 x 5 = 0.
x2 x 5 = 0.
Then x3 4x 5 (x 1)(x2 x 5)
The equation x3 4x 5 0
becomes (x 1)(x2 x 5) 0
Then x 1 0 or x2 x 5 0
1 20
1
x 1 or x
2
1 19
i
2
EXAMPLE 3
t chnology
8x 5) 0
(x
x 1 or x2 8x 5 0
44
x 8
2
1)(x2
8 211
2
4
11
The solutions are x 1, x 4 11
.
46
CHAPTER 2
x
x2 8x 5
3
1x
x
92
3
1x
5
x3 x2
8x2 13x
8x2 8x
5x 5
5x 5
0
EXAMPLE 4
t chnology
Checking our list of values for p, we see that the only possible values are 13, 12,
and 2.
Checking, we find that f 13 f 12 f(2) 0.
Therefore f(x) (3x 1)(2x 1)(x 2) and the roots of f (x) 0 are 13, 12,
and 2.
EXAMPLE 5
a. Find the family of cubic functions whose x-intercepts are 2, 1, and 3.
b. Find the particular member of the above family whose graph passes through
the point (2, 20).
Solution
a. Since 2, 1, and 3 are x-intercepts, (x 2), (x 1), and (x 3) must be
factors of the cubic function. Therefore, y k(x 2)(x 1)(x 3), where k is
a constant, represents the family of cubic functions.
b. If (2, 20) lies on the graph of one member of the above family, then (2, 20)
must satisfy its equation. Substituting, we get 20 k(4)(1)(1) or k 5.
Therefore, the particular cubic function is y 5(x 2)(x 1)(x 3).
We frequently encounter equations that cannot be factored. In such situations, the
best we can hope for is to determine approximate values for the roots using a
graphing calculator. The following example illustrates this application.
EXAMPLE 6
Solve x3 5x2 11 0.
Solution
Can the expression be factored?
2 . 3 S O LV I N G P O LY N O M I A L E Q UAT I O N S
47
The only factors of 11 are 1 and 11, and none is a root of the equation.
t chnology
Using a graphing calculator, graph f(x) x3 5x2 11. Using the ZDecimal
instruction in the ZOOM mode, note from the graph that there is a root slightly
to the left of 1.
CALC
The roots of the equation are 1.3, 1.9, and 4.4, to one decimal place. Note that
this procedure will find approximate real roots but will not find the non-real roots
(if there are any) of a polynomial equation.
EXAMPLE 7
Solve: x4 24x2 25 0.
Solution
(x2 25)(x2 1) 0
x2 25 or x2 1
Then x 5 or x i.
Sometimes making a substitution assists in the solving of higher-order equations.
In Example 7, you could let y x2 to get the equation y2 24y 25. Solve for y
and then solve for x. In the next example, the substitution is more subtle.
48
CHAPTER 2
EXAMPLE 8
Exercise 2.3
Part A
Communication
1. For the function f (x) x3 5x2 2x 8, explain how you determine which
integral values of x you would use to make f (x) 0.
2. Write a monic polynomial equation with roots 1, 2, and 4.
3. a. Find the family of cubic functions whose x-intercepts are 3, 0, and 2.
b. Find the particular member of the above family whose graph passes
through the point (1, 12).
4. a. Find the family of cubic functions whose x-intercepts are 2, 1, and 1.
b. Find the particular member of the above family whose graph passes
through the point (2, 6).
5. a. Find the family of quartic functions whose x-intercepts are 2, 1, 1,
and 3.
b. Find the particular member of the above family whose graph passes
through the point (2, 6).
6. Write a polynomial equation with integer coefficients that has the roots 1, 2,
and 35.
2 . 3 S O LV I N G P O LY N O M I A L E Q UAT I O N S
49
b. x2 2x 10 0
c. x(x 2)(x 5) 0
d. x (x2 4) 0
e. x3 x
f. x4 1 0
g. x3 3x2 4x 0
h. 8x3 27 0
i. x3 3x2 4x 12 0
j. x3 9x2 26x 24
k. x3 3x 2 0
l. x3 2x2 15x 36 0
m. x3 8x 10 7x2
n. x3 3x2 16 6x
e. x4 13x2 36 0
f. x4 7 6x2
g. 5(x 1)3 5
h. (x 1)(x 5)(x 3) 3
b. x6 7x3 8 0
2
7
d. x 1x 71
x 1x 10 0
2
e. (3x 5)(3x 1)2(3x 7) 68 0
11. A steel cube is uniformly coated with ice. The volume of ice is given by y
8x3 36x2 54x cm3, where x is the thickness of ice. Find the thickness of
the ice when its volume is 2170 cm3.
12. Find the approximate roots of the following equations, correct to three
decimal places, using a graphing calculator.
Application
50
CHAPTER 2
a. x2 7x 1 0
b. x3 2x2 8x 13 0
c. 2x3 6x2 4 0
d. 3x4 20x2 23 0
13. The height, length, and width of a small box are consecutive integers with the
height being the smallest of the three dimensions. If the length and width are
increased by 1 cm each and the height is doubled, then the volume is increased
by 120 cm3. Find the dimensions of the original small box.
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
14. A silo has a cylindrical main section and a hemispherical roof. If the height of
the main section is 10 m, what should the radius be in order that the volume
of the silo (including the part inside the roof section) is 2000 m3? (You will
need to use your graphing calculator to find the approximate answer correct to
two decimal places.)
Part C
15. We start observing a rocket at time t 0, when it has a velocity of 4 km/s
(and its displacement is considered to be zero). Its acceleration is 2 km/s2, and
this acceleration is increasing at a rate of 0.6 km/s2. The displacement of the
rocket at time t (t 0) is represented by s 0.1t3 t2 4t. At what time
has the rocket travelled 25 km?
2 . 3 S O LV I N G P O LY N O M I A L E Q UAT I O N S
51
INVESTIGATION
For each equation, complete the table, then answer the questions below.
Equation
5x 6 0
5
x2 3x 28 0
28
3x2 19x 6 0
19
x2
4x 1 0
4
2x2 17x 2 0
17
x20
x2
5x2
Roots
Sum of Roots
Product of Roots
1. State a relationship between the sum of the roots of a quadratic equation and
the coefficients of the equation.
2. State a relationship between the product of the roots of a quadratic equation
and the coefficients of the equation.
The results you have noted are easy to prove in general. The quadratic equation
b
b2 4ac
b
b24ac
and x2
.
ax2 bx c 0 has roots x1
2a
2a
52
CHAPTER 2
b
b
b2 4ac
b2 4ac
x1 x2
2a
2a
2b
b2 4ac
b2 4ac
2a
ba
b
b 4ac
b
b 4ac
and x1x2
2a
2a
2
b (b 4ac)
4a2
2
4ac
4a2
ac
Also, if x1 and x2 are the roots of ax2 bx c 0, then this equation can be
written as (x x1)(x x2) 0, which, when simplified, becomes
x2 (x1 x2)x x1x2 0. However, ax2 bx c 0 can also be written as
x2 bax ac 0.
Then x2 (x1 x2)x x1x2 x2 bax ac, and we can conclude that
(x1 x2) ba or (x1 x2)ba and x1x2 ac.
The sum of the roots of ax2 bx c 0 is ba.
The product of the roots of ax2 bx c 0 is ac and
any quadratic equation can be written as
x2 (sum of the roots)x (product of the roots) 0.
EXAMPLE 1
EXAMPLE 2
53
EXAMPLE 3
so h 6,
and the sum of the roots is 6 4 ba k.
Therefore, k 2.
EXAMPLE 4
Find the equation whose roots are each three more than the roots of
x2 7x 2 0.
Solution
Let x1 and x2 represent the roots of the given equation.
Then x1 x2 7 and x1x2 2.
The roots of the required equation will be (x1 3) and (x2 3).
For the new equation, the sum of the roots is (x1 3) (x2 3) (x1 x2) 6
7 6
1
and the product of the roots is (x1 3)(x2 3) x1x2 3x1 3x2 9
x1x2 3(x1 x2) 9
2 3(7) 9
10.
Therefore, the required equation is x2 (1)x (10) 0 or x2 x 10 0.
EXAMPLE 5
Find the equation whose roots are the squares of the roots of 3x2 9x 4 0.
Solution
Let x1 and x2 represent the roots of the given equation.
Then x1 x2 3 and x1x2 43.
The roots of the required equation are x12 and x22.
The sum of these roots is (x12 x22) (x12 2x1x2 x22) 2x1x2
(x1 x2)2 2x1x2
(3)2 243
54
CHAPTER 2
9 83
139
43
196.
The required equation is x2 139x 196 0 or 9x2 57x 16 0.
Exercise 2.4
Part A
Knowledge/
Understanding
Application
1. State the sum and product of the roots of the following equations:
a. x2 5x 11 0
b. 2x2 5x 9 0
2. Find a quadratic equation (with integral coefficients) whose roots have the
given sum and product.
a. sum is 3; product is 7
3
d. sum is 11
; product is 14
2
Communication
c. 3x2 7x 8 0
3. Find a quadratic equation (with integral coefficients) having the given roots:
c. 3, 13
a. 3, 7
b. 5, 8
e. 45, 23
5
f. 2i, 2i
d. 12, 34
2 . 4 P R O P E RT I E S O F T H E R O OT S O F Q UA D R AT I C E Q UAT I O N S
55
Application
8. Find the equation whose roots are each three times the roots of
3x2 7x 3 0.
9. Find the equation whose roots are the squares of the roots of
4x2 9x 2 0.
10. Find the equation whose roots are the reciprocals of the roots of
5x2 10x 1 0.
11. Find the equation whose roots are the squares of the reciprocals of the roots
of x2 6x 2 0.
12. Find the equation whose roots are the cubes of the roots of 2x2 4x 1 0.
Part C
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
15. Find the equation whose roots are each two more than the roots of
x3 4x2 3x 2 0.
16. Using the method employed in Question 13, find the relationship between the
coefficients in a quartic equation and the roots of that equation.
56
CHAPTER 2
EXAMPLE 1
t chnology
EXAMPLE 2
t chnology
EXAMPLE 3
t chnology
Solve x2 x 6 0.
Solution
Consider the graph of y x2 x 6
(x 3)(x 2).
The values of x that satisfy the inequality
x2 x 6 0 are the same values for which
the graph of y x2 x 6 is below the
x-axis. From the graph, x2 x 6 0
for 2 x 3.
Solve x3 5x2 2x 8 0.
Solution
We first graph y f (x) x3 5x2 2x 8.
From the graph it appears that
x3 5x2 2x 8 0 if x 1, 2, or 4.
Since f (1) f (2) f (4) 0, the
x-intercepts are 1, 2, and 4. The solution to
the inequality x3 5x2 2x 8 0 is the
set of values of x for which the graph of
y f (x) is on or above the x-axis.
The solution is 1 x 2 or x 4.
Solve 2x3 3x2 9x 5 0.
Solution
The solution to the inequality is the set of
values for which the graph of
f (x) 2x3 3x2 9x 5 is below the x-axis.
Using the graph and the TRACE function,
it appears that the x-intercepts are
approximately 1.8, 0.5, and 2.8.
2 . 5 S O LV I N G P O LY N O M I A L I N E Q UA L I T I E S
57
and f 12 0.
x 12
1 21
1 21
.
for x
or 12 x
2
2
2x
x2 x 5
3
12
x
x
32
x
9
5
2x3 x2
2x2 9x
2x2 x
10x 5
10x 5
0
If approximate answers are sufficient, then we can make conclusions without having to solve the equation completely. In the above example, using only the TRACE
function, we might, depending on the given conditions, be satisfied with the solution x 1.8, or 0.5 x 2.8. In some situations an approximation is the best
we can hope to achieve.
EXAMPLE 4
t chnology
58
CHAPTER 2
Exercise 2.5
Part A
Knowledge/
Understanding
(ii) f (x) 0
c.
b.
y
y
y = f(x)
x
4
y = f(x)
y = f(x)
x
x
2
01
Part B
2. Solve each of the following, x R.
t chnology
a. x(x 2) 0
b. (x 3)(x 1) 0
c. x2 7x 10 0
d. 2x2 5x 3 0
e. x2 4x 4 0
f. x3 9x 0
g. x3 5x2 x 5
h. 2x3 x2 5x 2 0
i. x3 10x 2 0
j. x2 1 0
3. The viscosity, v, of oil used in cars is related to its temperature, t, by the formula v t 3 9t2 27t 21, where each unit of t is equivalent to 50C.
a. Graph the function of v t3 9t2 27t 21 on your graphing
calculator.
b. Determine the value of t for v 0, correct to two decimal places.
c. Determine the value of t for v 20, correct to two decimal places.
Application
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
59
4 units
6
EXAMPLE 1
Evaluate 5 9 35 12.
Solution
5 9 35 12 5 9 37
5937
17
EXAMPLE 2
Solve for x if x 7 3.
Solution
Since x 7 is three units from the origin, x 7 3 or x 7 3.
Therefore, x 10 or x 4.
EXAMPLE 3
60
CHAPTER 2
Solve x 3.
Solution
Using the geometric definition of absolute value, this statement says that x is less
than three units away from the origin. If we look at the real number line, this
means that x must lie in the interval between 3 and 3.
x
5
Solve x 3 5.
Solution
Using the geometric definition of absolute value, this statement says that x 3 is
more than five units away from the origin. Looking at the real number line, this
means that x 3 must lie in the interval to the right of 5 or in the interval to the
left of 5.
x3
8
x3
4
Therefore, x 3 5 or x 3 5.
Solving these inequalities for x gives us x 8 or x 2.
We now summarize the preceding discussion by giving the definition of the
absolute value of any real number.
The Absolute Value of x, x R, is
x, if x 0.
x
x, if x 0.
EXAMPLE 5
t chnology
61
GRAPH
f(x)
1
f(x) = x
x
1
This means that in order to obtain the graph of y f(x), we can sketch the
graph y f(x) and reflect the portion(s) of the graph that are below the x-axis.
EXAMPLE 6
Graph y 2x 1, x R.
Solution
To graph y 2x 1, first graph y 2x 1. The
portion of the graph below the x-axis is reflected in
the x-axis as illustrated, to obtain the required graph.
The graph y 2x 1 is shown.
Note that if x 1, y 3, and if x 2, y 3.
The graph of y 2x 1 contains the line
y 2x 1 for x 12, x R, and the line
62
CHAPTER 2
y
y = 2x + 1
1
EXAMPLE 7
Graph y x2 4, x R.
y
y = x2 4
Solution
First graph the parabola y x2 4. Then reflect
the portion of the graph that is below the x-axis in
the x-axis, as illustrated, to obtain the required graph.
Exercise 2.6
Part A
Knowledge/
Understanding
b. 4 15
c. 3 5 3 9
d. 9 35337 12
2. Graph each of the following on the number line, for x R. Rewrite each
statement without the absolute value bars.
a. x 2
Application
b. x 3
c. x 4
d. x 2
b. g(x) x 5
c. h(x) 2x 5
d. m(x) 3x 6
e. f(x) 4 3x
f. g(x) 1 2x
b. y x2 1
c. y x2 2x
d. y x2 4x
e. y x3 1
f. y x3
Part B
Communication
5. In your notebook, describe how you would sketch the graph of the absolute
value of a function.
6. Graph each of the following functions:
a. y x2 x 6
b. y 2x2 4x 3
c. y x3 x
2 . 6 A B S O L U T E VA L U E F U N C T I O N S
63
7. Solve for x, x R.
a. 2x 1 7
b. 3x 2 6
c. x 3 9
d. x 4 5
e. 2x 3 4
f. x 5
Part C
e
t chnology
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
64
CHAPTER 2
b. x 5 4x 1
c. 4x 8 2x
d. x 1 x
e. 2x 4 12x
f. 3x 1 53x 1 16
g. x 2 x 6
h. x 4 x 1 3
x x
a positive integer?
9. For which non-zero real numbers, x, is
x
x x
for x R.
10. Graph f(x)
x
Solving Equations
using grouping, using the Factor Theorem, using the graphing calculator and
the Factor Theorem
finding approximate roots using the graphing calculator
finding the family of polynomial functions given the x-intercepts of the graph
Absolute Value
x
x, if x 0
x, if x 0
graphs of y f (x) lie entirely above (or on) the x-axis
65
wrap-up
C H A P T E R 2 : R E S E A R C H I N G D O S E R E S P O N S E R E L AT I O N S H I P S
In this task, you will utilize the mathematical model used in the Career Link for
predicting the side-effect response to medication.
The model states
9 2
R(t) 5t4 4t3 14
t 32t
where [R(t)] is the temperature in degrees Celsius above or below the normal
body temperature of 36.9C caused by an experimental drug t hours after it was
administered. Remember that due to the stress of temperature change on the
body, a second drug is administered at the moment the patients temperature
starts to exceed 36.9C. Complete the following questions:
a) Apply the Factor Theorem and the quadratic formula to determine the times
when the patients temperature is at the normal body temperature.
b) Predict when the second drug will be administered by applying your
knowledge of solving polynomial inequalities.
c) The company has stated the maximum deviation, above or below normal
body temperature, is 2.5C. Express this statement in algebraic form using
absolute-value notation and explaining your work. Describe how you would
solve this on the graphing calculator.
66
CHAPTER 2
Review Exercise
1. a. If f(3) 0, state a factor of f (x).
2. a. Find the family of cubic functions whose x-intercepts are 4, 1, and 2.
b. Find the particular member of the above family whose graph passes
through the point (3, 10).
3. a. Determine if x 2 is a factor of x5 4x3 x2 3.
b. Determine if x 3 is a factor of x3 x2 11x 3.
4. Use the Factor Theorem to factor x3 6x2 6x 5.
5. a. If x 1 is a factor of x3 3x2 4kx 1, what is the value of k?
b. If x 3 is a factor of kx3 4x2 2kx 1, what is the value of k?
6. Factor each of the following:
a. x3 2x2 2x 1
b. x3 6x2 11x 6
c. 8x3 27y3
b. 2x3 x2 13x 5
b. x3 25x 0
c. x3 8 0
d. x3 x2 9x 9 0
e. x4 12x2 64 0
f. x3 4x2 3 0
REVIEW EXERCISE
67
g. x3 3x2 3x 2 0
h. x6 26x3 27 0
t chnology
12. Use your graphing calculator to find the approximate roots of the following
equations (correct to three decimal places):
a. x2 2
b. x2 10x 2 0
c. x3 x2 4x 1 0
d. 2x3 x2 2 0
e. x410x2150
f. x6 11x5 x2 1 0
13. If 2 is one root of x2 kx 6 0, find the other root and the value of k.
14. Find the quadratic equation whose roots are the reciprocals of the roots of
2x2 5x 1 0.
15. a. State the sum and product of the roots of 2x2 x 4 0.
b. Find a quadratic equation (with integral coefficients) whose roots have a
sum of 11
and a product of 12
.
5
5
c. Find a quadratic equation (with integral coefficients) whose roots are
3 2i and 3 2i.
d. If 2 is one root of the equation 3x2 4kx 4 0, find the other root and
the value of k.
e. Find an equation whose roots are each three less than the roots of
x2 5x 2 0.
f. Find an equation whose roots are the reciprocals of the roots of
2x2 x 4 0.
16. Solve for x, x R.
a. (x 2)(x 4) 0
b. x2 x 2 0
d. x3 2x2 x 20 e. x4 0
g. x6 8x4 2 0
c. x3 3x 0
f. x4 5x2 2 0
h. x9 2x7 1 0
b. x 1 3
c. 2x 3 5
18. Identical squares are cut from each corner of a rectangular sheet of tin 8 cm 6 cm. The sides are bent
upward to form an open box. If the volume of the box
is 16 cm3, what is the length of each side of the
squares cut from the original sheet?
68
CHAPTER 2
8 cm
x
x
x
x
x
x
6 cm
Chapter 2 Test
Achievement Category
Questions
Knowledge/Understanding
1, 2, 3, 4, 7
Thinking/Inquiry/Problem Solving
Communication
Application
5, 9
b. x3 4x2 6x 3 0
c. 2x3 7x2 3x 0
d. x4 5x2 4 0
5. Find the quadratic equation whose roots are each three greater than the roots
of x2 2x 5 0.
6. The Math Wizard states that the x-intercepts of the graph of
f (x) x3 9x2 26x 24 cannot be positive. Is the Math Wizard correct?
Explain.
7. Solve for x, x R.
a. (x 3)(x 2)2 0
b. x3 4x 0
c. 2x 5 9
CHAPTER 2 TEST
69
8. What can you deduce about the zeros, the leading coefficient, and the least
degree of the polynomial functions represented by the following graphs?
a.
b.
c.
y
9. The free end of a diving board dips C centimetres when a diver of x kilograms
stands on it. The relation is C 0.0002x3 0.005x2 0.5x.
a. Calculate the amount of dip when a 95 kg diver stands on the board.
Give your answer to the nearest tenth of a centimetre.
b. Calculate the mass of a diver, correct to one decimal place, if the diving
board dips 40 cm.
70
CHAPTER 2
Chapter 3
INTRODUCTION TO CALCULUS
Exercise
1. Determine the slope of the line passing through each of the following pairs of
points:
a. (2, 5) and (6, 7)
l.
c. slope 0, y-intercept 5
e. through (1, 6) and (4, 12)
3. The domain of a function f is the set of all numbers x, and its values are given
x
. Find each of the following values:
by f(x)
2
x 4
a. f(10)
72
CHAPTER 3
b. f(3)
c. f(0)
d. f(10)
3 x, if x 0.
3 x, if x 0.
b. f(0)
c. f(78)
b. s(1)
c. s(0)
1
, if 3 t 0.
t
5, if t 0.
t3, if t 0.
d. s(1)
e. s(100)
6 2
b.
2 3
4
c.
1
d.
3
3
5
e.
74
23
f.
32
53
g.
32
h.
2 5
i.
2
3
4
23
5
23
3
1
2 5
3
b.
7
4
c.
5
2 3
d.
3
7
e.
7
23
f.
6 2
32
b. x3 x
c. x2 x 6
d. 2x2 7x 6
e. x3 2x2 x
f. x3 8
g. 27x3 64
h. x3 2x2 3x 6
i. 2x3 x2 7x 6
b. y x2
c. y
x5
d. y
3
e. y
x1
x2 4
h. y
x
6x
k. y
2x2 5x 3
f. y 4x 5
x3
g. y
x97
7
j. y
x2 3x 4
4
i. y
5x
(x 3)(x 4)
l. y
(x 2)(x 1)(x 5)
73
investigate
C H A P T E R 3 : A S S E S S I N G AT H L E T I C P E R F O R M A N C E
Differential calculus is fundamentally about the idea of instantaneous rate of
change. A rate of change familiar to us is heart rate. Elite athletes are keenly
interested in the analysis of heart rates. Obviously, sporting performance is
enhanced when an athlete is able to increase his or her heart rate at a slower
pace (i.e., get tired less quickly). Heart rate is the rate of change of the number of
heartbeats with respect to time. A heart rate is given for an instant in time. In
calculus terminology, heart rate at an instant in time is known as the
instantaneous rate of change of the number of heartbeats with respect to time.
When a nurse or doctor counts our heartbeats then divides by the time elapsed,
they are not determining the instantaneous rate of change but instead are
calculating the average heart rate over a period of time (usually ten seconds). In
this chapter, the idea of the derivative will be developed, progressing from the
average rate of change being calculated over a smaller and smaller interval until a
limiting value is reached at the instantaneous rate of change.
Case StudyAssessing Elite Athlete Performance
The table below shows the number of heartbeats of an athlete who
is undergoing a cardio-vascular fitness test. Complete the discussion
questions to determine if this athlete is under his or her maximum
desired heart rate of 65 beats per minute at precisely 30 seconds.
DISCUSSION QUESTIONS
74
Time
(in seconds)
Number of
Heartbeats
10, 0.17
20, 0.33
19
30, 0.50
31
40, 0.67
44
50, 0.83
59
60, 1.00
75
CHAPTER 3
What Is Calculus?
Two simple geometric problems originally led to the development of what is now
called calculus. Both problems can be stated in terms of the graph of a function
y f(x).
y
Slope = ?
y = f(x)
Area = ?
x
0
Interest in the problem of tangents and the problem of areas dates back to scientists such as Archimedes of Syracuse (287212 B.C.), who used his vast ingenuity
to solve special cases of these problems. Further progress was made in the seventeenth century, most notably by Pierre de Fermat (16011665) and by Isaac
Barrow (16301677), Isaac Newtons professor at the University of Cambridge,
England. Professor Barrow recognized that there was a close connection between
the problem of tangents and the problem of areas. However, it took the genius of
both Sir Isaac Newton (16421727) and Gottfried Wilhelm von Leibniz
(16461716) to show the way to handle both problems. Using the analytic geometry of Ren Descartes (15961650), Newton and Leibniz showed independently
how these two problems could be solved by means of new operations on functions, called differentiation and integration. Their discovery is considered to be
one of the major advances in the history of mathematics. Further research by
mathematicians from many countries using these operations has created a problemsolving tool of immense power and versatility, which is known as calculus. It is a
powerful branch of mathematics, used in applied mathematics, science, engineering, and economics.
We begin our study of calculus by discussing the meaning of a tangent and the
related idea of rate of change. This leads us to the study of limits and, at the end
of the chapter, to the concept of the derivative of a function.
W H AT I S C A L C U L U S ?
75
y = f(x)
T4
The goal of this section is to develop a method for determining the slope of a tangent at a given point on a curve. We begin with a brief review of slopes and lines.
P 2 (x 2 ,y 2 ) l
y y
2
1 .
m
x
x x
2
y
P 1 (x 1 ,y 1)
x
yy
1 m or y y1 m(x x1),
x x1
CHAPTER 3
Tangent
at P
secant
P
y = f(x)
0
The slope of the tangent to a curve at a point P is the limiting slope of the
secant PQ as the point Q slides along the curve towards P. In other words,
the slope of the tangent is said to be the limit of the slope of the secant as Q
approaches P along the curve.
We will illustrate this idea by finding the slope of the tangent to the parabola
y x2 at P(3, 9).
INVESTIGATION 1
1. Find the y-coordinates of the following points that lie on the graph of the
parabola y x2.
a. Q1(3.5,
b. Q2(3.1,
c. Q3(3.01,
d. Q4(3.001,
2. Find the slopes of the secants through P(3, 9) and each of the points Q1, Q2,
Q3, and Q4.
3. Find the y-coordinates of each point on the parabola and then repeat step 2
using the points.
a. Q5(2.5,
)
b. Q6(2.9,
)
c. Q7(2.99,
) d. Q8(2.999,
4. Use your results from steps 2 and 3 to estimate the slope of the tangent at point
P(3, 9).
5. Graph y x2 and the tangent to the graph at point P(3, 9).
In this investigation, you found the slope of the tangent by finding the limiting
value of the slopes of a sequence of secants. Since we are interested in points Q
that are close to P(3, 9) on the parabola y x2, it is convenient to write Q as
(3 h, (3 h)2), where h is a very small non-zero number. The variable h determines the position of Q on the parabola. As Q slides along the parabola towards
P, h will take on values successively smaller and closer to zero. We say that h
approaches zero and use the notation h 0.
INVESTIGATION 2
t chnology
APPENDIX P. 440
3. Find the slope of the secant through Q1 and P(1, 1), Q2 and P(1, 1), and so on,
for points Q1(1.5, f(1.5)), Q2(1.1, f(1.1)), Q3(1.01, f(1.01)),
Q4(1.001, f(1.001)), and Q5(1.0001, f(1.0001)).
4. Graph these secants on the same utility you used in step 1.
3 . 1 T H E S L O P E O F A TA N G E N T
77
5. Use your results to estimate the slope of the tangent to the graph of f at point P.
6. Draw the tangent at point P(1, 1).
INVESTIGATION 3
h0
EXAMPLE 1
Find the slope of the tangent to the graph of the parabola f(x) x2 at P(3, 9).
Solution
Using points P(3, 9) and Q(3 h, (3 h)2), h 0, the slope of the secant PQ is
y
y2 y1
x
x2 x1
(3 h) 9
3h3
2
9 6h h 9
h
2
h(6 h)
h
(6 h)
t chnology
a. Use your calculator to graph the parabola y 18(x 1)(x 7) and plot the
points on the parabola from x 1 to x 6, where x is an integer.
b. Determine the slope of the secants using each point from part a and point
P(5, 1.5).
c. Use the result of part b to estimate the slope of the tangent at P(5, 1.5).
78
CHAPTER 3
Solution
a. Using the x-intercepts of 1 and 7, the equation of the axis of symmetry is
1 7
3, so the x-coordinate of the vertex is 3. Substitute x 3 into
x
2
4
2
x
8
1.5 0
0.25.
b. Using points (1, 0) and P(5, 1.5), the slope is m
5 (1)
Similarly, using the other points and P(5, 1.5), the slopes are 0.125, 0, 0.125,
0.25, 0.375, 0, and 0.625, respectively.
c. The slope of the tangent at P(5, 1.5) is between 0.375 and 0.625. It can be
determined to be 0.5 using additional points closer and closer to P(5, 1.5) for
values of x between 4 and 6.
y
Q
Tangent
at P
(a + h, f(a + h))
y = f (x)
P(a, f(a))
x
0
3 . 1 T H E S L O P E O F A TA N G E N T
79
y
f(a h) f (a)
f(a h) f(a)
.
x
aha
h
quotient.
f(a h) f(a)
secant PQ), which may be written as m lim h.
h0
h0
The slope of the tangent to the graph y f(x) at point P(a, f(a)) is
y
f(a h) f(a)
lim .
m lim
h
x 0 x
h0
EXAMPLE 3
a. Using the definition of a derivative, determine the slope of the tangent to the
curve y x2 4x 1 at the point determined by x 3.
b. Determine the equation of the tangent.
c. Sketch the graph of y x2 4x 1 and the tangent at x 3.
Solution
a. The slope of the tangent can be determined using the expression above. In this
example, f(x) = x2 4x 1 and a 3.
Then
and
m lim h
h 0
h 2h 4 4
lim
h
2
h 0
h(h 2)
lim
h
h 0
lim (h 2)
h 0
2.
The slope of the tangent at x 3 is 2.
y4
80
CHAPTER 3
15
10
10
15
20
EXAMPLE 4
3x 6
at
Determine the slope of the tangent to the rational function f(x)
x
point (2, 6).
Solution
Using the definition, the slope of the tangent at (2, 6) is
f(2 h) f(2)
m lim h
h0
6 3h 6
6
2h
lim
h0
12 3h 12 6h
2h
lim
h
h0
1
3h
lim
h
2h
h0
3h
lim
h0 h(2 h)
3
lim
h0 (2 h)
1.5.
3x 6
at (2, 6) is 1.5.
Therefore, the slope of the tangent to f(x)
x
EXAMPLE 5
3 . 1 T H E S L O P E O F A TA N G E N T
81
f (9 h) f (9)
m lim h
h0
9
h3
lim
h
h0
9
h3
9h3
9h3
lim
h
h0
(9 h) 9
h(
9 h 3)
h0
lim
h
h(
9
h 3)
h0
lim
1
lim
9h3
h0
16.
Therefore, the slope of the tangent to the function f (x) x at x 9 is 16.
INVESTIGATION 4
A graphing calculator can help us guess the approximate value of the slope of a
tangent at a point, which can then be found using the definition of the slope of the
tangent, from first principles, developed in this section. For example, suppose we
wish to find the slope of the tangent to y f(x) x3 at x 1.
((x 0.01) x )
.
1. Graph Y1
0.01
3
t chnology
WINDOW
Xmin 3
Xmax 3
Xscl 0.5
Ymin 0
Ymax 8
Yscl 1
CHAPTER 3
4. Can you improve this approximation? Explain how you could improve your
estimate. Also, if you use different WINDOW values you can see a different-sized
or differently centred graph.
5. Try once again by setting Xmin 9, Xmax 10, and note the different appearance of the graph. Use the TRACE function to find X 0.904 255 32,
Y 2.480 260 7, then X 1.106 383, Y 3.705 541 4. What is your guess for
the slope of the tangent at x 1 now? Explain why only estimation is possible.
6. Another way of using a graphing calculator to approximate the slope of the tangent is to consider h as the variable in the difference quotient. For this example,
f (x) x3 at x 1, look at
f(a h) f(a)
(1 h)3 13
.
h
h
7. Trace values of h as h 0. You can use the table or graph functions of your
(1 h) 1
in the neighbourcalculator. Graphically, we say we are looking at
h
3
(1 x)3 1
Exercise 3.1
Part A
1. Find the slope of the line through each pair of points.
a. (2, 7), (3, 8)
b. 13x 7y 11 0
3. State the equation and sketch the graph of the following straight lines:
a. passing through (4, 4) and 53, 53
b. having slope 8 and y-intercept 6
c. having x-intercept 5 and y-intercept 3
d. passing through (5, 6) and (5, 9)
4. Simplify each of the following:
(2 h)2 4
a.
h
3(1 h)2 3
e.
h
(5 h)3 125
b.
h
(2 h)3 8
f.
h
(3 h)4 81
c.
h
3
3
4
4h
g.
h
1
1
1h
d.
h
1
1
2
2h
h.
h
3 . 1 T H E S L O P E O F A TA N G E N T
83
h 5
h42
b.
h
5
h 5
c.
h
Part B
6. Find the slope m, in simplified form, of each pair of points.
a. P(1, 3), Q(1 h, f (1 h)) where f(x) 3x2
b. R(1, 3), S(1 h, (1 h)3 2)
9 h)
c. T(9, 3), U(9 h,
Knowledge/
Understanding
(2,
(3,
(2,
(2.5,
(2,
(2.1,
(2,
(2.01,
Slope of Line
PQ
Slope of Line
PQ
(2,
(1,
(2,
(1.5,
(2,
(1.9,
(2,
(1.99,
b. Use the results of part a to approximate the slope of the tangent to the
graph of f(x) at point P.
c. Calculate the slope of the secant PR, where the x-coordinate of R is
2 h.
d. Use the result of part c to calculate the slope of the tangent to the graph of
f(x) at point P.
e. Compare your answers for parts b and d.
f. Sketch the graph of f(x) and the tangent to the graph at point P.
8. Find the slope of the tangent to each curve at the point whose x-value is
given.
a. y 3x2; (2, 12)
b. y x2 x at x 3
c. y x3 at x 2
9. Find the slope of the tangent to each curve at the point whose x-value is given.
x 2; (3, 1)
a. y
b. y
x 5 at x 9 c. y
5x 1 at x 2
10. Find the slope of the tangent to each curve at the point whose x-value is given.
a. y 8x; (2, 4)
84
CHAPTER 3
8
at x 1
b. y
3x
1
at x 3
c. y
x2
Knowledge/
Understanding
11. Find the slope of the tangent to each curve at the given point.
a. y x2 3x; (2, 2)
c. y 3x3 at x 1
d. y
x 7 at x 16
16 x, where y 5
e. f (x)
f. y
25 x2; (3, 4)
4x
at x 8
g. y
x 2
h. y at x 5
x 11
12. Sketch the graph of Question 11, part f. Show that the slope of the tangent can
be found using the properties of circles.
Communication
Communication
13. Explain how you would approximate the slope of the tangent at a point without using first principles.
14. Sketch the graph of y 34
16 x2. Explain how the slope of the tangent at
P(0, 3) can be found without using first principles.
15. Copy the following figures. Draw an approximate tangent for each curve at
point P.
a.
b.
c.
d.
P
P
e.
f.
P
3 . 1 T H E S L O P E O F A TA N G E N T
85
20
Application
16. Find the slope of the demand curve D(p) , p 1, at point (5, 10).
Application
17. It is projected that t years from now, the circulation of a local newspaper will
be C(t) 100t2 400t 5000. Find how fast the circulation is increasing
after 6 months. Hint: Find the slope of the tangent when t is equal to
6 months.
p1
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
18. Find the coordinates of the point on the curve f (x) 3x2 4x, where the
tangent is parallel to the line y 8x.
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
19. Find the points on the graph of y 13x3 5x 4x at which the slope of the
tangent is horizontal.
Part C
20. Show that at the points of intersection of the quadratic functions
y x2 and y 12 x2, the tangents to each parabola are perpendicular.
86
CHAPTER 3
If s(t) gives the position of the vehicle on a straight section of the highway at time
t, then the average rate of change of the position of the vehicle over a time interval is
average velocity st .
INVESTIGATION
You are driving with a broken speedometer on a highway. At any instant you do
not know how fast the car is going. Your odometer readings are the following:
t (in hours)
2.5
62
133
210
250
293
3 . 2 R AT E S O F C H A N G E
87
3. Explain why there may be other times when you were travelling above the
posted speed limit.
4. Compute your average velocity over the interval 4 t 7 if s(4) 375 km
and s(7) 609 km.
5. After 3 h of driving, you decide to continue driving from Goderich to
Huntsville, a distance of 330 km. Using the average velocity from Question 4,
how long would it take you to make this trip?
EXAMPLE 1
s(3) s(1)
average velocity
31
Cliff
35 75
2
40
2
20 m/s
The average velocity in this 2 s interval is 20 m/s.
b. s(1.5) 80 5(1.5)2
68.75
s(1.5) s(1)
average velocity
1.5 1
Falling Pebble
Ground
68.75 75
0.5
12.5 m/s
The average velocity in this 0.5 s interval is 12.5 m/s.
c. Since gravity causes the velocity to increase with time, the smaller interval of
0.5 s gives a lower average velocity, as well as giving a value closer to the actual velocity at time t 1.
88
CHAPTER 3
The following table shows the results of similar calculations of the average velocity over successively smaller time intervals.
Time Interval
Average Velocity
(in metres per second)
1 t 1.1
10.5
1 t 1.01
10.05
1 t 1.001
10.005
It appears that, as we shorten the time interval, the average velocity is approaching the value 10 m/s. The average velocity over the time interval 1 t 1 h is
s(1 h) s(1)
average velocity
h
5(1 h) 5
h
2
5 10h 5h 5
h
2
10 5h, h 0.
If the time interval is very short, then h is small, so 5h is close to 0 and the
average velocity is close to 10 m/s. The instantaneous velocity when t 1 is
defined to be the limiting value of these average values as h approaches 0. Therefore, the velocity (the word instantaneous is usually omitted) at time t 1 s is
v lim (10 5h) 10 m/s.
h0
In general, suppose that the position of an object at time t is given by the function
s(t). In the time interval from t a to t a h, the change in position is
s s(a h) s(a).
The average velocity over this time interval is
s
s(a h) s(a)
t
h
s
Q
s(a + h)
s = s(t)
s
s(a)
P
h
t
a
a+h
h0
Note that the velocity v(a) is the slope of the tangent to the graph of s(t) at
P(a, s(a)).
The speed of an object is the absolute value of its velocity. It indicates how fast
an object is moving, whereas velocity indicates both speed and direction (relative
to a given coordinate system).
3 . 2 R AT E S O F C H A N G E
89
EXAMPLE 2
s(4 h) s(4)
v(4) lim
h
h0
[10h 5h ]
lim
h
2
h0
h(10 5h)
lim
h
h0
10.
Therefore, the velocity of the ball is 10 m/s downwards at t 4.
Velocity is only one example of the concept of rate of change. In general, suppose that a quantity y depends on x according to the equation y f (x). As the
independent variable changes from a to a h, the corresponding change in the
dependent variable y is y f (a h) f (a).
y
f (a h) f (a)
y
Q
f(a + h)
y = f(x)
y
f(a)
P
h
x
a
a+h
x0
90
CHAPTER 3
h0
It should be noted that as with velocity, the rate of change of y with respect to x at
x a equals the slope of the tangent to the graph of y f (x) at x a.
EXAMPLE 3
h0
10
100 h 100
10
100 h 100
10
100 h 100
lim
h
h0
100(100 h) 10 000
lim
100 h 100)
h0 h(10
100h
lim
100 h 100)
h0 h(10
100
lim
100 h 100)
h0 (10
100
(10
100 0 100)
0.5.
Therefore, the rate of change of the total cost with respect to the number of items
being produced when that number is 100 is $0.50 per item.
3 . 2 R AT E S O F C H A N G E
91
5 5t
lim
t1
2
t1
5(1 t)(1 t)
lim
t1
t1
lim5(1 t)
t1
10.
s(t) s(a)
.
In general, the velocity of an object at time t a is v(a) lim
ta
ta
.
lim
xa
xa
Exercise 3.2
Part A
Knowledge/
Understanding
Communication
1. The velocity of an object is given by v(t) t(t 4)2. At what times, in seconds, is the object at rest?
2. Give a geometrical interpretation of the following, where s is a position
function.
s(9) s(2)
a.
7
s(6 h) s(6)
b. lim
h
h0
4h2
y = f(x)
C
D
E
x
a. Between which two consecutive points is the average rate of change of the
function greatest?
b. Is the average rate of change of the function between A and B greater than
or less than the instantaneous rate of change at B?
c. Sketch a tangent to the graph between points D and E such that the slope
of the tangent is the same as the average rate of change of the function
between B and C.
92
CHAPTER 3
5. What is wrong with the statement the speed of the cheetah was 65 km/h
north?
6. Is there anything wrong with the statement a school bus had a velocity of
60 km/h for the morning run and that is why it was late on arrival?
Part B
7. A construction worker drops a bolt while working on a high-rise building
320 m above the ground. After t seconds, the bolt has fallen a distance of
s metres, where s(t) 320 5t2, 0 t 8.
a. Find the average velocity during the first, third, and eighth seconds.
b. Find the average velocity for the interval 3 t 8.
c. Find the velocity at t 2.
8. The function s(t) 8t(t 2) describes the distance s, in kilometres, that a car
has travelled after a time t, in hours, for 0 t 5.
a. Find the average velocity of the car during the following intervals:
i) from t 3 to t 4
ii) from t 3 to t 3.1
iii) 3 t 3.01
b. Use the results of part a to approximate the instantaneous velocity of the
car when t 3.
c. Find the velocity at t 3.
Application
Application
change of the time with respect to the height when the height of an object is
125 m above the ground.
3 . 2 R AT E S O F C H A N G E
93
12. Suppose that the temperature, T, in degrees Celsius, varies with the height h,
in kilometres, above the earths surface according to the equation
60
. Find the rate of change of temperature with respect to height at
T(h)
h2
a height of 3 km.
13. A spaceship approaching touchdown on a distant planet has height h, in
metres, at time t, in seconds, given by h 25t2 100t 100. When and with
what speed does it land on the surface?
Application
14. A manufacturer of soccer balls finds that the profit from the sale of x balls per
week is given by P(x) 160x x2 dollars.
a. Find the profit on the sale of 40 soccer balls.
b. Find the rate of change of the profit at the production level of 40 balls per
week.
t chnology
c. Using a graphing calculator, graph the profit function and from the graph
determine for what sales levels of x the rate of change of profit is positive.
f (x) f (a)
x 1, where x 24
c. f(x)
Part C
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
16. Let (a, b) be any point on the graph of y 1x, x 0. Prove that the area of the
triangle formed by the tangent through (a, b) and the coordinate axes is 2.
17. A manufacturers total weekly cost in producing x items can be written as
C(x) F V(x), where F, a constant, represents fixed costs such as rent and
utilities, and V(x) represents variable costs, which depend on production level
x. Show that the rate of change of the cost is independent of fixed costs.
18. A circular oil slick on the ocean spreads outward. Find the approximate rate
of change of the area of the oil slick with respect to its radius when the radius
is 100 m.
19. Show that the rate of change of the volume of a cube with respect to its edge
length is equal to half the surface area of the cube.
94
CHAPTER 3
and means that the value of f(x) can be made arbitrarily close to L by choosing x
sufficiently close to a (but not equal to a). The limit lim f(x) exists if and only if
xa
the limiting value from the left equals the limiting value from the right. We shall
use this definition to evaluate some limits.
Note: This is an intuitive explanation of the limit of a function. A more precise
definition using inequalities is important for advanced work but is not necessary
for our purposes.
INVESTIGATION 1
1.5
1.9
1.99
1.999
2.001
2.01
2.1
2.5
y = x2 1
INVESTIGATION 2
x 1
by graphing.
Find lim
x1
x1
Solution
x2 1
, x 1.
On a graphing calculator, display the graph of f (x)
x1
e
t chnology
APPENDIX P. 434
95
We say that the limit at x 1 exists only if the value approached from the left is
the same as the value approached from the right. From this investigation, we
x 1
2.
conclude that lim
x1
2
x1
EXAMPLE 1
x 1
by using a table.
Find lim
x1
2
x1
Solution
We select sequences of numbers for x 1 and x 1.
x approaches 1 from the left
x
x2 1
x1
0.5
0.9
0.99
0.999
1.001
1.01
1.1
1.5
1.5
1.9
1.99
1.999
undefined
2.001
2.01
2.1
2.5
1
approaches 2 from below
f(x)
x1
1
approaches 2 from above
f(x)
x1
x2
x2
x 1
2, as we found when graphing in
This pattern of numbers suggests lim
x1 x 1
Investigation 2.
2
EXAMPLE 2
e
t chnology
APPENDIX P. 438
96
CHAPTER 3
x 1, if x 1.
1, if x 1.
x 1, if x 1.
2
Solution
y
The graph of the function f consists of the line y x 1
y = f(x)
for x 1, the point (1, 1) and the square root function
2
y 2
x 1 for x 1. From the graph of f (x),
1
x
observe that the limit of f (x) as x 1 depends on whether
x 1 or x 1. As x 1, f (x) approaches the value of 0,
1
1
from below. We write this as lim f(x) lim(x 1) 0.
x1
x1
Similarly, as x 1, f (x) approaches the value 2, from
above. We write this as lim f (x) lim (2
x 1) 2. (This is the same
x1
x1
x1
more briefly, lim f (x) lim f (x). This implies that f (x) does not approach a
x1
x1
defined at x 1; that is, f(1) 1. We can now summarize the ideas introduced in
these examples.
We say that the number L is the limit of a function y f (x) as x approaches
the value a, written as lim f(x) L, if lim f (x) L lim f(x). Otherwise,
xa
xa
xa
lim f (x) does not exist.
xa
Exercise 3.3
Part A
1. What do you think is the appropriate limit of these sequences?
a. 0.7, 0.72, 0.727, 0.7272,
b. 3, 3.1, 3.14, 3.141, 3.1415, 3.141 59, 3.141 592,
Communication
Communication
97
Knowledge/
Understanding
b. lim (x 7)
c. lim x2
e. lim 4
f. lim 2x
x3
d. lim (4
x2
3x2)
x10
x1
x3
1, x 4.
1, x 4.
Part B
6. For the function y f(x) in the graph below, find the following:
a. lim f (x)
b. lim f (x)
x2
c. lim f (x)
x2
d. f(2)
x2
y
(2, 2)
D
(2, 0)
(2, 1)
Knowledge/
Understanding
b. lim f(x)
x2
c. lim f(x)
x2
x3
3
2
1
3
2
1
1 2 3
3
2
1
x
1 2 3
1 2 3
x 20
b. lim
x0 2x 5
c. lim
x1
x5
9. Find lim (x2 1) and illustrate your result with a graph indicating the limiting
x2
value.
Communication
b. lim(x2 4)
c. lim(x2 4)
1
d. lim
x1 x 3
1
e. lim
x3 x 2
1
f. lim
x3 x 3
x0
98
CHAPTER 3
x2
x3
Knowledge/
Understanding
11. In each of the following, find the indicated limit if it exists. Sketch the graph
of the function.
a. f(x)
4x, x 21
; lim f(x)
c. f(x) 1
1 x12
, x
x
2
Application
x 4, x 2 ; lim f(x)
x 2, x 1 ; lim f(x)
b. f(x)
x1
2x 6, x 2 x2
x 2, x 1
d. f(x)
1, x 0.5
x2 0.25, x 0.5
; lim f(x)
x0.5
12. Sketch the graph of any function that satisfies the given conditions in each
case.
a. f(1) 1, lim f(x) 3, lim f(x) 2
x1
x1
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
x1
Part C
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
14. Determine the real values of a, b, and c for the quadratic function
f(x) ax2 bx c, a 0, that satisfy the conditions f (0) 0, lim f(x) 5,
x1
and lim f(x) 8.
x2
15. The fish population (in thousands) in a lake at time t, in years, is modelled by
the function
p(t)
3 11
t2, 0 t 6
2
t2, 6 t 12.
2 11
8
x6
99
the number L as x gets closer and closer to the number a (from either side of a)
such that x a. This means that in finding the limit of f(x) as x approaches a,
there is no need to consider x a. In fact, f(a) need not even be defined. The only
thing that matters is the behaviour of f(x) near x a.
EXAMPLE 1
Solution
It seems clear that when x is close to 2, 3x2 is close to 12, and 4x is close to 8.
Therefore, it appears that lim (3x2 4x 1) 12 8 1 19.
x2
2. lim x a
xa
xa
xa
xa
xa
xa
lim f(x)
f(x)
xa
6. lim provided lim g(x) 0
lim g(x)
xa g(x)
xa
xa
EXAMPLE 2
xa
Solution
lim (3x2 4x 1) lim (3x2) lim (4x) lim (1)
x2
100 C H A P T E R 3
x2
x2
x2
x2
3lim x 4(2) 1
2
x2
3(2)2 8 1
19
Note: If f is a polynomial function, then lim f(x) f(a).
xa
EXAMPLE 3
x2 5x 2
.
Evaluate lim
3
2
x1 x 3x 1
Solution
8lim (x2 5x 2)
x1
x2 5x 2
lim
3
2
lim (2x3 3x 1)
x1 x 3x 1
x1
(1) 5(1) 2
2(1)3 3(1) 1
2
8
4
2
EXAMPLE 4
x
.
x5 x 1
2
Evaluate lim
Solution
x
x
lim
1
x
1
x
x5
x5
lim
lim x2
x5
lim (x 1)
x5
25
4
52
Sometimes the limit of f(x) as x approaches a cannot be found by direct substitution. This is of special interest when direct substitution results in an
0
indeterminate form . In such cases, we look for an equivalent function that
0
agrees with f for all values except the troublesome value x a. Here are some
examples.
3 . 4 P R O P E RT I E S O F L I M I T S
101
EXAMPLE 5
x 2x 3
.
Find lim
x3
2
x3
Solution
If we try substitution, we obtain 00, an indeterminate form. The next step is to simplify the function by factoring and reducing to see if the limit of the reduced form
can be evaluated.
x 2x 3
(x 1)(x 3)
lim lim (x 1)
lim
x3
x3
2
x3
x3
x3
This reduction is valid only if x 3. This is not a problem, since lim is concerned
x3
with values as x approaches 3, not the value x 3. Therefore,
x 2x 3
lim (x 1) 4.
lim
x3
2
x3
EXAMPLE 6
x3
A useful technique for finding limits is to rationalize either the numerator or the
denominator to obtain an algebraic form that is not indeterminate.
x11
Evaluate lim
.
x
x0
Solution
x11
x11
x11
x11
lim
lim
x
x
x0
x0
x11
Multiplying by
x 1 1
x11
lim
x 1 1)
x0 x(
x
lim
x 1 1)
x0 x(
1
lim
x11
x0
12
INVESTIGATION
(x 1)
2. Let u x, and rewrite lim in terms of u. Since x u2, and x 0,
1
x1 x
u1
102 C H A P T E R 3
1
EXAMPLE 7
(x 8) 3 2
Evaluate lim .
x0
x
Solution
1
This quotient is indeterminate 00 when x 0. Rationalizing the term (x 8) 3 is
not so easy. However, the expression can be simplified by substitution.
1
Let u (x 8) 3 . Then u3 x 8 and x u3 8. As x approaches the value 0,
u approaches the value 2. The given limit becomes
1
(x 8) 3 2
u2
lim lim
3
x0
u2 u 8
x
u2
lim
(u 2)(u2 2u 4)
u2
1
lim
u2 2u 4
u2
112.
EXAMPLE 8
x 2
x2 x 2
f (x)
x2
, if x 2
x2
(x 2)
, if x 2
x2
1, if x 2.
1, if x 2.
y
3
2
1
1 2 3
Notice that f(2) is not defined and that we must consider left- and right-hand
limits.
lim f(x) lim1 (1) 1
x21
x2
x21
x2
Since the left- and right-hand limits are not the same, we conclude that
x 2
x2 x 2
3 . 4 P R O P E RT I E S O F L I M I T S
103
EXAMPLE 9
a. Evaluate lim
9 x2.
x3
Solution
9 x2 is the semicircle y
9 x2 as illustrated
a. The graph of f(x)
below.
y
3
x
3
of 3.
In this section, we have learned the properties of limits and developed algebraic
methods for evaluating limits. The examples in this section have complemented
the table of values and graphing techniques introduced in previous sections. Five
techniques for evaluating simple limits that have indeterminate quotients were
illustrated:
direct substitution
factoring
rationalizing
change of variable
one-sided limits
104 C H A P T E R 3
Exercise 3.4
Part A
1. Is there a different value for the answers among lim (3 x), lim 3 x, and
x2
x2
lim (x 3)?
x2
Communication
Communication
3. Once you know the lim f(x) and lim f(x) at an interior point of the
xa
xa
domain of f, do you then know lim f(x)? Give reasons for your answer.
xa
1 2
x
c. lim x
x9
x3
x3 2x 4
x0
Part B
Knowledge/
Understanding
t chnology
5. Use a graphing calculator to graph the function and to estimate the limit. Then
find the limit by substitution.
3
2x
x
a. lim
x2 x 2
b. lim
2
x 1
x1
t t 5t
1.
6. Show that lim
6 t2
3
t1
Knowledge/
Understanding
4x
b. lim
x2 2 x
7x x
c. lim
x
2x2 5x 3
d. lim
x1
x1
3x x 4
e. lim
3x 4
x 27
f. lim
x3 x 3
x0
x11
x3 2x2 4x 8
2x3 5x2 3x 2
h. lim i. lim
g. lim
x2
2x 4
x2
x2
2 4
x
j. lim
x
x0
5 x
3x
m. lim
x1
x1
x0
x 2
7 x
7x
k. lim
x4 x 4
l. lim
x
2 x
n. lim
2x 1
x4 3
2 2
o. lim
x
x0 2 1
x0
2x
1
6
x 1
d. lim
1
x1 x 3
1
27 x
b. lim
1
x27 x 3
3
x 2
8
x4 x
e. lim
3
1
6
x 1
c. lim
x1 x 1
1
3
(x 8) 2
f. lim
x
x0
3 . 4 P R O P E RT I E S O F L I M I T S
105
x 16
b. lim
2
x4 x 5x 6
x x 5x 3
c. lim
x2 2x 1
x1
x2 5
x6
x
d. lim
x1 x 1
x2
e. lim
x3
x6
x12
4
g. lim
1
1
h. lim
x3
x11
j. lim
x
(x h) x
k. lim
h
x2
x2
x
2
x3
x0
1
3
(2x 1) 1
f. lim
x
x0
x
9x
i. lim
2
x0
5x3 6x
h0
1
1
2
l. lim
3x 5
x1 x 1 x 3
10. By using one-sided limits, determine whether the limit exists. Illustrate the
results geometrically by sketching the graph of each function.
x 5
2x 5(x 1)
a. lim
x5 x 5
b. lim
2x 5
x x2
c. lim
(x 2)
d. lim
x2 x 2
Application
x2 x 2
11. Charles Law and Absolute Zero Jacques Charles (17461823) discovered
that the volume of gas at a constant pressure increases linearly with the temperature of the gas. In the table, one mole of hydrogen is held at a constant
pressure of one atmosphere. The volume V is measured in litres and the temperature T is measured in degrees Celsius.
T
40
20
20
40
60
80
19.1482
20.7908
22.4334
24.0760
25.7186
27.3612
29.0038
a. By finding a difference row, show that T and V are related by a linear relation.
b. Find the linear equation V in terms of T.
c. Solve for T in terms of V for the equation in part b.
d. Show that limT is approximately 273.15. Note: This represents the
V0
106 C H A P T E R 3
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
x5
x5
13. If lim f(x) 3, use the properties of limits to evaluate each limit.
x4
[f (x)]2 x2
c. lim
3f(x)
2x
b. lim
x4 f (x) x
a. lim [f(x)]3
x4
x4
Part C
f(x)
f(x)
b. lim
x0 g(x)
a. lim f(x)
x0
f(x)
g(x)
15. If lim x 1 and lim x 2, then evaluate each limit.
x0
x0
a. lim f(x)
f(x)
c. lim
x0 g(x)
b. lim g(x)
x0
x0
x 1
2x 1
16. Evaluate lim of the indeterminate quotient.
3x 4 2x
4
x0
x x 1 1
17. Does lim exist? Illustrate your result by sketching a graph of
2
x1
x 1
the function.
x bx 3
exist?
18. For what value of b does lim
x1
2
x1
mx b 3
19. For what values of m and b is the statement lim 1?
x0
3 . 4 P R O P E RT I E S O F L I M I T S
107
10
2
2
c. Discontinuous at x 1
d. Discontinuous at x 1
10
Vertical
asymptote
2
2
Hole
10
x
2
see that lim f (x) does not exist and the function is therefore not continuous at
x1
x 1.
108 C H A P T E R 3
f(a)
f(x)
xa
f(x)
y y = f(x)
(a, f(a))
x
x a x
x2 3, x 1
x 1, x 1.
c. Find f(1).
Solution
a.
y
2
1
1
(1, 2)
b. From the graph lim f(x) 2. Note: Both the left-hand and right-hand limits
x1
are equal.
c. f(1) 2
Therefore, f(x) is continuous at x 1.
EXAMPLE 2
x x2
b. g(x)
x2
2
x x2
, if x 2 and h(2) 3
c. h(x)
x2
2
1
d. F(x)
(x 2)2
e. G(x)
4 x2, if x 2
3, if x 2
3.5 CONTINUITY
109
Solution
a. The function f is continuous at x 2 since f(2) 6 lim f(x). (Polynomial
x2
functions are continuous at all real values of x.)
b. The function g is not continuous at x 2 because g is not defined at this point.
x x2
(x 2)(x 1)
lim
c. Since lim
x2
(x 2)
2
x2
x2
lim (x 1)
x2
3
h(2),
therefore, h(x) is continous at x 2.
d. The function F is not continuous at x 2 because F(2) is not defined.
e. Since limG(x) lim(4 x2)
x2
x2
0
and limG(x) lim(3)
x2
x2
3,
therefore, lim G(x) does not exist, since the function is not continuous at x 2.
x2
INVESTIGATION
e
t chnology
8x 9x 5
, explain why the graphing technique to test for continuity
f(x)
x2 300x
3
Exercise 3.5
Part A
Communication
1. How can looking at a graph of a function help you tell where the function is
continuous?
Communication
110 C H A P T E R 3
Knowledge/
Understanding
7x 4
b. g(x)
x
x4
d. f(x)
x2 9
13x
e. g(x)
x2 x 6
x 1
c. h(x)
x3
2
x, x 3
f. h(x) 1 x, x 3
Part B
Knowledge/
Understanding
5. Find all values of x for which the given functions are continuous.
a. f(x) 3x5 2x3 x
b. g(x) x2 4.2x 7
16
x 5x
x2
c. h(x)
2
d. f(x)
x2
e. g(x) 10x
16
f. h(x)
x2 25
x 1, x 3
5 x, x 3
x2, x 0.
Is the function continuous?
3, x 0.
9. Recent postal rates for letter mail within Canada for non-standard and oversized items are given in the following table. Maximum dimensions for oversized letter mail are 380 mm
270 mm
20 mm.
100 g or Less
Between 100 g
and 200 g
Between 200 g
and 500 g
$0.92
$1.50
$2.00
x x6
is continuous at x 3.
10. Determine whether f(x)
x3
2
x, if x 1.
11. Examine the continuity of the function f(x) 1, if 1 x 2.
3, if x 2.
x 3, x 3.
12. g(x) 2 k, x 3. Find k, if g(x) is continuous.
3.5 CONTINUITY
111
Part C
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
x,
f(x) ax2 b,
6,
if 3 x 2
if 2 x 0
if x 0
is continuous for 3 x 0.
xx 1
, if x 1.
x1
0, if x 1.
a. Evaluate limg(x) and limg(x), then determine whether lim g(x) exists.
x1
x1
x1
112 C H A P T E R 3
Formulas
The slope of the tangent to the graph y f(x) at point P(a, f(a)) is
y
f (a h) f (a)
lim h.
m lim
x0 x
h0
change in distance
average velocity
change in time
h0
The function f(x) is continuous at x a if f(a) is defined and if lim f(x) f(a).
xa
113
wrap-up
C H A P T E R 3 : A S S E S S I N G AT H L E T I C P E R F O R M A N C E
An Olympic coach has developed a six-minute fitness test for her team members
that sets target values for heart rates. The monitor they have available counts the
total number of heartbeats starting from a rest position at time zero. Results
for one of the team members are as follows:
Time
(in minutes)
Number
of Beats
0.0
1.0
55
2.0
120
3.0
195
4.0
280
5.0
375
6.0
480
a. The coach has established that each athletes heart rate must not exceed 100
beats per minute at exactly 3 min. Using a graphical technique, determine if
this athlete meets the coachs criteria.
b. The coach also needs to know the instant in time when an athletes heart
rate actually exceeds 100 beats per minute. Explain how you would solve this
problem graphically. Would this be an efficient method? Explain. How is this
question different from part a?
c. Build a mathematical model with the total number of heartbeats as a
function of time (n f (t)) by first determining the degree of the polynomial
then using the graphing calculator to obtain an algebraic model.
d. Solve b algebraically by obtaining an expression for the instantaneous rate of
change of number of heartbeats, heart rate, as a function of time (r f (t))
using the methods presented in this chapter. Compare the accuracy and
efficiency of solving this question graphically and algebraically.
114 C H A P T E R 3
Review Exercise
1. Consider the graph of the function f(x) 5x2 8x.
a. Find the slope of the secant that joins the points on the graph given by
x 2 and x 3.
b. Determine the average rate of change as x changes from 1 to 4.
c. Find an equation for the line tangent to the graph of the function at x 1.
2. Find the slope of the tangent to the given function at the given point.
3
, P(2, 1)
a. f (x)
x1
b. g(x)
x 2, x 1
5
, x 4
d. f(x)
x2
c. h(x) , x 4
x5
4 x2, x 1
3. Find the slope of the graph of f (x) 2x 1, x 1 at each of the
following points:
a. P(1, 3)
b. P(2, 5)
4. The height (in metres) that an object has fallen from a height of 180 m is
given by the position function s(t) 5t2 180, where t 0 and t is in
seconds.
a. Find the average velocity during each of the first two seconds.
b. Find the velocity of the object when t 4.
c. At what velocity will the object hit the ground?
5. After t minutes of growth, a certain bacterial culture has a mass in grams of
M(t) t2.
a. How much does it grow during the time 3 t 3.01?
b. What is its average rate of growth during the time interval 3 t 3.01?
c. What is its rate of growth when t 3?
6. It is estimated that t years from now, the amount of waste accumulated, Q, in
tonnes, will be Q(t) 104(t2 15t 70) tonnes, 0 t 10.
a. How much waste has been accumulated up to now?
b. What will be the average rate of change of this quantity over the next
three years?
REVIEW EXERCISE
115
p(t)
10
t4
0
06:00
6
12:00
8. Sketch a graph of any function that satisfies the given conditions in each case.
a. lim f(x) 0.5 and f is discontinuous at x 1.
x1
x 1, x 1.
9. Sketch the graph of the function f(x) x 1, 1 x 1.
x 2, x 1.
a. Find all values at which the function is discontinuous.
b. Find the limits at those values, if they exist.
x x6
is continuous at x 3.
10. Determine whether f(x)
x3
2
2x 2
.
11. Consider the function f(x)
x2 x 2
t chnology
12. Use a graphing calculator to graph the function and estimate the limits, if they
exist.
a. f(x) x12 , lim f(x)
x0
x3 27
, lim h(x) and lim h(x)
c. h(x)
x2 9 x4
x3
116 C H A P T E R 3
t chnology
13. Complete each table and use the result to estimate the limit. Use a graphing
calculator to graph the function to confirm your result.
x2
a. lim
2
x2 x x 2
x
1.9
1.99
1.999
2.001
2.01
2.1
0.99
0.999
1.001
1.01
1.1
f(x)
x1
b. lim
2
x1 x 1
x
0.9
f(x)
14. Complete the table and use the results to estimate the limit. Then determine
the limit using an algebraic technique and compare the answer with the estimate.
x 3 3
lim
x
x0
0.1
0.01
0.001
0.001
0.01
0.1
f(x)
x22
2.1
2.01
2.001
2.0001
x+22
f(x) =
x2
t chnology
b. Use a graphing calculator to graph f and use the graph to approximate the
limit.
c. Use the technique of rationalizing the numerator to find the
x22
lim .
x2
x2
16. Evaluate the limit of each difference quotient. In each case, interpret the limit
as the slope of the tangent to a curve at a specific point.
4h2
(5 h) 25
a. lim
h
2
b. lim
h0
h0
1
1
4
(4 h)
1
(343 h) 3 7
c. lim
h
d. lim
h
h0
h0
17. Evaluate each limit using one of the algebraic methods discussed in the text,
if the limit exists.
x 7
a. lim
2
x2 x x
2
b. lim (5x2 3x 7)
xa
1
c. lim
x6 6 x
REVIEW EXERCISE
117
d. lim 10x
x 36
e. lim
x6 x 6
x2 12x 32
f. lim
x4
x2 4
g. lim
3
x2 x 8
(x 4a)2 25a2
h. lim
xa
xa
x 3x
i. lim
2
3
x0 x 7x
x 1
j. lim
2
x2 x 1
k. lim 24n
n0
1
m. lim
1
1
n. lim
x 3x
p. lim
x3 x 3
x3 x2 8x 12
x3 x2 12
r. lim
q. lim
x2
x2
64 x3
s. lim
x4 4 x
1
1
t. lim 1x
2x
2
x0
x0
x3
3
x
2
x4
5x 2x 3
l. lim
2
x0 7x 4x 3
x0
4
12 x
x4
x 5
5x
o. lim
x
x0
x2
x2
x3
a. lim
b. lim
x 4
c. lim
2
x2 x 4x 4
d. lim x
x0
x3
e. f(x)
x2
x2
5, x 1
lim f(x)
2, x 1 ; x1
5x2, x 1
f. f(x) 2x 1, x 1 ; lim f(x)
x1
19. Write an essay about Sir Isaac Newton and his discovery of calculus.
20. Write an essay about Gottfried Leibniz and his discovery of calculus.
21. Write an essay about the controversy surrounding the discovery of calculus by
Newton and Leibniz.
118 C H A P T E R 3
Chapter 3 Test
Achievement Category
Questions
Knowledge/Understanding
59, 1114
Thinking/Inquiry/Problem Solving
4, 17
Communication
1, 2, 3
Application
10, 15, 16
4. Give an example for which neither lim f(x) nor lim g(x) exists, but
xa
xa
lim [f(x) g(x)] does exist.
xa
5. Consider the graph of the function f(x) 5x2 8x. Find the slope of the
secant that joins the points on the graph given by x 2 and x 1.
6. State the slope of the line perpendicular to y 34x 5.
x 100
7. State the y-intercept of the function f(x)
.
5
2
8. State the equation of the line through (0, 2) with a slope of 1.
9. For the function in the diagram, find the following:
a. lim f(x)
x1
b. lim f(x)
x2
c. lim f (x)
x4
y = f(x)
2
1
x
0
CHAPTER 3 TEST
119
10. The population of a city grows from 100 000 people to an amount P given by
the formula P 100 000 4000t, where t is measured in years.
a. Find the number of people in the city in 20 years.
b. Determine the growth rate, in people per year, at t 10 years.
11. A weather balloon is rising vertically. After t hours, its distance, measured in
kilometres above the ground, is given by the formula s(t) 8t t2.
a. Determine its average velocity from t 2 h to t 5 h.
b. Find its velocity at t 3 h.
x 11 with respect to x from
12. Find the average rate of change of f(x)
x 5 to x 5 h.
x
.
13. Find the slope of the tangent at x 4 for the function f(x)
x2 15
2x x 6
b. lim
2
x2 3x 7x 2
2
x5
c. lim
x 1
d. lim
4
x1 x 1
1
6
e. lim
x2 9
x3 x 3
f. lim
x12
x5
1
(x 8) 3 2
x
x0
ax 3, if x 5
8, if x 5
x2 bx a, if x 5
a. f(0) 3
x1
c. lim f(x) 4
x1
d. f(2) 1
120 C H A P T E R 3
x2
2
, if x and x 2
7
7x 2
6x 4
k, if x 2
Chapter 4
D E R I VAT I V E S
Exercise
1. Use the exponent laws to simplify each of the following expressions.
Express your answers with positive exponents.
a. 54 57
b. a5 a3
c. (49)2
d. (2a2)3
e. 2m6 3m7
f.
15
g. (a4b5)(a6b2)
h. (3e6)(2e3)4
i.
5 2
4p7 6p9
12p
(3a4)[2a3(b)3]
12a b
2
b. 8x 6 3
a
a
c.
6
2
a
3. Determine the slope of a line perpendicular to a tangent that has the following
slopes:
a. 23
b. 12
c. 53
d. 1
122 C H A P T E R 4
a. (x 3y)(2x y)
c. (6x 3)(2x 7)
e. (2x
3y)2
(5x
y)2
(y 5)2
(x y)(x y)
(x y) 3
5x
a.
2
2x(x 2)
b.
(y 2)(y 5)
4y3
4
9
c.
(h k)
2(h k)
d.
5(x y)
10
x7
5x
e.
2x
x1
x1
x2
f.
x2
x3
7. Factor completely.
a. 10a2 6a
b. 4k2 9
c. x 2 4x 32
d. y2 11y 42
e. 3a2 4a 7
f. 6y2 17y 10
g. x4 1
h. x3 y3
i. r 4 5r2 4
b. a5 b5
c. a7 b7
d. an bn
4 2
b.
3
2 32
c.
3 42
32
43
d.
43
32
123
investigate
CHAPTER 4: THE ELASTICITY OF DEMAND
Have you ever wondered how businesses set prices for their goods and services?
One of the most important ideas in marketing is the elasticity of demand, or the
response of consumers to a change in price. Consumers respond very differently
to a change in price of a staple item, such as bread, as compared to a luxury item
such as jewellery. A family would probably still buy the same quantity of bread if
the price increased by 20%. This is called inelastic demand. If the price of a gold
chain, however, were increased by 20%, it is likely sales would decrease 40% or
more. This is called elastic demand. Mathematically, elasticity is defined as the
n
relative (percentage) change in the number demanded n
divided by the
p
relative (percentage) change in the price p:
n
n
E .
p
p
For example, if a store increased the price of a CD from $17.99 to $19.99 and
the number sold per week went from 120 to 80, the elasticity would be
(80 120)
120
E
3.00.
(19.99 17.99)
17.99
The elasticity of 3.00 means that the change in demand is three times as large, in
percentage terms, as the change in price. The CDs have an elastic demand because
a small change in price can cause a large change in demand. In general, goods or
services with elasticities greater than one (E 1) are considered elastic (e.g., new
cars), and those with elasticities less than one (E 1) are inelastic (e.g., milk). In our
example, we calculated the average elasticity between two price levels, but in reality,
businesses want to know the elasticity at a specific or instantaneous price level. In
this chapter, you will develop the rules of differentiation that will enable you to
calculate the instantaneous rate of change for several classes of functions.
Case Study Marketer: Product Pricing
In addition to developing advertising strategies, marketing departments also
conduct research into and make decisions on pricing. The demandprice
500
,
relationship for weekly movie rentals at a convenience store is n(p)
p
where n(p) is demand and p is price.
DISCUSSION QUESTIONS
1. Generate two lists, each with at least five goods and services that you have
purchased recently, classifying each of the goods and services as having
elastic or inelastic demand.
2. Discuss how elasticity might be used in a business to make decisions about
setting price levels. Give specific examples for elastic and inelastic goods.
3. Calculate and discuss the elasticity if the movie rental fee increases from
$1.99 to $2.99.
124 C H A P T E R 4
This limit has two interpretations: the slope of the tangent to the graph y f(x)
at the point (a, f (a)), and the rate of change of y f(x) with respect to x at
x a. Since this limit plays a central role in calculus, it is given a name and a
concise notation. The limit is called the derivative of f(x) at x = a. It is denoted
by f(a) and is read as f prime of a.
The derivative of f at the number a is given by
f(a h) f(a)
EXAMPLE 1
(3 h) (3)
lim
h
2
h0
9 6h h 9
lim
h
2
h0
h(6 h)
lim
h
h0
lim (6 h)
h0
6.
Therefore, the derivative of f(x) x2 at x 3 is 6.
An alternative way of writing the derivative of f at the number a is
4 . 1 T H E D E R I VAT I V E F U N C T I O N
125
f(x) f (a)
f(a) lim
xa
xa
In applications where we are required to find the value of the derivative for a
number of particular values of x, using the definition repeatedly for each value
is tedious.
The next example illustrates the efficiency of calculating the derivative of f(x) at
an arbitrary value of x and using the result to determine the derivatives at a
number of particular x-values.
EXAMPLE 2
f(x h) f(x)
(x h)2 x2
lim h
h0
x 2hx h x
lim
h
2
h0
h(2x h)
lim h
h0
lim (2x h)
h0
2x.
The derivative of f(x) x2 at an arbitrary value of x is f(x) 2x.
b. The required slopes of the tangents to y x2 are obtained by evaluating
the derivative f(x) 2x at the given x-values. We obtain the slopes by
substituting for x:
f(2) 4
f(0) 0
f(1) 2.
y
y = x2
2
1
126 C H A P T E R 4
INVESTIGATION
i) f(x) x 3
iii) f(x) x
The limit f(x) is read f prime of x. This notation was developed by Joseph
Louis Lagrange (17361813), a French mathematician.
In Chapter 3, we discussed velocity at a point. We can now define (instantaneous)
velocity as the derivative of position with respect to time. If a bodys position at
time t is s(t), then the bodys velocity at time t is
s(t h) s(t)
EXAMPLE 3
f(t h) f(t)
t h t
lim
h
h0
t h t
t h t
lim
h
h0
t
h t
(Rationalizing
the numerator)
(t h) t
h(
t h t)
h0
lim
4 . 1 T H E D E R I VAT I V E F U N C T I O N
127
lim
t h t)
h0 h(
1
lim
t h t
h0
1
2t
, for t 0.
1
2t
Note that f(t) t is defined for all t 0, whereas its derivative f(t) is
defined for only t 0. From this, we can see that a function need not have a
derivative throughout its entire domain.
EXAMPLE 4
Find an equation of the tangent to the graph of f(x) 1x at the point where x 2.
Solution
When x 2, y 12. The graph of y 1x, the point 2, 12, and the tangent at the
point are shown. First find f(x).
f(x h) f(x)
y = 1x
h0
1
1
x
xh
lim
h
x (x h)
lim
h0 h(x h)x
h0
Tangent
)
(f(x) x; f(x h)
xh
(2, 12)
2
2
1
lim
(x h)x
h0
x12
The slope of the tangent at x 2 is m f(2) 14. The equation of the tangent
is y 12 14(x 2), or in standard form, x 4y 4 0 .
EXAMPLE 5
Find an equation of the line that is perpendicular to the tangent to the graph of
f(x) 1x at x 2 and that intersects it at the point of tangency.
Solution
From Example 4, we found that the slope of the
tangent is f(2) 14 and the point of tangency is
128 C H A P T E R 4
Normal
y = 1x
Tangent
(2, 12)
2
[a, f (a)]
x
Cusp
EXAMPLE 6
Vertical Tangent
Discontinuity
y
2
y = |x|
x
2
2
2
f(0 h) f(0)
f(0) lim h
h0
f(h) 0
lim h
h0
lim h
h0
h
lim(1) 1
limh lim
h
h0
h0
h0
h
limh limhh lim(1) 1
h0
h0
h0
4 . 1 T H E D E R I VAT I V E F U N C T I O N
129
Since the left-hand and right-hand limits are not the same, the derivative does
not exist.
From Example 6, we conclude that it is possible for a function to be continuous
at a point and yet to be not differentiable at that point.
dy
1
x
dy
is not a fraction.
It is important to note that d
x
Exercise 4.1
Part A
1. State the domain on which f is differentiable.
a.
b.
2
x
2
2
130 C H A P T E R 4
x
2
2
2
c.
d.
2
x
e.
2
2
f.
2
x
2
2
Communication
Communication
Knowledge/
Understanding
4. For each function, find the value of the derivative f(a) for the given value of a.
a. f(x) x2; a 1
b. f(x) x2 3x 1; a 3
x 1; a 0
c. f(x)
5. Use the definition of the derivative to find f(x) for each function.
a. f(x) x2 3x
3
b. f(x)
x2
c. f(x)
3x 2
1
x
d. f(x) 2
dy
x1
b. y
x1
c. y 3x2
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
8. An object moves in a straight line with its position at time t seconds given by
s(t) t 2 8t where s is measured in metres. Find the velocity when t 0,
t 4, and t 6.
9. Find an equation of the straight line that is tangent to the graph of
f(x)
x 1 and parallel to x 6y 4 0.
4 . 1 T H E D E R I VAT I V E F U N C T I O N
131
dy
10. For each function, use the definition of the derivative to determine d
, where
x
a, b, c, and m are constants.
a. y c
Communication
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
b. y x
c. y mx b
d. y ax2 bx c
11. Does the function f(x) x3 ever have a negative slope? If so, where?
Give reasons for your answer.
12. Match each function in graphs a, b, and c with its corresponding derivative,
graphed in d, e, and f.
a.
b.
c.
y
2
2
x
x
2
e.
y = f(x)
f.
2
x
x
2
2
2
2
2
y = f(x)
y = f(x)
d.
x
2
y = f(x)
y = f(x)
y = f(x)
13. Find the slope of the tangent to the curve 1x 1y 1 at the point (2, 2).
Part C
14. For the function f(x) xx, show that f (0) exists. What is the value?
Application
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
132 C H A P T E R 4
f(a h)
2
x
2
2
2
Slope = 0
kk
lim
h
h0
lim 0
h0
0
EXAMPLE 1
a. If f(x) 5, f (x) 0.
0.
b. If y 2, d
x
dy
4 . 2 T H E D E R I VAT I V E S O F P O LY N O M I A L F U N C T I O N S
133
A power function is a function of the form f(x) xn, where n is a real number.
In the previous section, we observed that for f(x) x2, f (x) 2x;
1
1
2
1
2x
1
x
h(x) 2x3. We also hypothesized that ddx (xn) nxn1. In fact, this is true,
and is called the Power Rule.
The Power Rule
If f(x) x n, where n is a real number, then f(x) nx n1.
(xn) nx n1.
In Leibniz notation, dd
x
EXAMPLE 2
3
x
(x h) n x n
lim h
h0
(x h x)(x h)n1 (x h)n2 x ... (x h)x n2 x n1
lim
h
h0
(Reduce the
fraction)
nx n1.
The proof for any real number n will be investigated in Chapter 8.
134 C H A P T E R 4
(Factoring a
difference of
nth powers)
kg(x h) kg(x)
lim h
h0
g(x h) g(x)
lim k h
h0
g(x h) g(x)
k lim h
h0
(Property of Limits)
kg(x).
EXAMPLE 3
b. y 12x 3
Solution
a. f(x) 7x3
f (x) 7ddx (x3) 7(3x2) 21x2
4
b. y 12x 3
dy
1
d 4
4 4 1
3
12 x 3 12 x 3
16x
dx
3
dx
4 . 2 T H E D E R I VAT I V E S O F P O LY N O M I A L F U N C T I O N S
135
lim
h
h0
[ p(x h) p(x)]
[q(x h) q(x)]
[ p(x h) p(x)]
[q(x h) q(x)]
h0
p(x) q(x)
The proof of the Difference Rule is similar to that of the Sum Rule.
The Difference Rule
If f(x) p(x) q(x), then f (x) p(x) q (x).
EXAMPLE 4
3(2x) 5 12x
1
2
1
2
6x 52x
136 C H A P T E R 4
EXAMPLE 5
t chnology
Find the equation of the tangent to the graph of f (x) x3 3x2 2 at x 1.
Solution
The slope of the tangent to the graph
of f at any point is given by the
derivative f (x).
f(x) x3 3x2 2
f (x) 3x2 6x
Now,
f (1) 3(1)2 6(1)
3 6
3.
The slope of the tangent at x 1 is 3.
The point of tangency is (1, f(1))
(1, 0).
The equation of the tangent is
y 0 3(x 1) or y 3x 3.
For
DRAW
Select 2nd
program.
PRGM
Select 5:Tangent(.
Select
VARS
and 1:Function.
Press
ENTER
EXAMPLE 6
ZOOM
ENTER
Find the points on the graph in Example 5 where the tangents are horizontal.
Solution
Horizontal lines have slope 0. We need to find the values of x that satisfy
f (x) 0.
3x2 6x 0
3x(x 2) 0
x 0 or x 2
The graph of f(x) x3 3x2 2 has horizontal tangents at (0, 2) and (2, 2).
4 . 2 T H E D E R I VAT I V E S O F P O LY N O M I A L F U N C T I O N S
137
Exercise 4.2
Part A
Communication
1. What rules do you know for calculating derivatives? Give examples of each.
2. Find f (x) for each of the following:
a. f(x) 4x 7
b. f(x) 7
c. f(x) 2x 2 x 5
d. f(x) x
e. f(x) 4x3 2
f. f(x) x3 x 2
i. f(x) 14x 4
j. f(x) (3x)2
Knowledge/
Understanding
l. f(x) x3
3. Differentiate each function. Use either the Leibniz notation or prime notation,
depending on which is appropriate.
a. y x 2 3x 1
b. f(x) 2x 3 5x 2 4x 3.75
c. v(t) 6t3 4t 5
d. s(t) 2, t 0
e. f(x) (x3)2
g. s
t 2(t 2
1
t
2t)
h. g(x) 5
x
j. g(x) 5(x2)4
t 3t
, t 0
k. s(t)
2t
5
l. g(x) 7 f(x) 5
3
x
n. y mx b
m. h(x) 7
4. Apply the differentiation rules of this section to find the derivatives of the
following:
1
5
3
2
a. f(x) 10x 5
b. y 3x 3
d. y x 8 x8
e. y 3x 3 6x 3 x
f. y 4x
h. y 9x2 3x
i. y 20x5 3x 17
6
x
2
x
g. y 3 2 3
2
c. y 6x
1
1
3
j. y x 6
x3 2 k. y x1.5 12x0.25
1
2
6x
3
1 x
l. y
x
Part B
5. Let s represent the position of a moving object at time t. Find the velocity
v ddst at time t.
a. s 2t2 7t
138 C H A P T E R 4
b. s 18 5t 13t 3
c. s (t 3)2
6. Find f (a) for the given function f(x) at the given value of a.
2
a. f(x) x3 x; a 4
Application
b. f(x) 7 6x 5x 3 ; a 64
7. Find the slope of the tangent to each of the curves at the given point.
1
a. y 3x 4 at (1, 3)
d. y
16x 3 at (4, 32)
8. Find the slope of the tangent to the graph of the function at the point whose
x-coordinate is given.
a. y 2x3 3x; x 1
b. y 2x 5; x 4
16
x
d. y x3(x1 1); x 1
c. y
; x 2
2
c. y
3x 3 at P(3, 9)
f. y
at P(1, 1)
3
Communication
10. What is a normal to the graph of a function? Find the equation of the normal
to the graph of the function in Question 9, part b at the given point.
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
Communication
12. Do the functions y 1x and y x3 ever have the same slope? If so, where?
). Prove that
13. Tangents are drawn to the parabola y x2 at (2, 4) and (18, 61
4
these lines are perpendicular. Illustrate with a sketch.
14. Find the point on the parabola y x 2 3x 4 where the slope of the
tangent is 5. Illustrate your answer with a sketch.
15. Find the coordinates of the points on the graph of y x 3 2 at which the
slope of the tangent is 12.
16. Show that there are two tangents to the curve y 15 x 5 10x that have a
slope of 6.
4 . 2 T H E D E R I VAT I V E S O F P O LY N O M I A L F U N C T I O N S
139
Application
17. Find the equations of the tangents to the curve y 2x 2 3 that pass through
the following:
b. point (2, 7)
a. point (2, 3)
18. Find the value of a, given that the line ax 4y 21 0 is tangent to the
a
x
19. It can be shown that from a height of h metres, a person can see a distance
d kilometres to the horizon, where d 3.53h.
a. When the elevator of the CN Tower passes the 200 m height, how far can
the passengers in the elevator see across Lake Ontario?
b. Find the rate of change of this distance with respect to height when the
height of the elevator is 200 m.
20. A subway train travels from one station to the next in 2 min. Its distance, in
kilometres, from the first station after t minutes is s(t) t2 13t3. At what
times will the train have a velocity of 0.5 km/min?
21. A construction worker drops a bolt while working on a high-rise building
320 m above the ground. After t seconds, the bolt has fallen a distance of
s metres, where s(t) 5t2, 0 t 8. The function that gives the height of the
bolt above ground at time t is R(t) 320 5t2. Use this function to
determine the velocity of the bolt at t 2.
22. Tangents are drawn from the point (0, 3) to the parabola y 3x 2. Find the
coordinates of the points at which these tangents touch the curve. Illustrate
your answer with a sketch.
23. The tangent to the cubic function defined by y x3 6x2 8x at point
A(3, 3) intersects the curve at another point, B. Find the coordinates of B.
Illustrate with a sketch.
Part C
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
24. Let P(a, b) be a point on the curve x y 1. Show that the slope of the
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
25. For the power function f(x) x n, find the x-intercept of the tangent to its
graph at point (1, 1). What happens to the x-intercept as n increases
without bound (n
)? Explain the result geometrically.
Application
26. For each function, sketch the graph of y f(x) and find an expression for
f (x). Indicate any points at which f (x) does not exist.
b
.
tangent at P is
a. f(x)
140 C H A P T E R 4
x2, x 3
x 6, x 3
b. f(x) 3x 2 6
c. f(x) x 1
EXAMPLE 1
In words, the Product Rule says, the derivative of the product of two functions is
equal to the derivative of the first function times the second function plus the first
function times the derivative of the second function.
Proof of the Product Rule
h(x) f(x)g(x); then using the definition of the derivative,
f(x h)g(x h) f(x)g(x)
141
f(x h) f(x)
h0
g(x h) g(x)
and g(x) lim h . To evaluate h(x) we subtract and add terms
h0
in the numerator.
f(x h)g(x h) f(x)g(x h) f(x)g(x h) f(x)g(x)
lim
h0
f(x h) f(x)
g(x h) g(x)
g(x h) f(x)
h
h
f(x h) f(x) h0
g(x h) g(x)
h0
h0
f (x)g(x) f(x)g(x).
EXAMPLE 2
142 C H A P T E R 4
EXAMPLE 3
Find the value h(1) for the function h (x) (5x3 7x2 3)(2x2 x 6).
Solution
h (x) (5x3 7x2 3)(2x2 x 6)
Using the Product Rule, we get
h(x) (15x 2 14x)(2x 2 x 6) (5x3 7x 2 3)(4x 1)
h(1) [15(1)2 14(1)][2(1)2 (1) 6] [5(1)3
7(1)2 3][4(1) 1]
(1)(7) (5)(3)
8.
The following example illustrates the extension of the Product Rule to more than
two functions.
EXAMPLE 4
143
h(x) [g(x)]2
h(x) g(x)g(x)
The Power of a Function Rule is a special case of the Chain Rule, which we will
discuss later in this chapter. We are now able to differentiate any polynomial,
such as h(x) (x2 3x 5)6 or h(x) (1 x2)4 (2x 6)3, without multiplying
out the brackets.
EXAMPLE 5
EXAMPLE 6
144 C H A P T E R 4
(Product Rule)
(Power of a Function Rule)
At t 2,
v 0 (2)[4(0)(3)]
0.
We conclude that the object is at rest at time t 2.
Notice that if the derivative is required at a particular value of the independent
variable, it is not necessary to simplify before substituting.
Exercise 4.3
Part A
1. Use the Product Rule to differentiate each function. Simplify your answers.
a. h(x) x(x 4)
b. h(x) x 2(2x 1)
d. h(x) (8 x)(4x 6)
e. h(x)
Knowledge/
Understanding
(5x7
1)(x2
2x)
2. Use the Product Rule and the Power of a Function Rule to differentiate the
following. Do not simplify.
a. y (5x 1)3(x 4)
b. y (3x2 4)(3 x 3)5
c. y (1 x2)4(2x 6)3
Communication
145
b. y (x2 2x 1)(x2 2x 1)
7. Use the Extended Product Rule to differentiate the following. Do not simplify.
a. y (x 1)3(x 4)(x 3)2
Communication
8. Find the slope of the tangent to h(x) 2x(x 1)3(x2 2x 1)2 at x 2.
Explain how to find the equation of the normal at x 2.
Part C
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
146 C H A P T E R 4
, then h(x)
If h(x)
g (x)
f (x)g(x) f(x)g(x)
, g(x) 0.
[g(x)]2
du
dv
v u
dx
dx
In Leibniz notation, ddx uv
.
2
v
, g(x)
0.
h(x)
g (x)
h(x)
g(x)
f(x)
g(x)
f (x)
g (x)
g(x)
f (x)g(x) f(x)g(x)
[g(x)]
.
2
The Quotient Rule enables us to differentiate rational functions.
4 . 4 T H E Q U OT I E N T R U L E
147
EXAMPLE 1
3x 4
x 5
.
Find the derivative of h(x)
2
Solution
f(x)
, where f(x) 3x 4 and g(x) x 2 5, we use the
Since h(x)
g (x)
Quotient Rule to find h(x).
(3)(x2 5) (3x 4)(2x)
(x 5)
2
2
3x2 8x 15
(x 5)
.
2
2
EXAMPLE 2
2x
x 1
t chnology
Solution
The slope of the tangent to the
graph of y at any point is given by the
dy
2x
x 1
.
derivative d
x
.
In this case, input y1
2
(2)(x2 1) (2x)(2x)
dy
.
dx
(x2 1)2
At x 0,
(2)(0 1) (0)(0)
dy
2.
dx
(0 1)2
148 C H A P T E R 4
Select
GRAPH
DRAW
ENTER
to
EXAMPLE 3
2x 8
Find the coordinates of each point on the graph of f(x) where the
x
tangent is horizontal.
Solution
The slope of the tangent at any point on the graph is given by f (x).
Using the Quotient Rule,
(2)(x) (2x 8)12x 2
f (x)
(x)2
1
2x 8
2x
2x
x
2x
x 4
x
x
x
x4
.
3
x2
The tangent will be horizontal when f (x) 0, that is, when x 4. The point on
the graph where the tangent is horizontal is (4, 8).
Exercise 4.4
Part A
Communication
Rewrite
x + 3x
, x
0
f(x)
x
5
3x 3
g(x)
,x
0
x
1
10x
h(x) 5 , x
0
3
8x + 6x
, x
0
y
2x
t 9
, t
3
s
t3
2
Communication
4 . 4 T H E Q U OT I E N T R U L E
149
Part B
Knowledge/
Understanding
4. Use the Quotient Rule to differentiate each function. Simplify your answers.
x
a. h(x)
x1
x
b. h(x)
x1
2t 3
c. h(t)
t5
2x 1
d. h(x)
x3
e. h(x)
2
x3
2x 1
x2 x 1
h. y
x2 3
f. h(x)
2
x(3x 5)
1x
g. y
2
1
x 3
x2 1
i. y
x(3x 1)
dy
5. Find d
at the given value of x.
x
3x 2
, x 3
a. y
x5
x2 25
x 25
, x 2
c. y
2
x3
x 9
(x 1)(x 2)
, x 4
d. y
(x 1)(x 2)
, x 1
b. y
2
x3
x 6
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
5x 2
that have a
8. Show that there are no tangents to the graph of f(x)
x2
negative slope.
2x
a. y
x4
Application
b. y
2
x 1
at x 2.
11. Determine the equation of the tangent to the curve y
3x
2
12. A motorboat coasts toward a dock with its engine off. Its distance s, in
metres, from the dock t seconds after the engine is turned off is
10(6 t)
for 0 t 6.
s(t)
t3
150 C H A P T E R 4
ax b
d
, x
, where a, b, c, and d are
13. Consider the function f(x)
c
cx d
The domain of f g is the set of all x in the domain of g such that g(x) is in the
domain of f. We say that g is the inner function and that f is the outer function.
A good way to picture the composition f g is by imagining a machine.
x
(input)
g(x)
f (g(x))
(output)
151
EXAMPLE 1
b. g( f(4))
c. f(g(x))
d. g( f(x))
Solution
a. Since g(4) 9, we have f(g(4)) f(9) 3.
b. Since f(4) 2, we have g( f(4)) g(2) 7. Note: f(g(4))
g( f(4)).
c. f(g(x)) f(x 5)
x5
1x
x2.
1
1x
b. Since g(x) x2, then f(g(x)) f(x2) 2 . Since x2 has been substituted
1
.
for x in f, we conclude that f(x)
1x
Exercise 4.5
Part A
1. Given f(x) x and g(x) x 2 1, find the following:
a. f(g(1))
b. g(f(1))
c. g(f(0))
d. f(g(4))
e. f(g(x))
f. g(f(x))
2. For each of the following pairs of functions, find the composite functions
f g and g f. What is the domain of each composite function? Are the
composite functions equal?
a. f(x) x2
g(x) x
b. f(x) 1x
c. f(x) 1x
g(x) x2 1
g(x)
x2
Part B
1
, and u(x) x
to
3. Use the functions f(x) 3x 1, g(x) x3, h (x)
x1
a. f u
d. u g
b. u h
e. h u
c. g f
f. f g
g. h ( f u)
h. ( f g) u
i. g (h u)
b. h (x)
5x 1
1
c. h(x)
x4
d. h (x) (2 3x) 2
e. h(x) x 4 5x 2 6
5
5. If f(x)
2 x and f(g(x))
2 x3, then what is g(x)?
6. If g(x) x and f(g(x)) (x 7)2, then what is f(x)?
7. Let g(x) x 3. Find a function f so that f(g(x)) x 2.
8. Let f(x) x 2. Find a function g so that f(g(x)) x2 8x 16.
9. Let f(x) x 4 and g(x) (x 2)2. Find a function u so that
f(g(u(x))) 4x 2 8x 8.
1
and g(x) 1 x, determine
10. If f(x)
1x
a. g(f(x))
b. f (g(x))
153
EXAMPLE 1
Solution
3
The inner function is g(x) x 2 x and the outer function is f(x) x 2 .
The derivative of the inner function is g(x) 2x 1.
1
[ f(g(x))] lim
h0
(Property of Limits)
Since
h0
as h 0, we obtain
154 C H A P T E R 4
[ f(g(x))] f (g(x))g(x).
This proof is not valid for all circumstances, since dividing by g(x h) g(x),
we assume g(x h) g(x)
0. A more advanced proof can be found in
advanced calculus texts.
EXAMPLE 2
dy
1
3u2 2 .
x
dy du
dy
1 1
3u2 2 2 x 2
2
du dx
dx
dy
1
1
3(42) 2 (46) 23.
2
dx
4
EXAMPLE 3
4 . 6 T H E D E R I VAT I V E O F A C O M P O S I T E F U N C T I O N
155
Solution
We are asked to find the value of ddC
, when t 3.
t
We can find the value of change by using the Chain Rule.
Therefore,
dC
dC dP
dt
dP dt
1
120.5p2 17 2 (0.5)(2p) (0.2t).
When t 3,
p(3) 3.1 0.1(3)2 4,
so
dC
1
0.5(4)2 17
dt
2
1
2
(0.5)(2(4)) (0.2(3))
0.24.
The carbon monoxide level will be changing at the rate of 0.24 parts per million.
is positive.
This level will be increasing because the sign of ddC
t
EXAMPLE 4
dy
14x(x2 5)6.
Example 4 is a special case of the Chain Rule in which the outer function is a
power function of the form y [g(x)] n. This leads to a generalization of the
Power Rule.
Power of a Function Rule
If n is a real number and u g(x),
then
or
d
du
(un) nun1
dx
dx
n
n1
d
g(x) n g(x)
g(x).
dx
[ ]
[ ]
8
x 4
.
Using graphing technology, sketch the graph of the function f(x)
2
t chnology
Find the equation of the tangent at the point (2, 1) on the graph.
EXAMPLE 5
156 C H A P T E R 4
Solution
From graphing technology, the graph is
2
0.5.
The equation of the tangent is y 1 12(x 2) or x 2y 4 0.
EXAMPLE 6
dy
dy
f (3x 4) 12x3 .
dx
dy
f (3) 12(1)3
dx
When x 1,
(4)(12)
48.
EXAMPLE 7
x
. Express your answer in a simplified factored form.
Differentiate h(x) 3
1 2x
Solution
1
1
x
x
3 , where u is the inner function and u 3 is the
We write h(x)
1 2x
1 2x
outer function.
x
3
Then h(x) 13
1 2x
1 1
d
x
dx 1 2x
(Chain Rule)
2
3
(Quotient Rule)
2
3
.
2
4
3x 3 1 2x 3
4 . 6 T H E D E R I VAT I V E O F A C O M P O S I T E F U N C T I O N
157
Exercise 4.6
Part A
Communication
1. What is the rule for calculating the derivative of the composition of two
differentiable functions? Give examples and show how the derivative is
determined.
2. Differentiate each function. Do not expand any expression before
differentiating.
a. f(x) (2x 3)4
b. y (5 x)6
d. y (7 x3) 5
e. h(x) (2x 2 3x 5) 4
f. y (5x x 2)5
g. f(x) ( 2 x 2) 3
h. y (1 x x 2 x3) 4
j. g(x) (4x 1) 2
k. h(x)
5x 7
l. y
x2 3
1
m. f(x)
(x2 16)5
n. y
2
1
x 4
o. h(x)
p. f(u) 1 u 3
q. y
(2x
5)3
x2
3
r. y
x
1
x 1
1
Part B
Knowledge/
Understanding
b. y 3
1
x 4
e. y 2x
1
5x x
h. y
2
4
a. y 2
d. y
2
g. y
2
2
x
1
c. y
x1
3
9x
f. y 2
1 x
3
i. y
x2
1
(x x 1)
158 C H A P T E R 4
3x 5
1x
b. y 2
3x 2x
d. y
x2 1
f. y
3
g. y x 4(1 4x2)3
h. y
2
(2x 1)2
(x 2)
x2 3 4
x 3
j. h(x) 2
k. s (4 3t3)4(1 2t)6
1
x
l. h(x)
1x
1
x
5. Find the rate of change of each function at the given value of t. Leave your
answers as rational numbers, or in terms of roots and the number .
1
t 3
, t 2
b. s(t)
t 6
2
1
a. s(t) t 3 (4t 5) 3 , t 8
6. For what values of x do the curves y (1 x 3)2 and y 2x 6 have the same
slope?
7. Find the slope of the tangent to the curve y (3x x2)2 at 2, 14.
8. Find the equation of the tangent to the curve y (x3 7)5 at x 2.
dy
c. y 2u3 3u2, u x x 2 , x 1
d. y u(u2 3)3, u (x 3)2, x 2
3
u
, u (x2 1)3, x 1
e. y
u1
1
(1 u )
f. y
, u x 1, x 4
2 2
g. y u5 u3, u 3v 4v, v 3 x2, x 2
dy
x
9
. If g 2, find when x 3.
11. Let y g(h(x)) where h(x)
x2
5
dx
Application
12. Find h(2) given that h (x) f(g(x)), f(u) u2 1, g(2) 3, and g(2) 1.
dy
Part C
Application
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
x 2(1 x)3
(1 x)
15. Differentiate y
.
3
4 . 6 T H E D E R I VAT I V E O F A C O M P O S I T E F U N C T I O N
159
Application
Technology Extension
Numerical derivatives can be approximated on a TI-83 Plus using nDeriv(.
2x
:
To approximate f (0) for f(x)
2
x 1
t chnology
Press
MATH
Press
ENTER
To find the derivative, key in the expression, the variable, the value at
which we want the derivative, and a value for .
For this example, the display will be nDeriv( 2x/(x2 1), x, 0, .01).
Press
ENTER
iv) f(x) x3 6x at x 2
vi) f(x) (x2 1)(2x 1)4 at x 0
x2 1
x x2
at x 1
viii) f(x)
2
The TI-89 and TI-92 can find exact symbolic and numerical deriviatives. If you
have access to either model, try some of the above questions and compare your
answers to those found using a TI-83 Plus. Press DIFFERENTIATE under the
CALCULATE
160 C H A P T E R 4
ENTER
f(x) f (a)
.
by f (a) lim
xa
xa
f(x h) f(x)
The normal at point P is the line that is perpendicular to the tangent at point P.
For two functions f and g, the composite function f g is defined by
( f g)(x) f (g(x)).
Function Notation
Leibniz Notation
Constant
f(x) k, f(x) 0
d
(k) 0
dx
Linear
f(x) x, f(x) 1
d
(x) 1
dx
Constant Multiple
dy
d
(ky) k
dx
dx
Sum or Difference
d
d
d
[f(x) g(x)] f(x) g(x)
dx
dx
dx
h(x) f(x)g(x)
Product
Quotient
h(x)
g (x)
f (x)g(x) f(x)g(x)
h(x)
[g(x)]2
dx
dx
d f(x)
dx (x)
[g(x)]2
dy
dy
dy du
, where u is a function of x.
dx
du dx
dy
y un, d
nun1ddu
,
x
x
where u is a function of x.
Chain
y f(g(x)),d
f (g(x))g(x)
x
General Power
y [f(x)]n, d
n[f(x)]n1f (x)
x
dy
161
wrap-up
CHAPTER 4: THE ELASTICITY OF DEMAND
An electronics retailing chain has established the monthly price (p) demand
(nd ) relationship for a NintendoTM game as
4
(p 1) 3
p
nd (p) 1000 10
.
3
They are trying to set a price level that will provide maximum revenue (R). They
know that when demand is elastic (E 1), a drop in price will result in higher
overall revenues (R nd p) and that when demand is inelastic (E 1), an increase
in price will result in higher overall revenues. To complete the questions in this
task, you will have to use the elasticity definition of
E
nd
nd
p
p
n
converted into differential
ddnp notation.
p
a. Determine the elasticity of demand at $20 and $80, classifying these price
points as having elastic or inelastic demand. What does this say about where
the optimum price is in terms of generating the maximum revenue? Explain.
Also calculate the revenue at the $20 and $80 price points.
b. Approximate the demand curve as a linear function (tangent) at a price point
of $50. Plot the demand function and its linear approximation on the graphing
calculator. What do you notice? Explain this by looking at the demand
function.
c. Use your linear approximation to determine the price point that will generate
the maximum revenue. (Hint: Think about the specific value of E where you
wont want to increase or decrease the price to generate higher revenues.)
What revenue is generated at this price level?
d. A second game has a pricedemand relationship of
12 500
.
nd (p)
p 25
The price is currently set at $50. Should the company increase or decrease
the price? Explain.
162 C H A P T E R 4
Review Exercise
1. Describe the process of finding a derivative using the definition for f (x).
2. Use the definition of the derivative to find f (x) of each of the following
functions:
i) y 2x2 5x
x
iii) y
4x
ii) y
x6
b. y 8 x 3
d. y 5x4
e. y 4
1
x 5
3
c. f(x) x 4
7
3x
1
f. y
x3
3
(3 x )
g. y
2
h. y
2 2
i. y
2x
j. y
7x2
4x 1
k. y (5x4 )3
l. y x4 x 3 4
2
5
4. Find the derivative of the given function. In some cases, it will save time
if you rearrange the function before differentiating.
2x 3 1
x
8
c. h (x)
3xx
x
e. y
3x 5
a. f(x)
2
3 1x
d. y
x
f. y
x 1(x 1)
2
3
g. f(x) (x 2)
h. y
(x 3
)(x 3)
x 5x 4
i. y
x4
x 27
j. y
x3
b. y x
x2 1
x
c. y
3
d. y
3 2
x 5
10x 1
e. y
3x 5
(x2 1)3
(x 1)
3
f. y
2
g. y
2
h. y (x 2)3(x2 9)4
i. y (1 x2)3(6 2x)3
j. y (3x2 2)2
x2 5
x 1
REVIEW EXERCISE
163
a. g(x) f(x2)
dy
18
x 5
, find when x 2.
7. a. If y 5u2 3u 1 and u
2
dx
u4
x x
and u , find when x 4.
b. If y
u4
10
dx
dy
dy
c. If y f(
x2 9) and f (5) 2, find d
when x 4.
x
2
8. Find the slope of the line tangent to the graph of f(x) (9 x2) 3
at point (1, 4).
e
t chnology
t chnology
9. For what values of x does the curve y x 3 6x2 have a slope of 12?
Of 15? Use a graphing calculator to graph the function and confirm your
results.
10. a. Find the values of x where the given graph has a horizontal tangent.
i) y (x2 4)5
b. Use a graphing calculator to graph the function and its tangent at the point
to confirm your result.
11. Find the equation of the tangent to each function at the point given.
a. y (x2 5x 2)4 at (0, 16)
t chnology
x3
x 6
.
14. a. Using a graphing calculator, graph the function f(x)
2
164 C H A P T E R 4
5
2
(a, f (a))
REVIEW EXERCISE
165
Chapter 4 Test
Achievement Category
Questions
Knowledge/Understanding
37
Thinking/Inquiry/Problem Solving
11
Communication
1, 2
Application
810
4 y
2
x
4 3 2 1
2
1 2 3 4
4. Find d
for each of the following:
x
a. y 13x 3 3x5 4
b. y 6(2x 9)5
x
c. y 6x
3
x2 6 5
x
e. y x2
6x2 7 Simplify your answer.
4x5 5x 4 6x 2
x
f. y
Simplify your answer.
4
5. Find the slope of the tangent to the graph of y (x2 3x 2)(7 3x)
at (1, 8).
166 C H A P T E R 4
dy
6. Find d
at x 2 for y 3u2 2u and u
x2 5.
x
7. Find the equation of the tangent to y (3x2 2x3)5 at point (1, 1).
8. The amount of pollution in a certain lake is P(t) t 4 3 , where t is
1
CHAPTER 4 TEST
167
Cumulative Review
CHAPTERS 14
b. x3 5x2 4x 20
c. 2x3 x2 8x 4
b. x4 5x2 36 0
c. x3 4x2 x 6 0
d. 2x3 x2 2x 1 0
e. x3 x2 5x 3 0
f. 3x3 4x2 4x 1 0
168 C H A P T E R 4
b. (x 2)(x 1)(x 3) 0
b. 2x 3 5
c. 3x 1 16
y = f(x)
lim f (x) 8.
x2
20.
x2 1, x 2
f (x) = 2x 1, x 2
x 5, x 2
Determine where f (x) is discontinuous and justify your answer.
x4 2x3 2x2 2x 3
21. Use your graphing calculator to estimate lim
.
x2 2x 3
x1
(4 h)3 64
is the slope of the tangent to y f(x) at x = 4, what is
22. If lim
h
h0
f (x)?
C U M U L AT I V E R E V I E W C H A P T E R S 1 - 4
169
23. Use algebraic methods to evaluate each of the following (if they exist):
1
1
x
3
2x2 1
a. lim
x0 x 5
1
b. lim
x5 x 5
c. lim
x 4x 2x
d. lim
5
3
x0 3x 2x x
x2
e. lim
3
x2 x 8
x12
f. lim
x3
x3
x3
x3
b. f(x) 1x.
25. Use any of the rules you have learned to find the derivatives of the following
functions:
a. y x3 4x2 5x 2
b. y
2x3 1
2x
c. y
x3
(4x2 1)5
e. y
(3x 2)3
18
at point (1, 2).
26. Find the equation of the tangent to y
(x 2)2
1
, find .
28. If y 6u3 2u2 5u 2 and u
x3 2
dx
29. Find the slope of the tangent to y x2 9x 9 at the point where the curve
intersects the line at y 3x.
30. In 1980, the population of Smalltown, Ontario, was 1100. After a time t, in
years, the population is given by p(t) 2t2 6t 1100.
a. Find p(t), the function that describes the rate of change of the population.
b. Find the rate of change of the population in 1990.
c. In what year is the rate of change of the population 94 people per year?
170 C H A P T E R 4
Chapter 5
A P P L I C AT I O N S O F
D E R I VAT I V E S
We live in a world that is always in flux. Sir Isaac
Newtons name for calculus was the method of
fluxions. He recognized in the 17th century, as you
probably recognize today, that understanding
change is important. Newton was what we might
call a mathematical physicist. He developed his
method of fluxions as a means to better understand
the natural world, including motion and gravity. But
change is not limited to the natural world, and since
Newtons time, the use of calculus has spread to
include applications in the social sciences. Psychology, business, and economics are just a few of the
areas in which calculus has been an effective
problem-solving tool. As we shall see in this chapter,
anywhere that functions can be used as models, the
derivative is certain to be meaningful and useful.
CHAPTER EXPECTATIONS In this chapter, you will
C 2r, A r2
Sphere:
S 4r2, V 43r3
V 13r2h
Exercise
1. Sketch the graph of each function.
a. 2x 3y 6 0
b. 3x 4y 12
c. y x
d. y
x2
e. y x2 4
f. y x2 9
b. (x 2)2 (y 3)2 9
c. (x 4)2 (y 1)2 49
3. Draw each of the following ellipses:
a. 4x2 9y2 36
b. x2 4y2 100
(x 4)2
(y 1)2
1
c.
49
4
b. 4x2 9y2 36
5. Solve x, t R.
172 C H A P T E R 5
c. x2 4y2 100
a. 3(x 2) 2(x 1) 6 0
x5
b. 13(x 2) 25(x 3)
2
c. t 2 4t 3 0
d. 2t 2 5t 3 0
e. 6t 2t 4
g. x3 8x2 16x 0
f. x3 2x2 3x 0
h. 4t3 12t 2 t 3 0
i. 4t 4 13t 2 9 0
6. Solve each inequality, x R.
a. 3x 2 7
c. x2 4x 0
b. x(x 3) 0
7. Find the area of the figure described. Leave your answers in terms of .
a. Square: perimeter 20 cm
b. Rectangle: length 8 cm, width 6 cm
c. Circle: radius 7 cm
d. Circle: circumference 12 cm
8. Two measures of a right circular cylinder are given. Find the two remaining
measures.
Radius r
Height h
a.
4 cm
3 cm
b.
4 cm
Volume
V r2h
96 cm3
c.
d.
Surface Area
S 2rh + 2r 2
216 cm3
6 cm
120 cm2
5 cm
9 cm
b.
3 cm
Volume
V 43 r 3
Surface Area
S = 4r 2
36 cm3
c.
1000 cm2
d.
10. Two measures of a right circular cone are given. Find the remaining measure.
r
a.
4 cm
3 cm
b.
3 cm
V 13 r 2h
27 cm3
c.
4 cm
27 cm3
11. Find the total surface area and volume of a cube with each of the following
dimensions:
a. 3 cm
b. 5 cm
c. 23 cm
d. 2k cm
173
investigate
CHAPTER 5: MAXIMIZING PROFITS
We live in a world that demands we determine the best, the worst, the
maximum, and the minimum. Through mathematical modelling, calculus
can be used to establish optimum operating conditions for processes
that seem to have competing variables. For example, minimizing
transportation costs for a delivery truck would seem to require the driver
to travel as fast as possible to reduce hourly wages. Higher rates of
speed, however, increase the cost of gas consumption. With calculus, an
optimal speed can be established that minimizes the total cost of driving
the delivery vehicle considering both gas consumption and hourly
wages. In this chapter, calculus tools will be utilized in realistic contexts
to solve optimization problems from business applications (e.g.,
minimizing cost) to psychology (e.g., maximizing learning).
TR, TC, TP
Make a rough sketch of the graph in your notes and answer the following questions:
1. What range of sales would keep the company profitable? What do we call
these values?
2. Superimpose the total profit (TP) curve over the TR and TC curves. What would
the sales level have to be for maximum profits to occur? Estimate the slopes on
the TR and TC curves at this level of sales. Should they be the same?
Why or why not?
3. On a set of separate axes, draw a rough sketch of the marginal profit
MP ddTxP , the extra profit earned by selling one more box of chocolates.
What can you say about the marginal profit as the level of sales progress from
just less than the maximum to the maximum to just above the maximum? Does
this make sense? Explain.
174 C H A P T E R 5
Since there are x-values that correspond to two y-values, y is not a function of x
on the entire circle. Solving for y gives y
25 x2, where y
25 x2
2
represents the upper semicircle and y
25 x is the lower semicircle.
The given relation defines two different functions of x.
y
x
O
x
O
x2 y2 25
x
O
y
25 x2
y
25 x2
Consider the problem of finding the slope of the tangent line to the circle
x2 y2 25 at the point (3, 4). Since this point lies on the lower semicircle,
we could differentiate the function y
25 x2 and substitute x 3.
An alternative, which avoids having to solve for y explicitly in terms of x, is to
use the method of implicit differentiation. Example 1 illustrates this method.
EXAMPLE 1
b. Find the slope of the tangent line to the circle x2 y2 25 at the point
(3, 4).
Solution
a. Differentiate both sides of the equation with respect to x:
d
d
(x2 y2) (25)
dx
dx
d
d
d
(x2) (y2) (25)
dx
dx
dx
2y d
x
5 . 1 I M P L I C I T D I F F E R E N T I AT I O N
175
2x 2yd
0
x
dy
x
.
y
dx
and
The derivative in part a depends on both x and y. At the point (3, 4), x 3
and y 4.
The slope of the tangent line to x2 y2 25
y
dy
at (3, 4) is d
4 4 .
x
4
2
x
2
4
(3, 4)
EXAMPLE 2
dy
Find d
for 2xy y3 4.
x
Solution
We differentiate both sides of the equation with respect to x as follows:
d
d
d
(2xy) (y3) (4).
dx
dx
dx
Use the Product Rule to differentiate the first term and the Chain Rule for the
second.
dy
dy
dy
2y 2x d
3y2 d
0
x
x
dy
(2x 3y2)d
2y
x
2y
dy
2
2x 3y
dx
176 C H A P T E R 5
dy
Note that implicit differentiation leads to a derivative whenever the derivative does
not have a zero in the denominator. The derivative expression usually includes
terms in both x and y.
EXAMPLE 3
Find the slope of the tangent to the ellipse x2 4y2 25 at the point (3, 2).
Illustrate the tangent on the graph of the ellipse.
Solution
Differentiating implicitly with respect to x, we obtain
2x 42y d
0 or 2x 8y d
0.
x
x
dy
dy
dy
0
2(3) 8(2)d
x
dy
6
16
dx
(3, 2)
x 2 + 4y 2 = 25
x
38 .
Therefore, the slope of the tangent to the
ellipse at (3, 2) is 38.
e
t chnology
y
First, graph y1
.
4
25 x2
25 x2
as
((25
x2) 4)
.
4
5 . 1 I M P L I C I T D I F F E R E N T I AT I O N
177
Step 2.
25 x
, select y2 and then select the
To graph y
4
VARS
function.
Then select Y-VARS and press ENTER twice.
Then select GRAPH .
2
Use xmin 9.4, xmax 9.4, ymin 6.4, and ymax 6.4
as your window.
Step 3.
Exercise 5.1
Part A
Communication
Knowledge/
Understanding
2. Find d
for each of the following in terms of x and y using implicit
x
differentiation.
a. x2 y2 36
b. y2 x2 16
c. 15y2 2x3
d. 3xy2 y3 8
e. 5y4 x3 13
3y2
2
g. 1x6 13 1
j. x3 y3 6xy
h. 3x2 4xy3 9
i. x2 y2 5y 10
k. x3y3 144
l. x y y5
m. xy3 x3y 2
n. x y 5
o. (x y)2 x2 y2
3. For each curve, find the equation of the tangent at the given point.
a. x2 y2 13 at (2, 3)
y2
2
1 at (53, 12)
c. 2x5 3
6
Part B
4. At what point is the tangent to the curve x y2 1 parallel to the line
x 2y 0?
178 C H A P T E R 5
at (1, 1).
a. Find d
x
b. Find two points on the ellipse at which the tangent is horizontal.
Application
6. Find the slope of the tangent to the ellipse 5x2 y2 21 at point A(2, 1).
7. Find the equation of the normal at (2, 3) to the curve x3 y3 3xy 17 at
point (2, 3).
3
x
at point (1, 1).
8. Find the equation of the normal to y2
2x
.
a. Use implicit differentiation to find d
x
dy
t chnology
10. Graph each relation using a graphing calculator or a computer. For each
graph, decide the number of tangents that exist at x 1.
a. y
3x
b. y
5x
c. y x7 x
d. x3 4x2 (x 4)y2 0 (This curve is known as the strophoid.)
10, x y 0, .
11. Show that for the relation xy
x
dx
x
y
dy
Part C
12. Find the equations of the lines that are tangent to the ellipse x2 4y2 16
and that also pass through the point (4, 6).
13. The angle between two intersecting curves is defined as the angle between
their tangents at the point of intersection. If this angle is 90, the two curves
are said to be orthogonal. Prove that the curves defined by x2 y2 k and
xy p intersect orthogonally for all values of the constants k and p. Illustrate
your proof with a sketch.
14. Let l be any tangent to the curve x y k. Show that the sum of the
intercepts of l is k.
15. Two circles of radius 32 are tangent to the graph y2 4x at point (1, 2).
Find the equations of these two circles.
5 . 1 I M P L I C I T D I F F E R E N T I AT I O N
179
Higher-Order Derivatives
The derivative of 10x4 with respect to x is 40x3. If we differentiate 40x3, we obtain
120x2. This new function is called the second derivative of 10x4.
dy
For y 2x3 5x2, the first derivative is d
6x2 10x and the second
x
d 2y
12x 10.
derivative is
dx2
Note the location of the superscripts in the second derivative. The reason for this
choice of notation is that the second derivative is the derivative of the first
d 2y
.
derivative; that is, we write d
x dx
dx2
d dy
Other notations used to represent first and second derivatives of y f (x) are
dy
d 2y
f(x) y and
f (x) y
dx
dx2
EXAMPLE 1
x
at x 1.
Find the second derivative of f (x)
1x
Solution
x
using the Quotient Rule.
Differentiate f(x)
1x
(1)(1 x) x(1)
f (x)
(1 x)2
1xx
(1 x)2
1
(1 x)2
(1 x)2
180 C H A P T E R 5
2
At x 1, f (1)
(1 1)3
2
8
14.
ds
.
v ddst and a ddvt
dt2
The dimensions of velocity are length divided by time; typical units are m/s.
The dimensions of acceleration are length divided by (time)2; typical units
are m/s2.
If v(t) 0, the object is moving to the right, and if v(t)
0, it is moving to the
left. If v(t) 0, the object is stationary, or at rest. The object is accelerating if the
product of a(t) and v(t) is positive and decelerating if the product is negative.
5 . 2 H I G H E R - O R D E R D E R I VAT I V E S, V E L O C I T Y, A N D A C C E L E R AT I O N
181
EXAMPLE 2
s(t)
t
1 2 3 4 5 6
Solution
The object is moving to the right whenever s(t) is increasing, or v(t) 0.
From the graph, s(t) is increasing for 0
t
2 and for t 6.
For 2
t
6, the value of s(t) is decreasing, so the object is moving to the left.
At t 6, the direction of motion of the object changes from left to right, so the
object is stationary at t 6.
The motion of the object along the distance lines can be illustrated by the
following diagram:
t=6
s=0
t=2
s=6
t=0
s=0
0
EXAMPLE 3
s
8
At
(Divide by 3)
12
v(t)
t
2
interval 0
t
4.
EXAMPLE 4
Discuss the motion of an object moving on a horizontal line if its position is given
by s(t) t 2 10t, 0 t 12, where s is in metres and t is in seconds. Include
the initial velocity, final velocity, and any acceleration in your discussion.
Solution
The initial position of the object occurs at time t 0. Since s(0) 0, the object
starts at the origin.
5 . 2 H I G H E R - O R D E R D E R I VAT I V E S, V E L O C I T Y, A N D A C C E L E R AT I O N
183
14
v(t)
v(t) s(t) 2t 10
2(t 5).
v(t) = 2t 10
2(t 5) 0
t5
v(t) 0 for 5
t 12, therefore the object is
moving to the right.
12
10
v(t)
0 if 0 t
5, therefore the object is
moving to the left.
The initial velocity is v(0) 10.
At t 12, v(12) 14.
The acceleration at time t is
a(t) v(t) s(t) 2.
The object moves to the left for 0 t
5 and to the right for 5
t 12.
The initial velocity is 10 m/s, the final velocity is 14 m/s, and the acceleration is
2 m/s2.
The following diagram is a schematic of the motion. (The actual path of the
object is back and forth on a line.)
t=5
s = 25
t = 12
s = 24
t=0
s=0
25 20 15 10
s
10 15
20
25
A fly ball is hit vertically upward. The position function s(t), in metres, of the ball
is s(t) 5t2 30t 1 where t is in seconds.
a. Find the maximum height reached by the ball.
b. Find the velocity of the ball when it is caught 1 m above the ground.
Solution
a. The maximum height occurs when the velocity of the ball is zero, that is, when
the slope of the tangent to the graph is zero.
184 C H A P T E R 5
(3, 46)
46
Position of
ball when
t = 1 and 5
Ground
level
s(t)
26
t
1
5 6
Exercise 5.2
Part A
Communication
Knowledge/
Understanding
b. f(x) x
c. y (1 x)2
3. For the following position functions, each of which describes the motion of an
object along a straight line, find the velocity and acceleration as functions of
t, t 0.
5 . 2 H I G H E R - O R D E R D E R I VAT I V E S, V E L O C I T Y, A N D A C C E L E R AT I O N
185
a. s(t) 5t2 3t 15
c. s(t) t 8 6t
d. s(t) (t 3)2
e. s(t)
t1
9t
f. s(t)
t3
b.
2
1
2
1
t
1 2
1 2
186 C H A P T E R 5
9. An object moves in a straight line, and its position, s, in metres after t seconds
is s(t) 8 7t t2.
a. Find the velocity when t 5.
b. Find the acceleration when t 5.
Application
5
b. s t3 12t 9
5 . 2 H I G H E R - O R D E R D E R I VAT I V E S, V E L O C I T Y, A N D A C C E L E R AT I O N
187
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
16. Newtons laws of motion imply simple formulas for s(t) and v(t), and the
functions of altitude (in metres) and vertical velocity (in m/s): altitude is
s(t) s0 v0t 5t2, and vertical velocity is v(t) v0 10t, where s0 is the
metres above ground, and v0 is the upward velocity at t 0. According to the
1998 Guinness Book of Records, the roof of the SkyDome in Toronto,
Ontario, is the worlds only retractable roof. It covers 3.2 ha (8 acres), spans
209 m at its widest point, and rises 86 m. It takes 20 min to retract the
roof fully.
Could a major-league pitcher hit the 86 m ceiling of the SkyDome?
Hint: Assume the pitcher can throw the ball horizontally at 50 m/s, at about
35 m/s straight up, and that he throws the ball from the pitchers mound.
Part C
17. An elevator is designed to start from a resting position without a jerk.
It can do this if the acceleration function is continuous.
0,
if t
0
a. Show that for the position function s(t) t3
, the accelera, if t 0
t2 1
tion is continuous at t 0.
b. What happens to the velocity and acceleration for very large values of t?
18. An object moves so that its velocity, v, is related to its position, s, according
b2 2gs
, where b and g are constants. Show that the acceleration
to v
of the object is constant.
19. Newtons law of motion for a particle of mass m moving in a straight line
says that F ma, where F is the force acting on the particle and a is the
acceleration of the particle. In relativistic mechanics, this law is replaced by
m0 ddt v
ma
0
and c is the velocity of light. Show that F
.
v 2 3
1 (c)
188 C H A P T E R 5
EXAMPLE 1
When a raindrop falls into a still puddle, ripples spread out in concentric circles
from the point where the raindrop hits. The radii of these circles grow at the rate
of 3 cm/s.
a. Find the rate of increase of the circumference of one circle.
b. Find the rate of increase of the area of the circle that has an area
of 81 cm2.
Solution
The circumference of a circle is C 2r, and the area of a circle is A r2.
We are given that ddrt 3.
at any time, it is necessary to differentiate the equation
a. To find ddC
t
C 2r with respect to t.
dC
dr
2
dt
dt
At time t, since
dr
3,
dt
dC
2(3)
dt
6.
Therefore, the circumference is increasing at a constant rate of 6 cm/s.
b. To find ddAt , differentiate A r2 with respect to t.
dA
dr
2r
dt
dt
5 . 3 R E L AT E D R AT E S
189
r2 81
r2 81
r 9, r 0,
and
dA
2(9)(3)
dt
54.
EXAMPLE 2
Many related-rate problems involve right triangles and the Pythagorean Theorem.
In these problems, the lengths of the sides of the triangle vary with time. These
quantities and related rates can be represented quite simply on the Cartesian
plane.
C
S
r
y
A
Solution
Let x represent the distance Natalies car has travelled along AB, and let y
represent the distance Shannon has travelled along AC.
Therefore ddxt 45 and ddyt 40.
Let r represent the distance between the two cars at time t.
Therefore, x2 y2 r2.
Differentiate both sides of the equation with respect to time.
or
d
d
d
(x2) (y2) (r2)
dt
dt
dt
2xddxt 2y ddyt 2r ddrt
xddxt yddyt rddrt
1
190 C H A P T E R 5
EXAMPLE 3
Since we want to find ddht when h 8, we solve for r in terms of h from the ratio
or r 12h.
determined from the similar triangles hr 15
0
10
V 13 12h h
V 13 14h2h
h3.
V 11
2
r
10
h
Therefore, at the moment when the depth of the water is 8 m, the level is rising
at 0.0625 m/min.
5 . 3 R E L AT E D R AT E S
191
EXAMPLE 4
A student 1.6 m tall walks directly away from a lamppost at a rate of 1.2 m/s.
A light is situated 8 m above the ground on the lamppost. Show that the students
shadow is lengthening at a rate of 0.3 m/s when she is 20 m from the base of the
lamppost.
Solution
Let x be the length of her shadow and y be the
distance she is from the lamppost, in metres,
as shown. Let t denote the time, in seconds.
dy
1.6
y
x
xy
1.6
8
1.6x 1.6y 8x
1.6y 6.4x
dy
Therefore, her shadow is lengthening at 0.3 m/s. (Note that the shadow is lengthening at a constant rate, independent of her distance from the lamppost.)
Guidelines for Solving Related-Rate Problems
1. Make a sketch and label the quantities, if applicable.
2. Introduce variables to represent the quantities that change.
3. Identify the quantities to be determined.
4. Find an equation that relates the variables.
5. Implicitly differentiate both sides of the equation with respect to time t,
regarding all variables as functions of t.
6. Substitute into the differentiated equation all known values for the variables
and their rates of change.
7. Solve the equation for the required rate of change.
8. Write a conclusion that includes the units.
192 C H A P T E R 5
Exercise 5.3
Part A
Communication
Application
7. Oil spilled from a ruptured tanker spreads in a circle whose area increases at
a constant rate of 6 km2/h. How fast is the radius of the spill increasing when
the area is 9 km2?
5 . 3 R E L AT E D R AT E S
193
8. The top of a 5 m wheeled ladder rests against a vertical wall. If the bottom
of the ladder rolls away from the base of the wall at a rate of 13 m/s, how fast
is the top of the ladder sliding down the wall when it is 3 m above the base of
the wall?
9. How fast must someone let out line if the kite that she is flying is 30 m high,
40 m away from her horizontally, and continuing to move away from her
horizontally at the rate of 10 m/min?
10. If the rocket shown in the figure is rising
vertically at 268 m/s when it is 1220 m up,
how fast is the camera-to-rocket distance
changing at that instant?
e
nc
ista
d
t
ke
roc
to
ra
me
a
C
Launching pad
915 m
11. Two cyclists depart at the same time from a starting point along routes making
radians with each other. The first is travelling at 15 km/h, while
an angle of
3
the second is moving at 20 km/h. How fast are the two cyclists moving apart
after 2 h?
12. A spherical balloon is being filled with helium at a rate of 8 cm3/s. At what
rate is its radius increasing
a. when the radius is 12 cm?
b. when the volume is 1435 cm3? (Your answer should be correct to the
nearest hundredth.)
c. when it has been filling for 33.5 s?
13. A cylindrical tank with height 15 m and diameter 2 m is being filled with
gasoline at a rate of 500 L/min. At what rate is the fluid level in the tank
rising? (1 L 1000 cm3). About how long will it take to fill the tank?
Communication
14. If V r2h, find ddVt if r and h are both variables. In your journal,
write three problems that involve the rate of change of the volume of a
cylinder such that
i) r is a variable and h is a constant;
ii) r is a constant and h is a variable;
iii) r and h are both variables.
15. The trunk of a tree is approximately cylindrical in shape and has a diameter
of 1 m when the height is 15 m. If the radius is increasing at 0.003 m per
194 C H A P T E R 5
annum and the height is increasing at 0.4 m per annum, find the rate of
increase of the volume of the trunk.
16. A conical paper cup of radius 5 cm and height 15 cm is leaking water at the
rate of 2 cm3/min. At what rate is the level of water decreasing when the
water is 3 cm deep?
17. Derive the formula for the volume of a trough whose cross-section is an
equilateral triangle and whose length is 10 m.
18. The cross-section of a water trough is an equilateral
triangle with a horizontal top edge. If the trough is 5 m
long and 25 cm deep, and water is flowing in at a rate of
0.25 m3/min, how fast is the water level rising when
the water is 10 cm deep at the deepest point?
19. The shadow cast by a man standing 1 m from a lamppost is 1.2 m long.
If the man is 1.8 m tall and walks away from the lamppost at a speed of
120 m/min, at what rate is the shadow lengthening after 5 s?
Part C
20. A railroad bridge is 20 m above, and at right angles to, a river. A person in a
train travelling at 60 km/h passes over the centre of the bridge at the same
instant that a person in a motorboat travelling at 20 km/h passes under the
centre of the bridge. How fast are the two people separating 10 s later?
21. Liquid is being poured into the top of a funnel at a steady rate of 200 cm3/s.
The funnel is in the shape of an inverted right circular cone with a radius
equal to its height. It has a small hole in the bottom where the liquid is
flowing out at a rate of 20 cm3/s. How fast is the height of the liquid changing
when the liquid in the funnel is 15 cm deep?
At the instant when the height of the liquid is 25 cm, the funnel becomes
clogged at the bottom and no more liquid flows out. How fast does the height
of the liquid change just after this occurs?
22. A ladder of length l standing on level ground is leaning against a vertical wall.
The base of the ladder begins to slide away from the wall. Introduce a coordinate system so that the wall lies along the y-axis, the ground is on the x-axis,
and the base of the wall is the origin.
What is the equation of the path followed by the midpoint of the ladder? What
is the equation of the path followed by any point on the ladder? (Hint: Let k
be the distance from the top of the ladder to the point in question.)
23. A ball is dropped from a height of 20 m, 12 m away from the top of a 20 m
lamppost. The balls shadow, created by the light at the top of the lamppost,
is moving along the level ground. How fast is the shadow moving one second
after the ball is released?
5 . 3 R E L AT E D R AT E S
195
The purpose of this investigation is to determine how the derivative can be used in
determining the maximum (largest) value or the minimum (smallest) value of
a function on a given interval.
1. For each of the following functions, determine, by completing the square, the
value of x that produces a maximum or minimum function value on the given
interval.
a. f(x) x2 6x 3, interval 0 x 5
b. f(x) x2 2x 11, interval 3 x 4
c. f(x) 4x2 12x 7, interval 1 x 4
2. For each function, determine the value of c such that f (c) 0.
3. Compare the values obtained in Questions 1 and 2 for each function.
t chnology
APPENDIX P. 444
4. Using your calculator, graph each of the following functions and determine all
values of x that produce a maximum or minimum function value on the given
interval.
a. f(x) x3 3x2 8x 10, interval 2 x 4
b. f(x) x3 12x 5, interval 3 x 3
c. f(x) 3x3 15x2 9x 23, interval 0 x 4
d. f(x) 2x3 12x 7, interval 2 x 2
e. f(x) x3 2x2 15x 23, interval 4 x 3
5. For each function in Question 4, determine all values of c such that f(c) 0.
6. Compare the values obtained in Questions 4 and 5 for each function.
t chnology
7. From your conclusions in Questions 3 and 6, state a method for using the
derivative of a function to determine values of the variable that determine
maximum or minimum values of the function.
8. Repeat Question 4 for the following functions, using the indicated intervals.
a. f(x) x2 6x 3, interval 4 x 8
b. f(x) 4x2 12x 7, interval 2 x 6
c. f(x) x3 3x2 9x 10, interval 2 x 6
d. f(x) x3 12x 5, interval 0 x 5
e. f(x) x3 5x2 3x 7, interval 2 x 5
196 C H A P T E R 5
Max
Max
Max
Min
Min
Min
EXAMPLE 1
Find the extreme values of the function f(x) 2x3 9x2 4 on the interval
1 x 5.
Solution
The derivative is f (x) 6x2 18x.
If we set
so
f (x) 0, we obtain
6x(x 3) 0,
x 0 or x 3.
5 . 4 M A X I M U M A N D M I N I M U M O N A N I N T E R VA L
197
We can then evaluate f(x) for these values and at the end points x 1
and x 5, to obtain
f(1) 15
f(0) 4
f(3) 31
f(5) 21.
Therefore, the maximum value of f(x) on the interval 1 x 5 is f(3) 31,
and the minimum value is f(5) 21.
EXAMPLE 2
dC
0, we obtain
dt
3t2 2t 21 0
(3t 7)(t 3) 0,
t 73 or 3.
therefore,
Solution
Note that the function is not defined for t 2. Since this value is not in the
given interval, we need not worry about it.
The derivative is
198 C H A P T E R 5
2t 6t 4 t 2t 16
(t 2)2
2
t 4t 12
.
(t 2)2
2
Note that the calculation can be greatly reduced by rewriting the function,
as shown:
16
t 2t
I(t)
t2
t2
2
t 16(t 2)1.
I(t) 1 16(t 2)2
Then
16
.
1
(t 2)2
Setting
I(t) 0 gives
16
1
(t 2)2
t2 4t 4 16
t2 4t 12 0.
As before, t 6 or t 2.
The evaluations are also simplified:
I(0) 0 8 8
6
6
I(2) 2 14
6
15.
I(14) 14 11
6
5 . 4 M A X I M U M A N D M I N I M U M O N A N I N T E R VA L
199
Exercise 5.4
Part A
Communication
2. State the value of the maximum and the minimum for each function. In each
of the following graphs, the function is defined in the interval shown.
a.
10
b.
30
g(x)
20
4
10
x
4
4
4
10
8
20
12
c.
d.
f(t)
h(x)
100
20
10
t
10
10
2
2
10
100
20
200 C H A P T E R 5
Knowledge/
Understanding
t chnology
3. Find the maximum or minimum value of each function on the given interval,
using the algorithm for maximum or minimum values. Illustrate your results
by sketching the graph of each function.
a. f(x) x2 4x 3, 0 x 3
b. f(x) (x 2)2, 0 x 2
c. f(x) x3 3x2, 1 x 3
d. f(x) x3 3x2, 2 x 1
e. f(x) 2x3 3x2 12x 1, 2 x 0
f. f(x) 13x3 52x2 6x, 0 x 4
Part B
4. Find the extreme values of each function on the given
interval, using the algorithm for maximum or minimum values.
a. f(x) x 4x, 1 x 10
b. f(x) 4x x, 2 x 9
1
, 0 x 2
c. f(x)
x2 2x 2
4t
, t 0.
b. Repeat part a if v(t)
1 t2
Application
a. If the speed limit is 100 km/h, find the legal speed that will maximize the
fuel efficiency.
b. Repeat part a using a speed limit of 50 km/h.
5 . 4 M A X I M U M A N D M I N I M U M O N A N I N T E R VA L
201
is the number of hours after the medicine is taken. Find the maximum and
minimum concentrations between the first and sixth hours after the patient is
given the medicine.
9. Technicians working for the Ministry of Natural Resources have found that
the amount of a pollutant in a certain river can be represented by
1
, 0 t 1, where t is the time (in years) since
P(t) 2t
(162t 1)
a clean-up campaign started. At what time was the pollution at its lowest
level?
10. A truck travelling at x km/h, where 30 x 120, uses gasoline at the rate
1 4900
x. If fuel costs $0.45/L, what
of r(x) L/km, where r(x)
400 x
speed will result in the lowest fuel cost for a trip of 200 km? What is the
lowest total cost for the trip?
Part C
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
11. In a certain manufacturing process, when the level of production is x units, the
cost of production (in dollars) is C(x) 3000 9x 0.05x2, 1 x 300.
C(x)
? Keep in
What level of production x will minimize the unit cost U(x)
x
mind that the production level must be an integer.
202 C H A P T E R 5
x
Road
The domain of the function is 0 x 400 since the amount of fencing is 800 m.
To find the minimum and maximum values, determine A(x):
A(x) 800 4x.
Setting A(x) 0, we obtain 800 4x 0
x 200.
The minimum and maximum values can occur at x 200 or at the ends of the
domain, x 0 and x 400.
5 . 5 O P T I M I Z AT I O N P R O B L E M S
203
A(0) 0
A(200) 200(800 400)
80 000
A(400) 400(800 800)
0
The maximum area he can enclose is 80 000 m2, within a field 200 m by 400 m.
The procedure used here can be summarized as follows:
An Algorithm for Solving Optimization Problems
1. Understand the problem and identify quantities that can vary. Determine
a function that represents the quantity to be optimized. Be sure that this
function only depends on one variable.
2. Whenever possible, draw a diagram, labelling the given and required
quantities.
3. Determine the domain of the function to be optimized, using information
given in the problem.
4. Use the algorithm for extreme values to find the absolute maximum
or minimum function value on the domain.
5. Use the results of step 4 to answer the original problem.
EXAMPLE 1
60 cm
x
30 cm
x
Therefore, height x
length 60 2x
width 30 2x.
Since all dimensions are non-negative, 0 x 15.
x
30 2x
60 2x
204 C H A P T E R 5
15 53
x 23.7 or x 6.3
Since x 15, x 15 53 6.3.
To find the largest volume, substitute x 0, 6.3, and 15 in
V(x) 4x3 180x2 1800x.
V(0) 0
V(6.3) 4(6.3)3 180(6.3)2 1800(6.3)
5196
V(15) 0
The maximum volume is obtained by cutting out corner squares of side 6.3 cm.
The length of the box is 60 2
6.3 47.4 cm, the width is
30 2
6.3 17.4 cm, and the height is 6.3 cm.
EXAMPLE 2
Ian and Ada are both training for a marathon. Ians house is located 20 km north
of Adas house. At 9:00 one Saturday morning, Ian leaves his house and jogs
south at 8 km/h. At the same time, Ada leaves her house and jogs east at
6 km/h. When are Ian and Ada closest together, given that they both run
for 2.5 h?
Solution
If Ian starts at point I, he reaches point J after time t hours. Then
IJ 8t km and JA (20 8t) km.
If Ada starts at point A, she reaches point B after t hours and
AB 6t km.
Now the distance they are apart is s JB, and s can be expressed
as a function of t by
I
20
J
s
5 . 5 O P T I M I Z AT I O N P R O B L E M S
205
s(t)
JA2
AB2
(20
8t)2
(6t)2
100t2
320t
400.
The domain for t is 0 t 2.5.
s(t) 12 (100t2 320t 400)
1
2
(200t 320)
100t 160
2
100t
320t
400
100t 160 0
t 1.6
Using the algorithm for extreme values,
s(0) 400
20
s(1.6)
100(1.
6)2 320(1.
6) 400
144
12
s(2.5)
225
15.
Exercise 5.5
Part A
1. A piece of wire 100 cm long is to be bent to form a rectangle. Determine the
rectangle of maximum area.
Communication
Knowledge/
Understanding
Application
206 C H A P T E R 5
Part B
5. The volume of a square-based rectangular cardboard box is to be 1000 cm3.
Find the dimensions so that the quantity of material used to manufacture all 6
faces is a minimum. Assume that there will be no waste material. The
machinery available cannot fabricate material smaller in length than 2 cm.
6. Find the area of the largest rectangle that can be inscribed inside a semicircle
with radius of 10 units. Place the length of the rectangle along the diameter.
Application
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
8. a. Find the area of the largest rectangle that can be inscribed in a right
triangle with legs adjacent to the right angle of lengths 5 cm and 12 cm.
The two sides of the rectangle lie along the legs.
b. Repeat part a with the right triangle that has sides 8 cm by 15 cm.
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
5m
C
A
b. Calculate the maximum volume of water that can be held by this gutter.
10. A piece of window framing material is 6 m long. A carpenter
wants to build a frame for a rural gothic style window where
ABC is equilateral. The window must fit inside a space 1 m
wide and 3 m high.
A
B
5 . 5 O P T I M I Z AT I O N P R O B L E M S
207
11. A train leaves the station at 10:00 and travels due south at a speed of 60 km/h.
Another train has been heading due west at 45 km/h and reaches the same
station at 11:00. At what time were the two trains closest together?
Part C
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
12. In Question 8, you looked at two specific right triangles and observed that the
rectangle of maximum area that could be inscribed inside the triangle always
had dimensions equal to half the lengths of the sides adjacent to the rectangle.
Prove that this is true for any right triangle.
13. Prove that any cylindrical can of volume k cubic units that is to be made using
a minimum amount of material must have the height equal to the diameter.
14. A piece of wire 100 cm long is cut into two pieces. One piece is bent to form
a square, and the other is bent to form a circle. How should the wire be cut so
that the total area enclosed is
a. a maximum?
b. a minimum?
15. Determine the minimal distance from point (3, 3) to the curve given by
y (x 3)2.
16. A chord joins any two points A and B on the parabola whose equation is
y2 4x. If C is the midpoint of AB, and CD is drawn parallel to the x-axis to
meet the parabola at D, prove that the tangent at D is parallel to chord AB.
17. A rectangle lies in the first quadrant with one vertex at the origin and two of
the sides along the coordinate axes. If the fourth vertex lies on the line defined
by x 2y 10 0, then find the maximum area of the rectangle.
18. The base of a rectangle lies along the x-axis, and the upper two vertices are on
the curve defined by y k2 x2. Find the maximum area of the rectangle.
208 C H A P T E R 5
EXAMPLE 1
209
.
h
2
Substituting for h, we have a cost function in terms of r:
C(r) 150r2 160r
2
1000
r
or
160 000
.
C(r) 150r2
r
300r
0
2
160 000
r
1600
3
r 3
300r
2
r 5.54
This value is within the given domain, so we use the algorithm for maximum
and minimum.
160 000
43 380
C(5.38) 150(5.38)2
5.38
160 000
43 344
C(5.54) 150(5.54)2
5.54
160 000
43 631
C(6) 150(62)
6
The minimal cost is $43 344 with a tank of radius 5.54 m and a height of
1000
10.37 m.
(5.54)2
EXAMPLE 2
210 C H A P T E R 5
A commuter train carries 2000 passengers daily from a suburb into a large city.
The cost to ride the train is $7.00 per person. Market research shows that 40 fewer
people would ride the train for each $0.10 increase in the fare, and 40 more
people would ride the train for each $0.10 decrease. If the capacity of the train is
2600 passengers, and contracts with the rail employees require that at least 1600
passengers be carried, what fare should the railway charge to get the largest
possible revenue?
Solution
In order to maximize revenue, we require a revenue function. We know that
revenue (number of passengers)
(fare per passenger).
In forming a revenue function, the most straightforward choice for the independent variable comes from noticing that both the number of passengers and the fare
per passenger change with each $0.10 increase or decrease in the fare. If we let x
represent the number of $0.10 increases in the fare (e.g., x 3 represents a $0.30
increase in the fare, while x 1 represents a $0.10 decrease in the fare), then
we can write expressions for both the number of passengers and the fare per passenger in terms of x, as follows:
the fare per passenger is 7 0.10x
the number of passengers is 2000 40x.
Since the number of passengers must be at least 1600, 2000 40x 1600, and
x 10, and since the number of passengers cannot exceed 2600,
2000 40x 2600, and x 15.
The domain is 15 x 10.
The revenue function is
R(x) (7 0.10x)(2000 40x)
4x2 80x 140 000.
From a practical standpoint, we also require that x be an integer, in order that the
fare only varies by increments of $0.10. We do not wish to consider fares that are
other than multiples of 10 cents.
Therefore the problem is now to find the absolute maximum value of the revenue
function.
R(x) (7 0.10x)(2000 40x)
4x2 80x 14 000
on the interval 15 x 10, where x must be an integer.
R(x) 8x 80
R(x) 0, when 8x 80 0
x 10
R(x) is never undefined. The only critical point for R occurs at x 10, which is
in the domain. To determine the absolute maximum revenue, we evaluate
R(15) 4(15)2 80(15) 14 000
11 900
R(10) 4(10)2 80(10) 14 000
14 400
R(10) 4(10)2 80(10) 14 000
12 800.
5.6 OPTIMIZING IN ECONOMICS AND SCIENCE
211
Therefore, the maximum revenue occurs when there are 10 fare increases of
$0.10 each, or a fare decrease of 10(0.10) $1.00. At a fare of $6.00, the daily
revenue is $14 400 and the number of passengers is 2000 40(10) 2400.
EXAMPLE 3
Stack 1
Stack 2
x
20 x
Solution
Let the distance from the building to the stack with lesser emissions be x km.
Then the distance from the building to the second stack is (20 x) km.
7k
(20 x)
212 C H A P T E R 5
7
x 20 x
3
(1 7)x 20
20
1 7
x
3
6.9.
There is one critical value at x 6.9.
Since there are no fixed domain end points, we use the first derivative test to
determine whether this gives a minimal value.
If 0
x
6.9,
2k
x
14k
(20 x)
1
7
2k 3 3
x
(20 x)
0.
Then S(x) is decreasing.
If 6.9
x
20,
7
(20 x)
0.
Then S(x) is increasing.
Then a relative minimum occurs at x 6.9, and by the test it is an absolute
minimum. The building should be 6.9 km from the smokestack with fewer
emissions.
In summary, when solving real-life optimization problems, there are often many
factors that can affect the required functions and their domains. Such factors may
not be obvious from the statement of the problem. We must do research and ask
many questions to address all of the factors. Solving an entire problem is a series
of many steps, and optimization using calculus techniques is only one step that is
used in determining a solution.
Exercise 5.6
Part A
Knowledge/
Understanding
1. The cost, in dollars, to produce x litres of maple syrup for the Elmira Maple
Syrup Festival is C(x) 75(x 10), x 400.
a. What is the average cost of producing 625 L?
b. The marginal cost is C(x), and similarly, the marginal revenue is R(x).
What is the marginal cost at 1225 L?
c. How much production is needed to achieve a marginal cost of $0.50/L?
5.6 OPTIMIZING IN ECONOMICS AND SCIENCE
213
Application
height at which the operating cost is at a minimum and find the operating cost
per hour.
Application
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
214 C H A P T E R 5
12. Your neighbours operate a successful bake shop. One of their specialties is a
very rich whipped-cream-covered cake. They buy the cakes from a supplier
who charges $6.00 per cake, and they sell 200 cakes weekly at a price of
$10.00 each. Research shows that profit from the cake sales can be increased
by increasing the price. Unfortunately, for every increase of $0.50 cents,
sales will drop by seven.
a. What is the optimal sales price for the cake to obtain a maximal weekly
profit?
b. The supplier, unhappy with reduced sales, informs the owners that if they
purchase fewer than 165 cakes weekly, the cost per cake will increase to
$7.50. Now what is the optimal sales price per cake and what is the total
weekly profit?
c. Situations like this occur regularly in retail trade. Discuss the implications
of reduced sales with increased total profit versus greater sales with smaller profits. For example, a drop in the number of customers means fewer
sales of associated products.
5.6 OPTIMIZING IN ECONOMICS AND SCIENCE
215
Part C
13. If the cost of producing x items is given by the function C(x), and the total
revenue when x items are sold is R(x), then the profit function is
P(x) R(x) C(x). Show that the profit function has a critical point when
the marginal revenue equals the marginal cost.
14. A fuel tank is being designed to contain 200 m 3 of gasoline; however, the
maximum length tank that can be safely transported to clients is 16 m long.
The design of the tank calls for a cylindrical part in the middle with
hemispheres at each end. If the hemispheres are twice as expensive per unit
area as the cylindrical wall, then find the radius and height of the cylindrical
part so that the cost of manufacturing the tank will be minimal. Give the
answer correct to the nearest centimetre.
15. The illumination of an object by a light source is directly proportional to the
strength of the source and inversely proportional to the square of the distance
from the source. If two light sources, one three times as strong as the other,
are placed 10 m apart, where should an object be placed on the line between
the two lights so as to receive the least illumination?
16. During a cough, the diameter of the trachea decreases. The velocity, v, of air
in the trachea during a cough may be modelled by the formula
v(r) Ar2 (r0 r), where A is a constant, r is the radius of the trachea
during the cough, and r0 is the radius of the trachea in a relaxed state. Find
the radius of the trachea when the velocity is the greatest, and find the
associated maximum velocity of air. Note that the domain for the problem is
0 r r0.
216 C H A P T E R 5
217
wrap-up
CHAPTER 5: MAXIMIZING PROFITS
Highway
3 km
Mine
218 C H A P T E R 5
Review Exercise
dy
1. Find d
for each of the following:
x
b. x12 y12 5
a. x3 y5 6
d. x2y3 3 y
x1
c. y3
x1
2
e. y7 2x7y5 10
3
f. x 5 y 5 x
dy
2. Find d
at the indicated point.
x
a. x3 y3 18xy at (8, 4)
3. Find the slopes of the lines tangent to the graph of x2y6 2y2 6 0
at the point (0.5, 1) and at the point (0.5, 1).
4. Find f and f , if f (x) x 4 x14 .
d 2y
.
5. For y x9 7x3 2, find
dx2
21
y
REVIEW EXERCISE
219
11. A motorist starts braking when she sees a stop sign. After t seconds,
the distance (in metres) from the front of her car to the sign is
s(t) 62 16t t2.
a. How far was the front of the car from the sign when she started braking?
b. Does the car go beyond the stop sign before stopping?
c. Explain why it is unlikely that the car would hit another vehicle that is
travelling perpendicular to the motorists road when her car first comes
to a stop at the intersection.
12. Find the equation of the tangent to the graph y3 3xy 5 0
at the point (2, 1).
13. The position function of an object that moves in a straight line is
8
, 0 t 2. Find the maximum and minimum
s(t) 1 2t
t2 1
C(x) 3x 1000
ii)
iii)
iv)
C(x) 100x
1
2
5x 700
16. Find the production level that minimizes the average cost per unit for the cost
function C(x) 0.004x2 40x 16 000. Show that it is a minimum by
using a graphing calculator to sketch the graph of the average cost function.
17. a. The position of an object moving along a straight line is described by the
function s(t) 3t2 10 for t 0. Is the object moving away from or
towards its starting position when t 3?
b. Repeat the problem using s(t) t3 4t2 10 for t 0.
220 C H A P T E R 5
18. Sand is being poured onto a conical pile at the rate of 9 m3/h. Friction forces
in the sand are such that the slope of the sides of the conical pile is always 23.
a. How fast is the altitude increasing when the radius of the base of the pile
is 6 m?
b. How fast is the radius of the base increasing when the height of the pile
is 10 m?
19. Digging in his backyard, Dennis accidentally breaks a pipe attached to his
water-sprinkling system. Water bubbles up at a rate of 1 cm3/s, forming a
circular pond of depth 0.5 cm in his yard. How quickly is the surface area of
the pond covering his lawn?
20. The surface area of a cube is changing at a rate of 8 cm2/s. How fast is the
volume changing when the surface area is 60 cm2?
21. A coffee filter has the shape of an inverted cone. Water drains out of the filter
at a rate of 10 cm3/min. When the depth of water in the cone is 8 cm, the
depth is decreasing at 2 cm/min. What is the ratio of the height of the cone to
its radius?
22. A floodlight that is 15 m away and at ground level illuminates a building.
A man 2 m tall walks away from the light directly towards the building
at 2 m/s. Is the length of his shadow on the building increasing or decreasing?
Find the rate of change of the length of his shadow when he is 4 m from
the light.
23. A particle moving along a straight line will be s cm from a fixed
point at time t seconds, where t 0 and s 27t 3 1t6 10.
a. Find when the velocity will be zero.
b. Is this a maximum or a minimum velocity?
c. Is the particle accelerating? Explain.
24. A box with a square base and no top must have a volume of 10 000 cm3. If
the smallest dimension in any direction is 5 cm, then determine the
dimensions of the box that minimize the amount of material used.
25. An animal breeder wishes to create five adjacent rectangular pens, each with
an area of 2400 m2. To ensure that the pens are large enough for grazing, the
minimum for either dimension must be 10 m. Find the dimensions for the
pens in order to keep the amount of fencing used to a minimum.
REVIEW EXERCISE
221
26. You are given a piece of sheet metal that is twice as long as it is wide and
the area of the sheet is 800 square decametres. Find the dimensions of the
rectangular box that would contain a maximum volume if it were constructed
from this piece of metal. The box will not have a lid. Give your answer
correct to one decimal place.
27. A cylindrical can is to hold 500 cm3 of apple juice. The design must take into
account that the height must be between 6 and 15 cm, inclusive. How should
the can be constructed so that a minimum amount of material will be used in
the construction? (Assume that there will be no waste.)
28. In oil pipeline construction, the cost of pipe to go under water is 60% more
than the cost of pipe used in dry land situations. A pipeline comes to a 1-kmwide river at point A, and it must be extended to a refinery, R, on the other
side that is 8 km down a straight river. Find the best way to cross the river so
that the total cost of the pipe is kept to a minimum. (Answer to the nearest
metre.)
29. A train leaves the station at 10:00 and travels due north at a speed of
100 km/h. Another train has been heading due west at 120 km/h and reaches
the same station at 11:00. At what time were the two trains closest together?
30. A store sells portable CD players for $100 each, and at this price the store
sells 120 CD players every month. The owner of the store wishes to increase
his profit, and he estimates that for every $2 increase in the price of CD
players, one less CD player will be sold each month. If each CD player costs
the store $70, at what price should the store sell the CD players to maximize
profit?
31. An offshore oil well, P, is located in the ocean 5 km from the nearest point on
the shore, A. A pipeline is to be built to take oil from P to a refinery that is 20
km along the straight shoreline from A. If it costs $100 000 per kilometre to
lay pipe underwater and only $75 000 per kilometre to lay pipe on land, what
route from the well to the refinery will be the cheapest? (Give your answer
correct to the nearest metre.)
222 C H A P T E R 5
Chapter 5 Test
Achievement Category
Questions
Knowledge/Understanding
All questions
Thinking/Inquiry/Problem Solving
9, 11
Communication
5b
Application
4, 5, 6, 10
dy
1. Find d
if x2 4xy y2 8.
x
2. Find the equation of the tangent to 3x 2 4y 2 7 at P(1, 1).
3. An object starts at rest and moves along a horizontal trail. Its position, s,
in metres, after t seconds is given by s(t) t3 9t2 24t 5, t 0.
a. Find the average velocity from t 1 s to t 6 s.
b. At what time(s) is the object at rest?
c. Determine its acceleration after 5 s.
d. Is the object moving towards or away from the origin when t 3 s?
Justify your answer.
These formulas may be helpful for the following questions.
Sphere
V 43r3, S 4r2
Cone
V 13r2h
4. Assume that oil spilled from a ruptured tanker spreads in a circular pattern
whose radius increases at a constant rate of 2 m/s. How fast is the area of the
spill increasing when the radius of the spill is 60 m?
5. The radius of a sphere is increasing at a rate of 2 m/min.
a. Find the rate of change of the volume when the radius is 8 m.
b. Explain why the rate of change of the volume of the sphere is not constant
even though ddrt is constant.
CHAPTER 5 TEST
223
9. A figure skater is directly beneath a spotlight 10 m above the ice. If she skates
away from the light at a rate of 6 m/s and the spot follows her, how fast is her
shadows head moving when she is 8 m from her starting point? The skater is
(almost) 1.6 m tall with her skates on.
10. A man has purchased 2000 m of used wire fencing at an auction. He and his
wife want to use the fencing to create three adjacent rectangular paddocks.
Find the dimensions of the paddocks so the fence encloses the largest possible
area.
11. An engineer working on a new generation of computer called The Beaver is
using very compact VLSI circuits. The container design for the CPU is to be
determined by marketing considerations and must be a rectangular solid in
shape. It must contain exactly 10 000 cm3 of interior space, and the length
must be twice the height. If the cost of the base is $0.02/cm2, the cost of the
side walls is $0.05/cm2, and the cost of the upper face is $0.10/cm2, find the
dimensions to the nearest millimetre that will keep the cost of the container to
a minimum.
224 C H A P T E R 5
Chapter 6
THE EXPONENTIAL
FUNCTION
Are you thinking of buying a computer? Moores
Law suggests that the processing power of
computers doubles every eighteen months, which
means that in a year and a half from today,
computers will be twice as powerful as they are
now! This is an example of exponential growth. In
this chapter, you will study the exponential
functions that can be used to describe and make
predictions about the growth of biological
populations, including human populations and
populations of cancerous cells, the growth of
financial investments, the growth of the Internet,
and the decaying of radioactive substances.
Another application of exponential functions
occurs in psychology, where it has been noted
that, in certain circumstances, there is an
exponential relationship between the size of a
stimulus and a nerves response to the stimulus.
The common feature in all these situations and
many others is that the amount of growth or
decline at any point in time is directly
proportional to the size of the thing that is
growing or declining.
CHAPTER EXPECTATIONS In this chapter, you will
ap
a q (a) p or
In this chapter you will also be working with transformations.
Exercise
1. Find the value of each of the following:
a. 43
c. 33
b. (3)2
d.
b. 5m2
1
b. 23
c.
2
e. 23
1
d.
w5
c. (3b)3
3
34
34
21 22
d.
31
a. 4 2
1
b. 27 3
c. 18 3
1
227
investigate
C H A P T E R 6 : D I S C O V E R I N G E X P O N E N T I A L G R O W T H PAT T E R N S
If you have suffered from the bacterial infection streptococcal pharyngitis, better
known as strep throat, you have had first-hand experience with exponential growth.
Not all applications of exponential growth are so negative, however. Bacteria are used
in a multitude of biotechnology applications, including the destruction of hazardous
wastes such as PCBs, toxins that otherwise would be very difficult to remove from
our natural environment. Other applications with exponential patterns include the
mathematics of investment (growth) and the carbon dating of archeological relics
(decay). In this chapter, you will investigate patterns in exponential graphs, solve
problems following exponential growth and decay patterns, and build and
manipulate mathematical models following exponential patterns.
Case Study Agricultural Entomologist
Faced with changing weather patterns bringing more severe weather events,
Canadas agricultural sector is attempting to create disease- and insect-resistant
crops that are adaptable to both dry and wet climates. As part of this process, the
population dynamics of insects are thoroughly investigated. An entomologist, an
insect researcher, is examining the birth and death patterns of an insect that
destroys soy crops. The researcher notices that if no deaths were to occur, the
population would grow by 50% each day. She has also observed that 10% of the
population, including the new births, dies every day. The starting population is 1000.
DISCUSSION QUESTIONS
Population
Start of Day
Births
Deaths
Population
End of Day
1000
1000
5
228 C H A P T E R 6
xn x1n , x 0
am
amn, a 0
an
1
n
xn,
x
a n
b
(am)n amn
(ab)m ambm
a m
b
am
m
,
b
p
ba , a, b 0
a q (a)p or
ap
b0
Alternatively, a q a q or (ap) q
p
x0 1
EXAMPLE 1
x0
1
1
Solution
2
4
21 41
b.
2
3
1
52
33
2
a.
5
33
32
2275
3
1
3
1
42 83
c.
1
1
16 4 25 2
21 41
b.
32
52
a.
33
42 83
82
c.
1
1
4
2
16 25
25
3
4
1
9
160
34 91
35
247
EXAMPLE 2
a2
Solution
3
a4 a3
b.
1
a.
b4 (b2)3
4
b4 (b2)3 b 3 b6
a.
22
3
b
31
a4 a3
4 3
b.
a
1
a2
1
2
946
a 12
7
a 12
229
EXAMPLE 3
(x2y xy2)3
4
3
a. x 3 x
b.
(xy)4
Solution
2
4
3
a. x 3 x
[xy(x y)]3
(x y xy )
b.
4
(xy)4
2
2 4
x3 ( 3)
2 3
(xy)
(xy)3(x y)3
x2
(xy)4
(x y)3
xy
Exercise 6.1
Part A
1. Evaluate each of the following, using the laws of exponents.
a. (73)2 74
3
2
Knowledge/
Understanding
e. (8)
f. (2)3 (2)3
g. 42 81
h. (a4 a7) a3
i. (0.3)3 (0.3)5
j. (p2)3 (p3)2
k. (32)3 32
l. (31)3 32
m. (2)3 24
n. (23)2 (22)2
o. (63)4 126
a.
x3y4
23g2h4
5x3y4
g.
2x2y2
j. (a2bc1)3
b. (xy2)(x3y2)
(3a2b)2
c.
(ab2)3
e. (xy2)3
(b2)3c4
f.
(bc)5
x2y
h.
4xy3
k. (a2b1)3
d.
230 C H A P T E R 6
c. (3)5 (3)3
2
3
d. 25
d.
(gh2)3
Knowledge/
Understanding
b. (0.4)5 (0.4)3
(4x2y 3 ) 2
(8xy )
1 1
4 3
i. (5x2y)2
2 2
a
l. (ab)4
b2
3 2
b. (a 4 b 3 )2
x
c.
x1
(4a2)(2a3b2)
e.
12a4b3
(5x2y0)3
f.
1
1
1
(25x2y) 2
Part B
4. Simplify, using the laws of exponents.
1
1
Application
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
3
c. (27) 3
d. 2a 2 32
a 4
e.
27p6
g. a3.4 a2.6
h.
52
55
5
f.
32a10
i. (t)2
t5
(p2q pq3)3
31 32
a.
33
ab2c a2bc
b.
abc
c.
p3q4
x2 x3
d.
2x
3t 2t1
e.
t3
f. p
4
3p2 p3
x 2 x 2 x1
a.
1
Communication
4
b.
163
a. (64x4) 2
4 x
b.
3
x2
x1
d.
x9
c.
1
x x
x2 3
1
1
231
t chnology
b. Use the TRACE function to find the value of the y-intercept. Label the
y-intercept on your sketch.
INVESTIGATION
c. Using the TRACE function, move the cursor left. Watch the y-values as the
cursor moves. What do you notice about these values? The graph approaches the x-axis for small values of x. The line the graph of a function
approaches is called an asymptote. Label the horizontal asymptote on your
sketch and write its equation.
d. What is the domain and range of y 2x?
e. Does the graph cross the x-axis?
Your finished sketch should look like this:
30
y = 2x
25
20
Domain is x R.
Range is y 0, y R.
15
y-intercept is 1
10
5
x
5
5. Investigate the function y 13 . Draw a sketch of y 13 , showing the scale,
and labelling the y-intercept and the horizontal asymptote. State the domain
and range of the function. Note that we can express this as y 3x rather than
x
y 13 .
x
b. Predict where the graph of the curve y 17 will be relative to the
curves graphed in part a of this question. Check your prediction with your
graphing calculator or graphing software.
7. Write a general description of the graph of the exponential curve y bx, where
0 b 1. In this description include the y-intercept, horizontal asymptote,
domain, range, and a sketch.
x
6 . 2 I N V E S T I G AT I N G f ( x ) b x
233
y bx, b 1
The function is always increasing.
y bx, 0 b 1
The function is always decreasing.
Exercise 6.2
Part A
Knowledge/
Understanding
1. The graphs below have equations of the form y bx. Answer the following
questions about each of the functions:
a.
234 C H A P T E R 6
b.
c.
d.
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
Communication
4. Describe how you determine the equation of a function of the form y bx,
b 0, if you are given its graph. You can use only your knowledge of
exponential functions and not your calculator. Include sketches to help you
describe the procedure you use.
6 . 2 I N V E S T I G AT I N G f ( x ) b x
235
INVESTIGATION
e
t chnology
Exercise 6.3
Part A
Knowledge/
Understanding
d. y 12 2
236 C H A P T E R 6
b. y 2x 4
c. y 413
e. y 2(5x) 1
f. y 523 1
Knowledge/
Understanding
Application
Knowledge/
Understanding
Application
Communication and
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
6 . 3 I N V E S T I G AT I N G f ( x ) a b x + c
237
An antique vase was purchased in 2000 for $8000. If the vase appreciates in value
by 6% per year, what is its estimated value in the year 2040, to the nearest
thousand dollars?
Solution
The value of the vase is given by f(x) 8000(1.06)x, where x is the time in years.
f(40) 8000(1.06)40
82 285.7435
In 2040 the vase will be worth approximately $82 000.
EXAMPLE 2
A very convenient measure of population growth is a doubling period. The population of the world was 6 billion in 1999. This population is growing exponentially and doubles every 35 years.
a. Estimate the world population in 2050, to the nearest half billion.
b. When will the population be 24 billion?
Solution
a. If the population doubles, the base for the function must be 2. However, the
time for doubling is 35 years, so the exponent must be of the form 3t
, where t
5
is the number of years. Then the function representing population after t years
t
is f(t) 62 35 . For the population in 2050, t 51.
238 C H A P T E R 6
2 35 4 22.
Then 3t5 2
t 70.
The population will be 24 billion in 2069.
EXAMPLE 3
We do not always know the rate of increase. In this case, we construct an exponential function with an unknown base and determine the base from the given
information. The population of a town was 24 000 in 1980 and 29 000 in 1990.
a. Determine an expression for the population at the time t years after 1980.
b. Use this expression to estimate the population of the town in 2020.
Solution
a. Let the population in t years be P(t) P0bt, where P0 is the population at time
t 0, with t 0 in 1980. Then P(0) P0b0 P0 24, in thousands.
Now P(t) 24bt.
We are given that P(10) 29.
Then 24b10 29
b10 2294.
Taking roots on both sides,
9 10
b 22
4
1
1.019.
Now P(t) 24(1.019)t.
b. In the year 2020, t 2020 1980 40.
P(40) 24(1.019)40
51.16
The population in 2020 will be approximately 51 000.
EXAMPLE 4
239
Exercise 6.4
Part A
1. The population of a city is 810 000. If it is increasing by 4% per year, estimate the population in four years.
2. A painting, purchased for $10 000 in 1990, increased in value by 8% per year.
Find the value of the painting in the year 2000.
3. A river is stocked with 5000 salmon. The population of salmon increases by
7% per year.
a. Write an expression for the population t years after the salmon were put
into the river.
240 C H A P T E R 6
4. A house was bought six years ago for $175 000. If real-estate values have
been increasing at the rate of 4% per year, what is the value of the house
now?
5. A used-car dealer sells a five-year-old car for $4200. What was the original
value of the car if the depreciation is 15% a year?
Knowledge/
Understanding
6. In the early 1990s, the Canadian dollar was declining in value due to inflation
at the rate of 8.3% per year. If the situation continued, what would the dollar
be worth five years later?
Part B
Application
6 . 4 E X P O N E N T I A L G R O W T H A N D D E C AY
241
Application
11. A research assistant made 160 mg of radioactive sodium (Na24) and found
that there was only 20 mg left 45 h later.
a. What is the half-life of Na24?
b. Find a function that models the amount A left after t hours.
c. If the laboratory requires 100 mg of Na24 12 h from now, how much Na24
should the research assistant make now? (Ignore the 20 mg she currently
has.)
d. How much of the original 20 mg would be left in 12 h?
12. A bacteria colony grows at the rate of 15%/h.
a. In how many hours will the colony double in size?
b. In 10 h the bacteria population grows to 1.3 103. How many bacteria
were there initially?
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
13. People who work frequently in a radiation environment, such as X-ray technicians, dentists, radiologists, or nuclear reactor operations staff, are limited to a
50 mSv (milli-sievert) whole-body radiation dose in any one given year. They
wear badges that measure the radiation to which they have been exposed. We
all receive radiation from many sources, both naturally occuring and artificial,
all the time. The North American average from all sources is approximately
2 mSv/year. We can find these levels increasing if we mountain climb or
smoke.
a. Calculate your own radiation exposure in a year, using the information
below.
Radiation Source
Cosmic and terrestrial
Communication
Communication
242 C H A P T E R 6
Amount of Radiation
(in milli-sieverts per year)
0.8
Atmospheric fallout
0.05
Internal body
0.3
TV watching
Housing
Flying
60
Application
14. The population of a city was estimated to be 125 000 in 1930 and 500 000 in
1998.
a. Estimate the population of the city in 2020.
b. If the population continues to grow at the same rate, when will the
population reach 1 million?
Part C
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
15. On the day his son is born, an excited father wants to give his new son a seasons ticket to watch the fathers favourite sports team. A seasons ticket costs
$900. The father realizes there is no point in buying tickets for a baby only a
few hours old, so he decides to put the money aside until the boy is six years
old. If inflation is assumed to be 3% per year, how much money should the
father put aside so that he can purchase the seasons ticket in six years?
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
16. Two different strains of cold virus were isolated and put in cultures to grow.
Virus A triples every 8 h while virus B doubles every 4.8 h. If each culture
has 1000 viruses to start, which has more after 24 h?
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
17. With exponential growth, a population will continue to double in equal intervals of time. However, in a finite world, one population influences the growth
of another. A garden pond may have water lilies covering part of the surface.
Growing conditions are ideal and the number of water lilies doubles, and doubles again. Then the gardener, realizing that the water lilies will soon cover the
whole pond, introduces a chemical to kill off many of the plants. The exponential growth pattern is disrupted. But this disruption in the exponential growth
pattern would occur without the intervention of the gardener. As the water
lilies covered more and more of the pond surface, the plants would compete
for food and light. The over-crowding of the plants would reduce the rate of
expansion. This levelling off occurs in every example of natural growth.
Population
Below is a graph of the Canadian population between the years 1860 and 2000.
2000
1950
1900
1860
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
0
Year
Communication
a. Why do you think the population of Canada is not growing as fast now as
it was earlier in the twentieth century?
Communication
6 . 4 E X P O N E N T I A L G R O W T H A N D D E C AY
243
t chnology
Initially (at time zero) we have 500 mg of strontium90. Here are the results of
measuring the amount of strontium90 remaining after 6 time intervals have passed.
Number of
Time Intervals
Amount of
Strontium90
(in milligrams)
500
241
112
61
30
18
13
Number of Milligrams of
Strontium90
INVESTIGATION
244 C H A P T E R 6
Technical Help
To enter the data, press
L1 and L2.
STAT
t chnology
To draw the scatter plot, turn off all functions in Y= . Press Y= to obtain
the STAT PLOT function. Select 1:Plot 1 and press ENTER . Turn plot 1
on, select scatter plot, and L1 and L2 for Xlist and Ylist. Press WINDOW to
adjust the viewing window. Press GRAPH to see the scatter plot.
b. We now want to model this data with a function. If you pictured a curve
passing through our points, it would be shaped somewhat like the exponential
curve. We will find the curve of best fit determined by your calculator. Use
the exponential regression calculation. To three decimal places, the equation
is y 431.856(0.536)x.
t chnology
Technical Help
To use the exponential regression calculation, press STAT , then under
CALC, select 0:ExpReg. Press ENTER twice. The coefficient and the base of
the exponential regression equation are displayed.
c. Using the equation y 431.856(0.536)x, which we found as a model of the
data, estimate the amount of strontium90 remaining after 15 time intervals.
d. Using the equation y 431.856(0.536)x, estimate when there will be 0.5 mg of
strontium90 remaining.
Use the graphing calculator to draw the graph of
y 0.536x. We can use the TRACE feature of
the calculator to approximate the solution to
0.536x 0.0012.
The solution to 0.536x 0.0012 is
approximately x 10.766. There will be
0.5 mg of strontium90 remaining after approximately 10.8 time intervals. The accuracy of your
answer can be improved by using the ZOOM
feature of the calculator.
Alternately, you can guess-and-check using the power key on the calculator to
find the solution to 0.536x 0.0012.
0.53610 0.0020
0.53611 0.0010
The value of x must be between 10 and 11. Continue to experiment with values to
improve the accuracy of your approximation.
6 . 5 M O D E L L I N G D ATA U S I N G T H E E X P O N E N T I A L F U N C T I O N
245
Strontium90 has a half-life of 26.8 years. In one half-life, half of this radioactive
material will have decayed to some other substance. If we started with 10 g of
strontium90, after 26.8 years there should be 5 g left. In our calculations, each
time interval represented 26.8 years.
x
As the term half-life indicates, our expression should be of the form y a 12 .
Since we started with 500 g of strontium90, the expression should be
x
y 500 12 .
But things are never quite that precise when data is collected experimentally.
Using experimental data allows you to get close to the theoretical equation. The
more data points you have, and the more accurate the points are, the better the
actual situation will fit the mathematical model.
It is unusual to obtain a good function approximation using y bx. Most data sets
require an exponent of a more complicated form than x, such as 3x2 2x. Such
situations are beyond the scope of this text.
Exercise 6.5
Part B
Knowledge/
Understanding
t chnology
Bacteria
Population
1000
1135
1307
1490
1696
1957
2228
a. Use your graphing calculator to draw a scatter plot of the data. Sketch the
scatter plot in your notebook. Include the labels and scales on the axes.
b. Using the exponential regression calculation in your calculator, determine
the equation of the curve of best fit. Record this equation accurate to three
decimal places.
c. Using the equation of the curve of best fit, estimate the bacteria population
in 10 h.
246 C H A P T E R 6
d. Predict when there would be 10 000 bacteria. Hint: How many time intervals will this take?
2. Below is a table showing the population of the world. This information came
from the United Nations Web site, www.un.org/popin. We will count in intervals of 50 years from 1750.
Knowledge/
Understanding
Year
Time Interval
Population
(in billions)
1750
0.79
1800
0.98
1850
1.26
1900
1.65
1950
2.52
2000
6.06
a. With your graphing calculator, draw a scatter plot of the data. Using the
exponential regression calculation in your calculator, determine the equation of the curve of best fit accurate to three decimal places.
b. Using your mathematical model, estimate the world population in 2050.
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
Time
Interval
Carbon-Dioxide
Concentration
(in parts per million)
1860
294
1880
296
1900
300
1920
307
1940
308
1960
319
1980
340
2000
377
a. With your graphing calculator, draw a scatter plot of the data. Using the
exponential regression calculation in your calculator, determine the equation of the curve of best fit accurate to three decimal places.
b. Using your mathematical model, estimate the carbon-dioxide concentration
in 1930 and in 1990.
c. If the trend continues, predict when the concentration will be 390 parts per
million.
6 . 5 M O D E L L I N G D ATA U S I N G T H E E X P O N E N T I A L F U N C T I O N
247
4. The table below shows the amount of stored nuclear waste in million curies.
We will count in intervals of five years from 1970.
Year
Time
Intervals
Stored Nuclear
Waste
(in million curies)
1970
1975
30
1980
100
1985
210
1990
360
1995
660
a. With your graphing calculator, draw a scatter plot of the data. Using the
exponential regression calculation in your calculator, determine the equation of the curve of best fit accurate to three decimal places.
b. Using your mathematical model, estimate the amount of nuclear waste
stored in 1983.
c. If this trend continues, predict when the amount of nuclear waste stored
will be 800 million curies.
5. Statistics Canada is a government agency that collects and analyzes data about
many aspects of life in Canada. On their Web site, www.statcan.ca, you can
find the population of the provinces for the last few years. Select one of the
provinces. Copy and complete the chart below using the data from the
Statistics Canada Web site. Count the time intervals of years from the first
entry in your chart.
Year
Time
Intervals
Population
a. With your graphing calculator, draw a scatter plot of the data. Using the
exponential regression calculation in your calculator, determine the equation of the curve of best fit accurate to three decimal places.
248 C H A P T E R 6
6. Given a set of data, describe how you can predict the algebraic form of a
mathematical model to fit the data. Use sketches to illustrate your answer.
Part C
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
7. You have likely observed that the models obtained by using your calculator
provide a rather poor fit for the data. This is because your calculator uses only
one exponential function, namely f (x) Abx. By changing the exponent to
px2 qx, a much better fit of the data can be obtained. You may be interested
in using more sophisticated exponents with the data given in the problems of
this section to see whether you can determine functions that better describe
the situation. This will require a computer with algebraic capability.
6 . 5 M O D E L L I N G D ATA U S I N G T H E E X P O N E N T I A L F U N C T I O N
249
Exponent Laws
xn x1n , x 0
am an amn
m
aan amn, a 0
1
xn, x 0
xn
(am)n amn
n
n
ab ba , a, b 0
(ab)m ambm
a q (a)p or
ap
p
ab abm, b 0
x0 1
m
Alternatively,
p
a q a q or (ap) q
p
1
1
y bx, b 1
The function is always increasing.
250 C H A P T E R 6
y bx, 0 b 1
The function is always decreasing.
wrap-up
C H A P T E R 6 : D I S C O V E R I N G E X P O N E N T I A L G R O W T H PAT T E R N S
An entomologist is studying the predatorprey relationship for two colonies of
insects. She is investigating the possibility of introducing the predator insect in
corn farming areas to control the population of the prey insect, which is a
nuisance to corn crops.
a. In the experiment, the predator insect doubled in population every three days
and the prey insect quadrupled in nine days. The initial population of the
predator insect was 500 and the initial population of the prey insect was
1000. At what time were the two populations equal?
b. Once the populations are equal, the prey population depends on births
(which would still cause a doubling every three days if there were no
predator) and deaths caused by the predator, which amount to 5.0% of the
population per day. The researcher needs to develop a single algebraic model
to predict the population of the prey insect as a function of births and
deaths:
P Po (Exponential Growth Due to Births)(Exponential Decay Due to Deaths)
Expressed in doubling times format:
P(t) Po2kt,
where P(t) is the population at time t, in days, Po is the initial population,
and k is growth rate constant.
Hints: 1. Set t 0 for the time when the populations were equal as
determined in part a.
2. Convert growth expression to base of 2 with exponent laws.
3. Convert death expression to base of 2 using the graph of y 2x
and finding the value of x for 2x (1 Decay Rate).
c. The experiment will be considered a success if the population of the prey
insect is less than 6800 five days after the time the two populations were
equal, and if the doubling time of the prey is now more than seven days. Use
the expression developed in part b and the graphing calculator to judge the
experiments success.
251
Review Exercise
1. Evaluate each of the following:
3
3
b.
31 32
d. (53 52)(23 22)
a. (32 23)1
8
3
c.
36 35
54 3
b.
250
3
5
2
c.
1
4
16
b.
ap2q2
ap2q2
(xab) ab
c.
xa
2
d.
3
23
41
1
x 3 x
3
x2
5
a. 1 8x1 15x2
b. x 2 x 2
d. x 2 25x
3
1
2
5. Following are the graphs of some exponential functions with equations of the
form y bx, b 0. Using what you have learned about exponential functions,
and without the aid of your calculator, write the equation of each function.
Each line on the graph represents one unit.
a.
b.
t chnology
Year
Time
Intervals
Population
(in millions)
1994
29 036.0
1995
29 353.9
1996
29 671.9
1997
30 011.0
1998
30 301.2
a. Using your graphing calculator, draw a scatter plot of this data. Use the
exponential regression function on your calculator to find the curve of best
fit for the data.
b. Using your mathematical model, estimate the population of Canada in
2010.
c. Predict when there will be 35 million people in Canada.
11. The following information is from the United Nations Web site,
www.un.org/popin.
a. The following chart gives the population of Europe.
REVIEW EXERCISE
253
Year
Population
(in millions)
1750
163
1800
203
1850
276
1900
408
1950
547
1998
729
i) Find the average rate of change in population between 1750 and 1800.
ii) Find the average rate of change in population between 1950 and 1998.
iii) Compare the answers to parts i and ii.
b. The chart below gives the population of North America.
Year
1750
Population
(in millions)
2
1800
1850
26
1900
82
1950
172
1998
305
i) Find the average rate of change in population between 1800 and 1850.
ii) Find the average rate of change in population between 1950 and 1998.
iii) Compare the answers to parts i and ii.
c. Between 1800 and 1850, the average rate of change in population in
Europe was greater than the average rate of change in population in North
America. However the change in the size of the population in North
America was far more dramatic. Explain.
254 C H A P T E R 6
Chapter 6 Test
Achievement Category
Questions
Knowledge/Understanding
All questions
Thinking/Inquiry/Problem Solving
10
Communication
4, 9c, 10b
Application
3, 4, 5b, 6, 7, 8, 9b
a. 4 2
1
1
1
b. (5 3 5 6 )12
21 22
e.
23
d. (2)3 (2)5
c. 41 23 50
f. (5)3 (5)2
b. (3x2y)2
c. (x4y2)2 (x2y3)1
d. (xab)(xab)
xp q
e.
xpq
f.
x 16
3. Write
as a polynomial expression.
1
x2 4
3
x x
x1
255
t chnology
9. Below is a table showing the population of the world. This information came
from the United Nations Web site, www.un.org/popin. The data is in intervals
of 50 years from 1750, with 50 years considered as one time interval.
Year
Time
Intervals
Population
(in billions)
1750
0.79
1800
0.98
1850
1.26
1900
1.65
1950
2.52
2000
6.06
a. Use your graphing calculator to draw a scatter plot of the data. Using the
exponential regression calculation in your calculator, determine the equation of the curve of best fit accurate to three decimal places.
b. Using your mathematical model, estimate the world population in 2300.
c. If the habitable surface area of the earth is about 20 million hectares, what
will be the population density in the year 2300? (1 ha 10 000 m2)
d. Do you think the exponential model determined by the graphing calculator
is valid over an extended period? Explain your answer.
10. This graph has an equation of the form f (x) bx c.
a. Determine values for b and c.
b. Explain how you arrived at this answer.
256 C H A P T E R 6
Chapter 7
THE LOGARITHMIC
FUNCTION AND
LOGARITHMS
Did you know that the energy in the sound of a
jet aircraft engine is about one trillion times
greater than the energy you exert when you
whisper to your friend seated next to you on the
plane that youre secretly afraid of flying? Rather
than dealing with such a wide range of values,
people who work with sound whether they be
broadcasters, people in the recording industry, or
engineers trying to reduce engine noise inside an
airplane all measure sound levels using the
more manageable decibel scale, which is an
example of a
logarithmic scale.
Other examples of
logarithmic scales include the
Richter scale for measuring the
intensity of earthquakes and
the pH scale for measuring the acid
content in a substance. These scales are used to
simplify certain phenomena that might vary by
large magnitudes, and the scales are all based on
logarithmic functions like those that are
studied in this chapter.
CHAPTER EXPECTATIONS In this chapter, you will
Exercise
e
t chnology
APPENDIX P. 427
c. How is the slope of the graph of y 13 related to the slope of the graph
1
of y x 3 ?
d. Explain how the answers to parts b and c are related.
2. If f is a function defined by f(x) bx, where b 1, what can be stated about
a. the sign of f(x)?
b. the growth behaviour of f ?
c. f(0)?
258 C H A P T E R 7
259
investigate
CHAPTER 7: MEASURING ON A LOGARITHMIC SCALE
We often hear the term order of magnitude when people are describing the
severity of an earthquake, the acidity of a solution, or the loudness of a sound. Order
of magnitude is actually a very simple concept. One order of magnitude means 10
times larger, two orders of magnitude mean 100 times larger, and so on.
Mathematically, the pattern is 100, 101, 102, 103, 10n with the order of magnitude
as the exponent. This exponent is also known as the logarithm of the pattern. On a
number line, the intensity of an earthquake could be represented as follows:
Logarithm Notation
Exponential Notation
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
Standard Notation
10
100
1000
10 000
100 000
1 000 000
1
0
2
1
3
2
4
3
5
4
6
5
7
6
8
7
10
9
8
10
10
...
The logarithmic notation on this number line for measuring earthquake intensity is
known as the Richter Scale and indicates that an earthquake of magnitude 5 is 100
times more intense than an earthquake of magnitude 3. Other examples of log
scales include the pH scale in chemistry and the bel or decibel scale for the
measurement of loudness. In this chapter, you will investigate the properties of the
logarithm function and its graph, utilize the rules of logarithms to solve exponential
equations, and model exponential and polynomial data using logarithms.
Case Study Seismologist (Earthquake Geologist)
Seismologists play a critical role in assisting structural engineers to design
earthquake-proof buildings. Designing buildings to withstand earthquakes first
requires the seismologist to model the behaviour of earthquake shockwaves (e.g.,
magnitude and frequency). Only then can the engineer determine how the
beams and columns must be designed to withstand the tensional, compressive,
shearing (tearing), and torsion (twisting) forces the earthquake will cause. While
most people would identify Vancouver, B.C., as the city most prone to
earthquakes in Canada, there are others that might surprise you, such as Ottawa,
Ontario, which experiences earthquakes on a regular basis.
DISCUSSION QUESTIONS
260 C H A P T E R 7
y
x
y=b,b>1
1
1
1
y
x
y=b,b>1
1
1
1
x=y
1
x = by
y
y = bx, 0 < x < 1
1
1
x
1
x=b
Since the exponential function y b x is only defined for b 0, it follows that the
inverse function, x by, is only defined for b 0. We can also see from the
graph that the domain of x by is x 0. We will call this inverse function the
logarithmic function and write it as y log b x. This is read as y equals log of x
to the base b. The function logbx is defined only for x 0.
INVESTIGATION
Step 2:
Step 3:
Using the image line y x, sketch the graph of the inverse function
f(x) log b x.
261
Step 4:
Step 5:
As with the exponential function, there are two possible versions of the graph of
the logarithmic function:
y
y
1
1
1
x
1
y = logb x, b > 1
1
1
1
x
1
x = by
While any number can be used as a base, the most common base used is 10.
Logarithms with base 10 are called common logarithms. Common logarithms
were used for complicated calculations before the invention of the hand-held
calculator in the 1970s. For convenience, log10 x is usually written as just log x,
and the base is understood to be 10. Calculators are programmed in base 10, and
with this base we can use the calculator to sketch the graph of y log x.
Exponential Form
Logarithmic Form
x by
y logb x
b 0 and b 1
The logarithm of a number x with a given base is the exponent to which that
base must be raised to yield x.
262 C H A P T E R 7
EXAMPLE 1
EXAMPLE 2
EXAMPLE 3
b. log255 12
Solution
a. If log381 4, then 34 81.
1
123 8
a. 53 125
b.
Solution
a. If 53 125, then log5125 3.
b. If 12
3
b. log 4.6
c. log 0.0231
Solution
The answers are given to the accuracy of a calculator with a 10-digit display.
a. log10500 = 2.698 970 004
b. log 4.6 = 0.662 757 831
c. log 0.0231 = 1.636 388 02
EXAMPLE 4
b. log327
Solution
a. Let log525 x.
c. log214
d. log127
3
b. Let log327 x.
c. Let log214 x.
d. Let log127 x.
3
x
Then 13 27 or (31) x 3x 27.
263
Exercise 7.1
Part A
1. Write each of the following in logarithmic form.
a. 32 9
1
d. 36 2 6
Knowledge/
Understanding
c. 12 14
f. 23 18
2
b. 90 1
2
e. 27 3 9
b. log71 0
d. log717 1
c. log 521
2
5
e. log19 2
f. log927 32
b. log 0.24
c. log 1000
d. log 52
e. log 1.35
f. log 52648
Part B
Application
Knowledge/
Understanding
Application
d. log327
264 C H A P T E R 7
c. log381
e. log218
h. log242
f. log321
7
4
i. log232
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
b. log525
b. log913 log319
c. log636
log255
e. log39 9
f. log216 3
1
b. log4x 2
c. logx27 3
d. log4614 x
e. logx19 2
f. log1x 2
4
Communication
9. Explain how you find the value of a logarithm. Give specific examples to
illustrate your thought processes.
Part C
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
265
y
1
1
1
INVESTIGATION
x
1
y = logbx, b > 1
e. log225
f. log334
g. log 103.6
h. log 105.78
i. 5log525
j. 4log 464
k. 10log6
l. 10log97
266 C H A P T E R 7
logb1 0
Proof
Let log b1 y.
From the definition, by 1 b 0.
Then y 0 and log b1 0.
2.
log b b 1
Proof
Let log b b y.
From the definition, by b b1.
Then y 1 and log b b 1.
3.
log b b x x
Proof
Let log b b x y.
From the definition, by b x.
Then y x and log b b x x.
4.
blog b x x
Proof
Let blog b x y.
From our knowledge of exponentials, we can write y b t for some value
of t.
Then blog b x bt.
Now logb x t.
From the definition, b t x y.
Then blog b x x.
7 . 2 P R O P E RT I E S O F L O G A R I T H M S
267
Properties of Logarithms
When x 0, w 0, and r is a real number,
log a xw log a x log aw
log a wx log a x log aw
log a x r rlog a x.
These properties allow us to simplify expressions that might otherwise be
complicated.
268 C H A P T E R 7
EXAMPLE 1
Solution
a. log10(47 512) 4.381 367 8 (by calculator)
b. log3(81 243) log381 log3(243) 4 5 9
c. log 42 log 432 log 4(2 32) log 464 3
EXAMPLE 2
5
b. log272
6
c. log248 log23
d. log545
Solution
a. log32871 log327 log381 3 4 1,
or log3287
log313 log3(31) 1
1
b. log27256 log275 log226
c. log248 log23 log2438 log216 4
d. log545 log5(5 9) log55 log59 1 log59
EXAMPLE 3
EXAMPLE 4
7 . 2 P R O P E RT I E S O F L O G A R I T H M S
269
EXAMPLE 5
1
2
Evaluate 3
log349
Solution
Consider the exponent first.
12 log349 log3(49)
1
2
log3(17)
1
2
Now, 3
log349
log3(17)
3
17.
EXAMPLE 6
3.08.
x
log 7
b. 7(1.06x) 5.20
Taking logarithms of each side,
log 7 x log 1.06 log 5.20
x log 1.06 log 5.20 log 7
log 5.20 log 7
x
log 1.06
5.10.
EXAMPLE 7
Describe the relation between the graph of y log2 x and the graph of each of the
following:
a. y log2 x2
b. y log2(4x)
Solution
a. Since log2 x2 2 log2 x, the graph of y log2 x2 is a vertical dilatation of y
log2 x by a factor of 2.
b. Since log24x log24 log2 x 2 log2 x, the graph of y log24x is a
vertical translation of the graph of y log2 x by 2 units upwards.
270 C H A P T E R 7
Exercise 7.2
Part A
1. Write each of the following as a sum of logarithms.
a. loga(xy)
b. logm(pq)
b. logas logar
b. logasr
a. log6134
1
c. log7x 3
3
4
d. loga6
b. logayxz
xy
Part B
Knowledge/
Understanding
b. y log3(9x)
c. y log3(27x)
d. y log33x
c. y log3x3
d. y log3x
b. y log3x2
Application
a. log3135 log35
b. log240 log245
d. log5(2.5) log510
e. log2224 log27
c. log8640 log810
f. log336 log334
b. log318 log332
c. log416 log41
d. log553
e. log240 log252
f. log444 log333
g. log214 log247
h. log5200 log58
i. log64 log654
7 . 2 P R O P E RT I E S O F L O G A R I T H M S
271
10. Use the properties of logarithms to write each of the following in terms of
logax, logay, and logaw.
3
a. loga
x2y4
b. loga
w
x3y2
d. logaxy3 4
x3 y 4
c. loga
1 2
x4y3
1
Application
a. 102x 495
b. 103x 0.473
c. 10x 31.46
d. 7x 35.72
e. (0.6)4x 0.734
f. (3.482)x 0.0764
b. 7x9 56
c. 53x4 25
d. 102x1 95
e. 6x5 71.4
f. 352x 875
13. Solve each of the following. Write your answers correct to two decimal
places.
Application
a. 2 3x 7 5x
b. 12x 4 82x
c. 4.6 1.062x3 5 3x
e. 12 62x1 11x3
f. 7 0.432x 9 6x
g. 5x 32x 92
h. 4 5x 3(0.4)2x 11
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
and Communication
b. (4 log5x 2 log5y)
3 log5w
15. Describe the transformation that takes the graph of the first function to that of
the second.
a. y logx and y log(10x)
b. y log2x and y log2(8x2)
c. y log3x and y log3(27x3)
Part C
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
Communication
) log5(125 5
) b. log4(2 32
) log273
a. log3(27 81
272 C H A P T E R 7
EXAMPLE 1
Solve log6x 2.
Solution
log6 x 2
Then
x 62
x 36.
The root of the equation is x 36.
Checking, log636 2, therefore the root is admissible.
EXAMPLE 2
7 . 3 S O LV I N G L O G A R I T H M I C E Q UAT I O N S
273
In the last chapter, we considered some problems involving the exponential function in which it was difficult to solve the resulting equation. Using logarithms
makes this process much easier.
EXAMPLE 3
Solve 3x 23.
Solution
Take the logarithm of each side.
log 3x log 23
Now use the logarithmic properties to simplify and isolate the variable x.
x log 3 log 23
log 23
x
log 3
This is the exact value of x. You can use your calculator to determine an
approximate value:
log 23
2.85
x
log 3
Exercise 7.3
Part B
1. Solve the following:
Knowledge/
Understanding
a. log2 x 2 log24
b. log3 x 4 log33
c. 2 log5 x log536
d. 2 log x 4 log 7
2. Solve the following. Give the answer correct to two decimal places.
a. 3x 5
b. 5x 6
c. 2x 1 4
d. 7 12 4x
3. Solve for x.
a. logx 2 log3 3 log2
1
2
1
3
274 C H A P T E R 7
c. log2(x 2) 3 log2x
d. log4x log4(x 6) 2
e. log5(2x 2) log5(x 1) log5(x 1)
Communication
Application
Application
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
7 . 3 S O LV I N G L O G A R I T H M I C E Q UAT I O N S
275
276 C H A P T E R 7
Date
Magnitude
Death Toll
Tangshan, China
7.8 to 8.2
240 000
Tokyo, Japan
Sept. 1, 1923
8.3
200 000
Gansu, China
8.6
100 000
Northern Peru
7.7
70 000
Northern Iran
7.3 to 7.7
50 000
EXAMPLE 1
IG 107.5I0 .
We use the formula to compare the intensity of the Indian earthquake to the
intensity of the reference earthquake (I0).
6.4 logII
I
II 106.4I0 .
Now we can compare the intensity of the Guatemalan earthquake to the intensity
of the Indian earthquake.
I
107.5I0
G 6
II
10 .4I0
101.1
12.6
IG 12.6II
The intensity of the Guatemalan earthquake was 12.6 times the intensity of the
Indian earthquake.
277
transmit sound to the inner ear. In the inner ear, sound waves are converted to
readable nerve impulses by approximately 16 000 hair-like receptor cells, which
sway with the sound waves. These cells can be severely damaged by loud sounds,
resulting in permanent hearing loss. If you lose one third of these cells, your
hearing will be significantly impaired. Hearing loss is progressive. Some hearing
loss is inevitable with age, but we would lose much less if we protected our ears
at the appropriate times.
The loudness of any sound is measured relative to the loudness of sound at the
threshold of hearing. Sounds at this level are the softest that can still be heard.
EXAMPLE 2
A sound is 1000 times more intense than a sound you can just hear. What is the
measure of its loudness in decibels?
Solution
The loudness of a sound is calculated using the formula L 10 logII.
0
10 log 1000
10 3
30.
278 C H A P T E R 7
Soft whisper
60 dB
Normal conversation
80 dB
Shouting
90 dB
Subway
100 dB
Screaming child
120 dB
Rock concert
140 dB
Jet engine
180 dB
Space-shuttle launch
How many more times intense is the sound of normal conversation (60 dB) than
the sound of a whisper (30 dB)?
Solution
Let the intensity of the normal conversation be In and the intensity of the whisper
be Iw. We use our formula to compare the intensity of the normal conversation to
the intensity of a sound at the threshold of hearing (I0).
60 10 logIn
I
I
n 106
I0
In 106I0
Now we use our formula to compare the intensity of the whisper to the intensity
of a sound at the threshold of hearing (I0).
30 10 logIw
I
I
w 103
I0
Iw 103I0
7.4 WHERE WE USE LOGARITHMS
279
103
In 1000Iw
The intensity of normal conversation is 1000 times the intensity of a whisper.
L O G A R I T H M S A N D C H E M I S T RY
Chemists measure the acidity of a liquid by determining the concentration of the
hydrogen ion [H] in the liquid. This concentration is measured in moles per litre.
Since this is usually a very small number, a far more convenient measure uses
logarithms and is called the pH of a liquid.
EXAMPLE 4
280 C H A P T E R 7
Alternate Solution
pH log(6.1 108)
(log 6.1 log 108)
(.79 8)
7.21
The pH of the pool is 7.21.
EXAMPLE 5
The pH of a fruit juice is 3.10. What is the hydrogen ion concentration of the fruit
juice?
Solution
pH log[H]
3.10 log[H]
log[H] 3.10
[H] 103.10
0.000 79
The hydrogen ion concentration is 7.9 104 mol/L.
Exercise 7.4
Part B
Communication
Knowledge/
Understanding
Knowledge/
Understanding
Application
281
Application
Communication
7. An earthquake in the Quetta area of Pakistan on May 31, 1935, measured 6.8
on the Richter scale. This quake killed 50 000 people. On October 2, 1987,
an earthquake of magnitude 6.1 shook Los Angeles, California, and killed six
people.
a. Compare the magnitude of the two earthquakes.
b. Why do you think the death toll was so much higher with the earthquake
in Pakistan?
8. On January 24, 1939, an earthquake measuring 8.3 occurred in Chillan, Chile,
killing 28 000 people. On September 21, 1999, an earthquake in Taiwan
measured 7.6 on the Richter scale and killed 2100 people. Compare the
intensities of these two earthquakes.
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
9. Sasha needs a new muffler on her car. She has been told that the sound from
her car was measured at 120 dB. After installing the new muffler, the loudness
of her car is 75 dB. How many times more intense was the sound from her
defective muffler?
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
10. Tanias infant daughter has colic and cries during the night. The noise level in
the house at these times is 75 dB. When the baby finally falls asleep, the noise
level is 35 dB. How many times more intense is the noise level in the house
when the baby is crying?
11. How many times more intense is the sound of a space-shuttle launch (180 dB)
than the sound of a jet engine (140 dB)?
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
Application
12. Jonathan lives near a busy street. He has all the windows in his home open
and measures the noise level inside as 79 dB. He closes the windows and
finds the noise level is 68 dB. By what factor did the intensity of the noise
decrease when Jonathan closed the windows?
13. Find the hydrogen ion concentration of milk, which has a pH of 6.50.
14. Find the hydrogen ion concentration of milk of magnesia, which has
a pH of 10.50.
282 C H A P T E R 7
Determine log263.
t chnology
Solution
Let log263 y.
Then 2y 63.
EXAMPLE 1
Can this be done in any situation? Lets consider a general case and prove that
log x
a
logbx
, where a 0.
log b
a
Proof
Let logb x y.
From the definition, by x.
Taking logarithms of both sides, using base a,
logaby loga x
y logab loga x
log x
a
.
y
log b
a
loga x
.
Then logb x
loga b
283
Since this is true for any base a, it is certainly true for the particular base 10, and
we can use this to determine logarithms given any base.
Change of Base Formula
log x
a
logbx
log b
a
EXAMPLE 2
Use your calculator to find the value of log323, correct to two decimal places.
Solution
log 23
log323
log 3
2.8540
Correct to two decimal places, log323 2.85.
EXAMPLE 3
1
.
Prove that logt b
log t
b
Proof
log b
logt b
log t
1
log t
log b
1
log t
b
1
logt b
logb t
EXAMPLE 4
1
1
1
.
Show that
log a
log a
log a
3
12
Solution
1
1
loga3 loga4
log3a
log4a
loga12
1
log a
12
1
1
1
.
Therefore,
log a
log a
log a
3
284 C H A P T E R 7
12
EXAMPLE 5
ab
1
(log a log b).
If a2 b2 14ab, where a 0, b 0, show that log
4
2
Solution
Since
a2 b2 14ab
a2 2ab b2 16ab
(a b)2 16ab
2
ab
4
ab.
Then
log a log b.
ab
1
(log a log b).
log
4
2
We noted at the beginning of this discussion that the graph of y logbx is not
immediately accessible by calculator. Using the change of base formula, it is easy
to use a graphing calculator to obtain such a graph.
EXAMPLE 6
t chnology
b. y log0.5 x
Solution
log x
1
log x
a. log5x
log 5
log 5
1
log x and graph the
Input y
log 5
function.
log x
1
log x
b. log0.5x
log 0.5
log 0.5
1
log x and graph the
Input y
log 0.5
function.
285
Exercise 7.5
Part B
Knowledge/
Understanding
Application
Application
Communication
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
1. Use your calculator to find the value of each of the following, correct to three
decimal places.
a. log521
b. log7124
c. log63.24
d. log44.7
1
1
1
b.
log8a
log2a
log4a
2
1
c.
log6a
log36a
2
4
1
d.
log8a
log2a
log4a
b. y 4 log2 x
c. y log0.5x
d. y log0.2 x2
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
286 C H A P T E R 7
y
1
1
1
x
1
y = logb x, b > 1
1
1
1
x
1
x = by
log b1 0
log b b 1
log b b x x
blog b x x
Properties of Logarithms
For x 0, w 0, and r a real number:
log a xw log a x log aw
a
log b x
log b
a
1
log b x
log x b
KEY CONCEPTS REVIEW
287
wrap-up
a. Use log rules to show that pH 2[log(CO2) log(K)] and determine the
change in pH if the percentage of CO2 increases from 0.03% to 0.06%.
Is this a significant change? Explain.
b. Aquatic toxicologists conduct research on the response of fish and other
aquatic species to the environmental contamination of their ecosystem. The
data in the table was collected in a lab study to examine the effect of pH
on a fish population.
Obtain an algebraic expression for population
pH
Population
as a function of pH by linearizing the
4.0
250
population data in the table and obtaining an
4.5
353
equation of the form P 10k(pH)d, where k is
the growth rate factor and d is a constant.
5.0
500
Verify your equation by looking at doubling
5.5
707
patterns in the table and plotting both
6.0
1000
equations on the graphing calculator.
c. An environmental assessment has established that a 25% decline in a
population due to decreased pH is tolerable. Use your model from part b to
determine how low the pH can drop. What percentage of carbon dioxide does
this correlate to? The initial pH is 6.0 and the initial population is 1000.
288 C H A P T E R 7
Review Exercise
1. Evaluate each of the following:
1
b. log5
125
a. log327
c. log 432
d. log 636
log327
c. log525
d. 7log 75
b. log(x 3) log x 1
log(35 x3)
3
c. log5(x 2) log5(x 1) 2 log53 d.
log(5 x)
t chnology
8. Use your calculator to find the value of each of the following, correct to three
decimal places.
a. log19264
b. log534.62
2
1
3
.
9. Show that
log a
log a
log a
9
t chnology
b. y 2 log6(6x)
REVIEW EXERCISE
289
Chapter 7 Test
Achievement Category
Questions
Knowledge/Understanding
All questions
Thinking/Inquiry/Problem Solving
8, 10, 11
Communication
3, 5
Application
2, 4, 6, 7, 9
d. log525
b. log5125
c. log21
6
e. log28 log39
f. log39 3
1
a. log25 log210
b. log6108 log63
Cumulative Review
CHAPTERS 57
dy
1. Find d
for the following:
x
2
b. 4x2 16y2 64
a. x y2 324
d. 2x2 xy 2y 5
c. x2 16y2 5x 4y
1
e. 1x y 1
f. (2x 3y)2 10
b. x3 y3 y 21 at (3, 2)
3x 9
at (1, 2)
d. y2
7x2 4
2
2
b. f (x)
x2
4
c. f (x)
d. f (x) x4 x14
x
d 2y
C U M U L AT I V E R E V I E W C H A P T E R S 5 7
291
i) C(x) 5x 100
b. Find dt , where 5x2 y 100 and ddxt 10, when x 10.
10. An environmental study of a suburban community suggests that t years from
now, the average level of carbon monoxide in the air will be
q(t) 0.05t2 0.1t 3.4 parts per million.
a. At what rate will the carbon monoxide level be changing with respect to
time one year from now?
b. By how much will the carbon monoxide level change in the first year?
11. Suppose a spherical piece of ice is melting at a rate of 5 cm3/min and retains
its spherical shape at all times. How fast is the radius changing at the instant
when the radius is 4 cm? How fast is the surface area of the sphere changing
at the same instant?
12. Sand is being dumped on a pile in such a
way that it always forms a cone whose
radius equals its height. If the sand is
being dumped at a rate of 10 m3/h, at
what rate is the height of the pile increasing when there are 1050 m3 of sand in
the pile?
e
t chnology
d. y 2
292 C H A P T E R 7
b. y 10x 1
c. y 5x2 3
e. y 3ex1 2
f. y 8 ex
(27) 3 42
a.
48
3
d. 913
b. 4 2x1
e5
c. e25
e3e2x
e.
ex
f. (e4x)3
a. 52x9 125
1 x3
c. 4
e. ex 1
1 x1
8
d. 22x 12(2x) 32 0
f. e2x ex 2 0
16. Digital cable is being introduced into a certain city. The number of
80 000
.
subscribers t months from now is expected to be N(t)
1 10e0.2t
a. How many subscribers will there be after six months?
b. How many subscribers will there eventually be?
17. A rumour spreads through a school. After the rumour has begun,
50
people have heard the rumour where t is in hours.
N(t)
1 49et
How many people have heard it after 4 h?
18. Assume that the annual rate of inflation will average 5% over the next ten
years.
a. Write an equation to represent the approximate cost, C, of goods or
services during any year in that decade.
b. If the price of a mechanical inspection for your car is presently $39.95,
estimate the price ten years from now.
c. If the price of an oil change ten years from now is $40.64, determine the
price of an oil change today.
19. The value of a new car depreciates at a rate of 25% per year.
a. Write an equation to represent the approximate value, V, of a car purchased for $30 000.
b. Determine the value of the car two years after it is purchased.
c. Approximately how many years will it take until the car is worth $3000?
e
t chnology
1200
720
432
259.2
155.52
C U M U L AT I V E R E V I E W C H A P T E R S 5 7
293
a. y log2x
c. y 3 log(2 x)
b. log216
c. log3243
d. log0.001
e. log82
f. log4 18
g. log10
h. log2.2
i. loga a12
j. 4log47
k. 1010log3
l. a8loga a
23. Use the properties of logarithms to write each expression as a sum, difference,
and/or multiple of logarithms.
xy
a. log23
b. logz
x1
d. log
x1
x 4
e. log
x5
2
c. log15
f. loga4a5
c. 2log 3 12log(x2 1)
logx
a. log212
d. log8 4
b. log3 12
e. log46
c. log38
f. log 12 15
c. x 3log3 243 = 4 log2512
d. log5(2x 5) 2
e. 2 log3(4x 1) 4
f. log12x log12(x 2) 1 2
g.
2x
7
i. log(x 4) 1
h. log10 x 1
j. (log x)2 3log x 10 0
27. The level of sound in decibels is SL 10log(I 1012) where I is the intensity
of the sound in watts per square metre (W/m2). A decibel, or dB, named for
Alexander Graham Bell, is the smallest increase of the loudness of a sound
that is detectable by the human ear.
a. What is the sound level when the intensity is 2.51 105 W/m2?
b. The threshold of pain is 120 dB. A room with appliances on has an intensity
of 6.31 104. Is the sound level in the room bearable to the human ear?
c. Write the intensity of sound of normal conversation, 50 dB, in scientific
notation.
d. Calculate the intensity of the sound at a rock concert where the sound level
is 110 dB.
294 C H A P T E R 7
Chapter 8
D E R I VAT I V E S O F E X P O N E N T I A L A N D
LOGARITHMIC FUNCTIONS
Properties of Logarithms
logb(pq) logb p logbq
logbq logb p logbq
logb(pr) rlogb p
p
logb(br) r
Properties of Exponents
bmbn bmn
m
bbn bmn
(bm)n bmn
blogb(m) m
y = bx
y = bx
x
y = logb x
y = logb x
for b 1
for 0 b 1
b
for any a, b 0.
If y log a p, then y
log a
b
296 C H A P T E R 8
Exercise
1. Evaluate each of the following:
a. 32
2
b. 32 5
c. 27
2
3
d.
232
b. 42 11
6
c. x3 3
e. 38 z
f. ab T
d. logbA W
b. log100.0001
c. log1020 log105
d. log220 log25
e. 32log3 5
f. log3539325
3
2
5. In each of the following, use the change of base formula to express the given
logarithm in terms of the base b, and then use a calculator to evaluate to three
decimal places.
a. log2(80), b e
b. 3log522 2log515, b 10
b. y 5x3
297
investigate
C H A P T E R 8 : R AT E - O F - C H A N G E M O D E L S I N M I C R O B I O L O G Y
How would you find the slope of the function
5
y
3
using each of the Power, Product, Quotient, and Chain Rules? While this task
would be very difficult using traditional methods of differentiation, it will be painfree when you use the logarithmic and exponential differential calculus methods
of this chapter. In addition to developing ideas and skills, you will also take the
logarithmic and exponential models constructed in Chapters 6 and 7 and utilize
them in rate-of-change applications.
Case Study Microbiologist
Microbiologists contribute their expertise to many fields, including
medicine, environmental science, and biotechnology. Enumerating, the
process of counting bacteria, allows microbiologists to build mathematical
models that predict populations. Once they can predict a population
accurately, the model could be used in
Time
Population
medicine, for example, to predict the dose of
(in
hours)
medication required to kill a certain bacterial
0
1000
infection. The data set in the table was used by
a microbiologist to produce a polynomial0.5
1649
based mathematical model to predict
1.0
2718
population p(t), as a function of time t, in
1.5
4482
hours, for the growth of a certain bacteria:
2.0
7389
1 5
t
p(t) 1000 1 t 12t2 16t3 21
t4
4
120
DISCUSSION QUESTIONS
1. How well does the equation fit the data set? Use the equation, a graph,
and/or the graphing calculator to comment on the goodness of fit.
2. What is the population after 0.5 h? How fast is the population growing at
this time? (Use calculus to determine this.) Complete these calculations for the
1.0 h point.
3. What pattern did you notice in your calculations? Explain this pattern by
examining the terms of this equation to find the reason why.
The polynomial function in this case is an approximation of the special function
in mathematics, natural science, and economics, f(x) e x, where e has a value
of 2.718 28. At the end of this chapter, you will complete a task on rates of
change of exponential growth in a biotechnology case study.
298 C H A P T E R 8
b
b
lim
h
xh
h0
b b b
(Properties of the exponential function)
lim
h
x
h0
bx (bh 1)
The factor
bx
h0
In fact,
b 1
f(0) b0 lim
h
h
h0
b 1
.
lim
h
h
h0
Therefore if f(x)
f(x) bx f(0)
bx,
or
f(x) f(x)f(0).
Here we have a surprising result. The derivative at any point is the product of the
value of the function at that point and a constant. This constant is the value of the
slope of the function at x 0, namely f(0). In other words, the slope of the
tangent line at a given point is proportional to the y-coordinate at that point.
It is clear that as b changes, the value of f(0) will change. Is there any value of b
that gives a particularly useful result? The following investigation addresses this
question.
INVESTIGATION
b 1
The purpose of this investigation is to examine the value of f(0) lim
h
h
h0
8 . 1 D E R I VAT I V E S O F E X P O N E N T I A L F U N C T I O N S
299
b 1
1?
3. a. What is the maximum value of b so that the lim
h
h
h0
b 1
1?
b. What is the minimum value of b so that the lim
h
h
h0
bh 1
1 in calculating f(x) f(x) f(0)?
4. What is the implication of lim
h0 h
5. Repeat Question 1 of this Investigation using b 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, and 2.8.
6. By further investigation, determine, correct to three decimal places, the value
for b that gives a value of the limit closest to 1.
y
y = 3x
y = 2x
y = ex
1
x
1
t chnology
Slope of
tangent
is e x
(x,e x )
ex
y = ex
To try this Investigation utilizing a spreadsheet option, please refer to page 447 of
the Technical Assistance Appendix.
EXAMPLE 1
t chnology
a. f(x) x2ex
300 C H A P T E R 8
b. g(x) ex x
2
Solution
a. Using the Product Rule,
f(x) 2xex x2e x
ex(2x x2).
b. If we let u x2 x and use the Chain Rule,
g(u) eu
dg
dg du
dx
du dx
eu(2x 1)
ex x (2x 1).
2
In general, if f(x) e g(x), then f(x) eg(x) g(x) by the Chain Rule.
EXAMPLE 2
Solution
f(x) 3ex (2x)
2
6xex
Then
f(1) 6e.
Answers are usually left in this form. If desired, numeric approximations can be
obtained from a calculator. Here f(1) 16.31 correct to two decimals.
EXAMPLE 3
Determine the equation of the line tangent to the graph of y xex at the point
where x 2.
Solution
When x 2, y 2e2, so (2, 2e2) is the point of contact of the tangent.
y ex xex
ex(1 x)
When x 2, y 3e2.
The equation of the tangent is y 2e2 3e2(x 2)
or 3e2x y 4e2 0.
EXAMPLE 4
ex
Determine the equation of the line tangent to the graph of y 2 , x 0, at the
x
point where x 2.
8 . 1 D E R I VAT I V E S O F E X P O N E N T I A L F U N C T I O N S
301
Solution
Using the Quotient Rule,
t chnology
exx2 ex(2x)
dy
2
dx
(x )2
x
e x(x 2)
x4
x
e (x 2)
, x 0.
x3
dy
When x 2, d
0, and the tangent is
x
We will return to the problem of finding the derivative of the general exponential
function f(x) b x in Section 8.3.
Exercise 8.1
Part A
1. If f(x) e x, compare the graphs of y f(x) and y f(x).
Communication
2. Why can you not use the Power Rule for derivatives to differentiate y 2x?
3. Use the Chain Rule and the new Exponential Derivative Rule to find the
derivative for each of the following:
Knowledge/
Understanding
a. y e3x
b. s e3t5
d. y e3x
e. y e 56xx
f. y e x
e. f(x) xex
302 C H A P T E R 8
c. y 2e10t
2
x 3
e
c. f(x)
x
b. y xe3x
3t 2
e
d. s
t2
e2t
1e
h. g(t)
2t
t chnology
2e
6. a. Find the equation of the tangent to the curve defined by y
1 ex
at the point (0, 1).
b. Use technology to graph the function in part a and draw the tangent at
(0, 1).
c. Compare the equation in part a to the computer equation.
Part B
Application
x
5
dy d2y
d 3y
.
11. a. For the function y e3x, determine d
, and
x dx2
dx3
dny
.
b. From the pattern in part a, state the value for
dxn
12. For each of the following, determine the equation of the tangent at the
given point.
a. For the curve defined by y exy 0 at A(0, 1).
b. For the curve defined by x2ey 1 at B(1, 0).
c. Explain why these relations cannot easily be graphed using a calculator.
Application
.
t
30
8 . 1 D E R I VAT I V E S O F E X P O N E N T I A L F U N C T I O N S
303
14. The distance (in metres) fallen by a skydiver t seconds after jumping
(and before her parachute opens) is s 160 14t 1 e
t
4
.
e 1
a. lim
h
h
b. lim h
h0
h0
16. For what values of m does the function y Aemt satisfy the following
equation?
d2y
dy
d
6y 0
dx2
x
17. The hyperbolic functions are defined as sinh x 12(ex ex) and
cosh x 12(e x ex).
sinh x
.
c. Prove Dx tanh x 2 , if tanh x
cosh x
t chnology
CATALOG
0
2. Press 2nd
for the list of CATALOG items and select cosh( to investigate
if cosh is a built-in function.
304 C H A P T E R 8
t chnology
y = ex
x
y = ln x
y =x
dy
,
We could investigate this limit in order to determine the value of d
x
an investigation we will consider later. First, we can determine the derivative of
the natural logarithm function using the derivative of the exponential function we
developed in the previous section.
Given y ln x, we can rewrite this as ey x. Differentiating both sides of this
equation with respect to x, and using implicit differentiation on the left side,
yields
dy
ey d
1
x
dy
1
y
e
dx
1x.
The derivative of the natural logarithmic function y ln x is
dy
1
, x 0.
x
dx
8 . 2 T H E D E R I VAT I V E O F T H E N AT U R A L L O G A R I T H M I C F U N C T I O N
305
dy
y = ln x
1
x
1
EXAMPLE 1
dy
Find d
for the following functions:
x
ln x
x
a. y ln(5x)
b. y
3
c. y ln(x2 e x)
Solution
a. y ln(5x)
Solution 1
Using the Chain Rule,
dy
1
(5)
5x
dx
dy
1
0
x
dx
1x
1x
ln x
x
b. y
3
Using the Quotient and Power Rules,
d
d
(ln(x)) x3 ln(x)(x3)
dy
dx
dx
dx
(x3)2
1
x3 ln(x) 3x2
x
6
x
x2 3x2ln(x)
x6
1 3ln(x)
x
.
4
c. y ln(x2 ex)
Using the Chain Rule,
dy
1
d (x2 ex)
dx
(x2 ex) dx
2x ex
(x e )
.
2
x
306 C H A P T E R 8
Solution 2
y ln(5x) ln(5) ln(x)
1
g(x), by the Chain Rule.
If f(x) ln(g(x)), then f(x)
g(x)
EXAMPLE 2
ln x
at the point where x 1.
Determine the equation of the line tangent to y
3x
Solution
ln l 0, so y 0 when x 1, and the point of contact of the tangent is (1, 0).
dy
6 3ln x
9x2
2
dy
When x 1, d
23.
x
The equation of the tangent is y 0 23(x 1), or 2x 3y 2 0.
EXAMPLE 3
t chnology
APPENDIX P. 444
Solution
a. The graph of f(x) x ln x is shown.
Use the minimum value function, 3:minimum,
in the CALCULATE mode of your calculator to
find the minimum value of f(x). The minimum
value occurs at x 4.
b. f(x) x ln x
To minimize f(x), set the derivative equal to
zero.
1
2x
f(x) 1x
1
1
0
x
2x
1
1
x
2x
x 2x
x2 4x
x(x 4) 0
x 4 or x 0
8 . 2 T H E D E R I VAT I V E O F T H E N AT U R A L L O G A R I T H M I C F U N C T I O N
307
and, specifically,
ln(1 h) ln(1)
ln(1 h)
lim h
h0
1
1
h0
ln e 1,
Since
ln lim (1 h) h ln e.
1
h0
1
lim (1 h) h e.
Therefore,
h0
1
h
0.1
0.01
0.001
0.0001
2.59374246
2.704813829
2.71692393
2.7181459268
308 C H A P T E R 8
Exercise 8.2
Part A
Communication
n
express e as e lim 1 1n . Justify the definition by evaluating the limit
n
Knowledge/
Understanding
a. y ln(5x 8)
b. y ln(x2 1)
c. s 5ln t3
d. y ln
x1
e. s ln(t3 2t2 5)
f. w ln
z2 3z
ln x
b. y
x2
c. y e ln(x)
d. y [ln x]3
e. v et ln t
et
h. h(u) e
g. s
ln t
t chnology
ln u
x 1
i. f(x) ln
x1
2
t chnology
lnx
7. a. Find the equation of the tangent to the curve defined by f(x)
at the
x
point where x 1.
b. Use technology to graph the function in part a, and then draw the tangent
at the point where x 1.
c. Compare the equation in part a to the equation obtained on the calculator
or computer.
8 . 2 T H E D E R I VAT I V E O F T H E N AT U R A L L O G A R I T H M I C F U N C T I O N
309
Part B
Application
t chnology
Application
11. The velocity in kilometres per hour of a car as it begins to slow down is given
by the equation v(t) 90 30 ln(3t 1), where t is in seconds.
a. What is the velocity of the car as the driver begins to brake?
b. What is the acceleration of the car?
c. What is the acceleration at t 2?
d. How long does it take the car to stop?
12. The pH value of a chemical solution measures the acidity or alkalinity of the
solution. The formula is
pH log10(H)
ln (H)
ln (10)
where H is the concentration of hydrogen ions in the solution (in moles per
litre).
a. Tomatoes have H 6.3 105. Find the pH value.
b. Recipe ingredients are being added to a bowl of tomatoes, so that the
concentration of hydrogen ions in the whole mixture is given by
H(t) 30 5t 25e
t
5
d F
F 18ke2S.
between two objects, then prove
dS 2
14. For each of the following, find the slope of the tangent.
a. For the curve defined by xey yln x 2, at (1, ln2).
1
0, at the point , 3.
b. For the curve defined by lnxy
3
310 C H A P T E R 8
Part C
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
ln(2 h) ln(2)
.
15. Use the definition of the derivative to evaluate lim
h
h0
n
a. Use the Binomial Theorem to expand 1 1n and then evaluate the limit.
n
8 . 2 T H E D E R I VAT I V E O F T H E N AT U R A L L O G A R I T H M I C F U N C T I O N
311
exln b.
Since ln b is a constant for any value of b, we differentiate f(x) exln b using the
Chain Rule and get
f(x) exln (b)ddx (xln b)
exln (b) ln b
eln (b ) ln b
x
bxlnb.
What happens if the exponent is g(x)? Then we have f(x) bg(x). Now we let
u g(x) and use the Chain Rule on f(u) bu, as follows:
df
df du
.
dx
du dx
df
u
Then d
bulnb and dd
g(x).
x
u
df
bg(x)lnb[g(x)]
dx
EXAMPLE 1
Solution
We have f(x) 3g(x) with g(x) x2 2.
Then g(x) 2x.
2
Now, f(x) 3x 2 (ln 3)2x.
We can use these derivatives to solve problems.
EXAMPLE 2
On January 1, 1850, the population of Goldrushtown was 50 000. Since then the
size of the population has been modelled by the function P(t) 50 000(0.98)t,
where t is the number of years since January 1, 1850.
a. What was the population of Goldrushtown on January 1, 1900?
b. At what rate was the population of Goldrushtown changing on January 1,
1900? Was it increasing or decreasing at that time?
Solution
a. January 1, 1900 is exactly 50 years after January 1, 1850, so we let t 50.
P(50) 50 000(0.98)50
18 208.484
The population on January 1, 1900 was approximately 18 208.
b. To determine the rate of change of the population, we require the derivative of P.
P(t) 50 000(0.98)t ln(0.98)
P(50) 50 000(0.98)50 ln(0.98)
367.861
Hence, after 50 years, the population was decreasing at a rate of approximately
368 people per year. (We expected the rate of change to be negative, as the
original population function was a decaying exponential function with a base
less than 1.)
We can now determine the derivative of the general logarithmic function, that is
y logbx, for any base b 0. We use the fact that this logarithmic function can
be written as b y x. Differentiating both sides implicitly with respect to x yields
dy
1
by lnb d
x
dy
1
byln b
dx
1
.
xln b
For the special case of the natural logarithm function, that is, y loge x ln x,
dy
.
this becomes d
x
xlne
x
8 . 3 D E R I VAT I V E S O F G E N E R A L E X P O N E N T I A L A N D L O G A R I T H M I C F U N C T I O N S
313
In the general case, for y logbg(x), by g(x), from the definition of logarithms.
dy
dy
For y logbx, dx
xlnb .
dy
gx
For y logbg(x), dx
g(x)lnb .
EXAMPLE 3
x
.
3x2log2
x2 4
(x2 4)ln2
4
Then
16
g(2) 12 log2
44
(4 4)ln (2)
16
12 log28
8ln 2
3
2
12 log22 2
ln 2
2
2
18 .
12 32
ln 2
ln 2
EXAMPLE 4
If I0 is the intensity of barely audible sound, then the decibel (dB) measure of the
log101
0 dB.
314 C H A P T E R 8
log10(100)
2 dB.
b. We know that ddIt 100 000 and we wish to find ddLt .
L log10 II
0
Differentiate both sides of the equation implicitly with respect to time, t, and get
1
dL
1 dI
dt
I0 dt
I
ln10
I0
1 dI
0
Iln10 I dt
dI
1
.
Iln (10) dt
6.2.
Therefore, the loudness of the siren is increasing at approximately 6.2 dB
per second.
In this section, we learned the derivatives for the general exponential and
logarithmic functions y bx and y logb(x). Many students will wish to compile
a list of formulas and memorize them. However, there is no need to do so. You
can always use identities to convert general exponential and logarithmic functions
to exponential and logarithmic functions with base e, and then use the specific
derivatives of y ex and y ln(x) along with the Chain Rule.
Exercise 8.3
Part A
Knowledge/
Understanding
a. y 23x
c. s 103t5
d. w 10(56nn )
1x
e. y log5(x3 2x2 10) f. y log10
1 x
g. f(x) 7x
h. v log2
t2 3t
i. y 3x 3
2
8 . 3 D E R I VAT I V E S O F G E N E R A L E X P O N E N T I A L A N D L O G A R I T H M I C F U N C T I O N S
315
a. v 2t
b. y 2xlog2(x4)
d. s t 2log10(1 t)
e. f(x)
2
3x
c. p 2log3(5s) log3(4s)
log (3x2)
x1
5
f. y
t1
, evaluate f(3).
3. a. If f(t) log2
2t 7
Communication
t chnology
Communication
316 C H A P T E R 8
Part C
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
10. An earthquake of minimal intensity, I0, is given a value 0 on the Richter scale.
An earthquake of intensity I has a magnitude R log10II on the Richter
0
scale.
8 . 3 D E R I VAT I V E S O F G E N E R A L E X P O N E N T I A L A N D L O G A R I T H M I C F U N C T I O N S
317
EXAMPLE 1
The effectiveness of studying for a test depends on how many hours a student
studies. Some experiments showed that if the effectiveness, E, is put on a scale
of 0 to 10, then E(t) 0.510 te
t
20
t
20
t
20
0.5e
t 210e
1 2t0
t
20
t
20
0
1 2t
0
t 20.
To determine the maximum effectiveness, we use the algorithm for extreme
values.
E(0) 0.510 0e0 5
318 C H A P T E R 8
EXAMPLE 2
A mathematical consultant determines that the proportion of people who will have
responded to the advertisement of a new product after it has been marketed for
t days is given by f(t) 0.71 e0.2t. The area covered by the advertisement
contains 10 million potential customers, and each response to the advertisement
results in revenue to the company of $0.70 (on average), excluding the cost of
advertising. The advertising costs $30 000 to produce and a further $5000 per
day to run.
a. Find lim f(t) and interpret the result.
t
t
319
e0.2t 0.005102041
0.2t ln(0.005102041)
t 26
To determine the maximum profit, we evaluate
P(26) 4.9 1061 e0.2(26) 30 000 5000(26)
4 713 000
The maximum profit of $4 713 000 occurs when the ad campaign runs
for 26 days.
Exercise 8.4
Part A
e
t chnology
1. Use your calculator to graph each of the following functions. From the graph,
find the absolute maximum and absolute minimum values of the given
functions on the indicated intervals.
a. f(x) ex e3x on 0
x
10
t
e
on 1
t
12
b. g(t)
1 ln t
c. m(x) (x 2)e2x on 4
x
4
t2 1
t 1
6 ln t on 1.1
t
10
d. s(t) ln
2
.
where t was measured in weeks. The function was P
0.02t
a. Find the population at the start of the study when t 0.
b. The largest population the forest can sustain is represented mathematically
by the limit as t. Determine this limit.
c. Determine the point of inflection.
d. Graph the function.
e. Explain the meaning of the point of inflection in terms of squirrel
population growth.
Part B
4. The net monthly profit from the sale of a certain product is given (in dollars)
by the formula P(x) 1061 (x 1)e0.001x, where x is the number of
items sold.
a. Find the number of items that yield the maximum profit. At full capacity,
the factory can produce 2000 items per month.
b. Repeat part a, assuming that, at most, 500 items can be produced per
month.
5. Suppose the revenue (in thousands of dollars) for sales of x hundred units of
an electronic item is given by the function R(x) 40x2e0.4x 30, where the
maximum capacity of the plant is eight hundred units. Determine the number
of units to produce so the revenue is a maximum.
6. In a telegraph cable, the speed of the signal is proportional to
v(x) x2 ln1x, where x is the ratio of the radius r of the
R
r
321
t chnology
d. If this model is used up to 1977, calculate the total U.S. investment and
the growth rate.
e. Use the Internet to determine the actual amount of total U.S. investment
in 1977, and calculate the error in the model.
f. If the model is used up to 2007, calculate the expected U.S. investment
and the expected growth rate.
10. If a drug is injected into the body, the concentration C in the blood at time t
k
eat ebt, where a, b(b a), and k
is given by the function C(t)
ba
are positive constants that depend on the drug. At what time does the largest
concentration occur?
t
t
10
t
20
322 C H A P T E R 8
Part C
13. Suppose that in Question 12 the student has only 25 h to study for the two
exams. Is it possible to determine the time to be allocated to each exam?
If so, how?
14. Although it is true that many animal populations grow exponentially for a
period of time, it must be remembered that eventually the food available to
sustain the population will run out and at that point the population will
decrease through starvation. Over a period of time, the population will level
out to the maximum attainable value, L. One mathematical model that will
describe a population that grows exponentially at the beginning and then
levels off to a limiting value L is the logistic model. The equation for this
aL
a (L a)e
8 . 4 O P T I M I Z AT I O N P R O B L E M S
323
EXAMPLE 1
dy
Determine d
for the function y xx, x 0.
x
Solution
Take natural logarithms of each side: ln y x ln x.
dy
y(1 ln x)
Then d
x
xx(1 ln x).
Given the function y xn, for any real values of n, determine d
. To solve this,
x
we take the natural logarithm of both sides of this expression and get
ln y ln xn
n ln x.
Differentiating both sides with respect to x, using implicit differentiation and
remembering that n is a constant, we get
1 dy
1
n
y dx
x
dy
1
ny
x
dx
n
nx 1x
324 C H A P T E R 8
nxn1.
Therefore, ddx (xn) nxn1 for any real value of n.
EXAMPLE 2
dy
dy
2x
.
(x2 3)x ln(x2 3) x
x2 3
dy
2x
y ln(x2 3) x
x2 3
dx
Logarithmic differentiation is useful when the function that we wish to differentiate contains a power with variables in both the base and the exponent.
You will recognize logarithmic differentiation as the method used in the previous
section, and its use makes memorization of many formulas unnecessary. It also
allows for complicated functions to be handled much more easily.
EXAMPLE 3
x2
(x 1)
Given y
, determine d
at x 1.
(2x2 2x 1)
x
dy
Solution
dy
While it is possible to find d
using a combination of the Product, Quotient, and
x
Chain Rules, this process is awkward and time-consuming. Instead, before differentiating, we take the natural logarithm of both sides of the equation.
x2
(x 1)
Since y
,
(2x2 2x 1)
4
(x 1)
x2
ln y ln
(2x2 2x 1)
4
ln(x4 1) ln
x 2 ln(2x2 2x 1)
ln(x4 1) 12ln(x 2) ln(2x2 2x 1).
The right side of this equation looks much simpler. We can now differentiate both
sides with respect to x, using implicit differentiation on the left side.
1 dy
1
1 1
1
(4x3)
(4x 2)
y dx
x4 1
2 x2
2x2 2x 1
3
dy
4x
1
4x 2
y
x4 1
2(x 2)
2x2 2x 1
dx
1
4x 2
(x 1)
x 2 4x
2(x 2)
2x2 2x 1
(2x2 2x 1) x4 1
4
8 . 5 L O G A RT I H M I C D I F F E R E N T I AT I O N
325
While this derivative is a very complicated function, the process of finding the
derivative is straightforward, using only the derivative of the natural logarithm
function and the Chain Rule.
We do not need to simplify this in order to determine the value of the derivative at
x 1.
4
1
4 2
(1 1)1
For x 1, d
2(1 2)
221
(2 2 1) 1 1
x
dy
22 12 2
1.
Exercise 8.5
Part A
1. Differentiate each of the following.
3
a. y x 10
b. f(x) 5x 32
Knowledge/
Understanding
c. s t
d. f (x) xe ex
(x 1)(x 3)
b. y
(x 2)3
c. y x x
d. s 1t
4. Find the equation of the tangent to the curve defined by y x(x ) at the point
where x 2.
2
Part B
1
5. If y
, find the slope of the tangent to the curve at the
(x 1)(x 2)(x 3)
point where x 0.
Application
326 C H A P T E R 8
1
8. The tangent at point A (4, 16) to the curve defined by y x x is extended to
cut the x-axis at B and the y-axis at C. Determine the area of OBC where O
is the origin.
Part C
1
9. The position of a particle that moves on a straight line is given by s(t) t t for
t 0.
a. Find the velocity and acceleration.
b. At what time, t, is the velocity zero? What is the acceleration at that time?
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
8 . 5 L O G A RT I H M I C D I F F E R E N T I AT I O N
327
e lim (1 h) h
h0
e lim 1 1n
n
g(x)
ddx (logb g(x))
g(x)ln b
The only rules that need to be memorized are those in the shaded area. The other
rules can be determined from the first two, using properties of exponential and
logarithmic functions along with logarithmic differentiation.
328 C H A P T E R 8
wrap-up
C H A P T E R 8 : R AT E - O F - C H A N G E M O D E L S I N M I C R O B I O L O G Y
To combat the widespread problem of soil and groundwater contamination,
scientists and engineers have investigated and engineered bacteria capable of
destroying environmental toxicants. The use of bacteria in environmental
clean-ups, known as bioremediation, has been proven effective in destroying
toxic compounds ranging from PCBs to gasoline additives such as benzene. An
environmental engineer conducting a lab study found the growth in mass of a
quantity of bioremediation bacteria follows a logistic growth pattern. The
logistic model is characterized by the familiar S-shaped graph and equation as
follows:
m(t)
mb (t)
L m0 Lkt
e
1
m0
b
[litres per hour]
DO2 10(mc )d
t
329
Review Exercise
1. Use the Chain Rule and the appropriate derivative rule for a logarithmic or
exponential function to find the derivative for each of the following:
a. y e2x3
b. s ln(t3 1)
d. y e3x
e. y ln(ex ex)
f. y 2e
5x
2. Use the appropriate derivative rules to find the derivative for each of the
following. If necessary, use logarithmic differentiation.
a. y xex
xln x
b. y
ex
c. s
t4 2 ln(3t)
d. y
3
2
et 1
e 1
2x
g. y 3x0
f. y
x2 3
(x 2)(x 4)5
(2x 1)
ex
e. s
t
h. e xy ln(x y)
a. f(x) ex
b. y xe10x
2
ln x
at the point
6. Find the equation of the tangent to the curve defined by y
x
where x 4.
e2x 1
e 1
dy
330 C H A P T E R 8
b. y 16y 0.
9. Find the equation of the tangent to the curve defined by y x ex that is
parallel to the line represented by 3x y 9 0.
x
e
at the
10. Find an equation for the normal line to the curve defined by y
1 ln x
point where x 1.
.
t
20
REVIEW EXERCISE
331
kx2
when x 12?
17. The function C(t) K e2t e5t, where K is a positive constant, can be
used to model the concentration at time t, in days, of a drug injected into the
bloodstream.
a. Evaluate lim C(t).
t
b. Find C (t), the rate at which the drug is cleared from circulation.
c. When is this rate equal to zero?
332 C H A P T E R 8
Chapter 8 Test
Achievement Category
Questions
Knowledge/Understanding
All questions
Thinking/Inquiry/Problem Solving
8, 9
Communication
Application
3, 5, 6, 7, 8
dy
3x
e e
d. y
2
3x
b. y ln(x2 6)
c. y 3x 3x
e. y (4x3 x)log10(2x 1)
f. y x
3
ln(x 4)
at x 1.
5. If e xy x, determine d
x
6. For what values of A does the function y e Ax satisfy the equation
y 3y 2y 0?
7. Find the equation of the straight line that is normal to the curve defined by
y 3x xln x at point A(1, 3).
8. The velocity of a particular particle that moves in a straight line under the
influence of forces is given by v(t) 10ekt, where k is a positive constant
and v(t) is in cm/s.
a. Show that the acceleration of this particle is proportional to (a constant
multiple of) its velocity. Explain what is happening to this particle.
b. At time t 0, what is the initial velocity of the particle?
CHAPTER 8 TEST
333
334 C H A P T E R 8
Chapter 9
CURVE SKETCHING
If you are having trouble figuring out a mathematical relationship, what do you do? Many people
find that visualizing mathematical problems is the
best way to understand them and communicate
them more meaningfully. Graphing calculators and
computers are powerful tools for producing visual
information about functions. Similarly, since the
derivative of a function at a point is the slope of
the tangent to the function at that point, the
derivative is also a powerful tool for providing
information about the graph of a function. It
should come as no surprise then that the Cartesian
coordinate system in which we graph functions,
and the calculus that we use to analyze functions
were invented in close succession, in the
seventeenth century. In this chapter, you will see
how to draw the graph of a function using the
methods of calculus, including the first and second
derivatives of the function.
CHAPTER EXPECTATIONS In this chapter, you will
Exercise
1. In the following, solve the given equation.
a. 2y2 y 3 0
b. x2 5x 3 17
c. 4x2 20x 25 0
d. y3 4y2 y 6 0
b. 5(3 x) 3x 1
c. t2 2t 3
d. x2 3x 4 0
336 C H A P T E R 9
a. f(x) (x 1)2 3
b. f(x) x2 5x 6
c. f(x) 1 2x
d. f(x) log10(x 4)
x2 3x 10
x2
a. lim (x2 4)
b. lim
c. lim x23x
d. lim log5(x 1)
x2
x2
x0
x2
1
x
x1
x 3
b. f(x)
2
c. f(x) ex
d. f(x) x5 ln(x)
6. Divide each of the following and write your answer in the form
r
7
ax b . For example, (x2 4x 5) (x 2) x 6 .
q(x)
a. (x2 5x 4) (x 3)
x2
b. (x2 6x 9) (x 1)
337
investigate
C H A P T E R 9 : P R E D I C T I N G S T O C K VA L U E S
Stock-market analysts collect and interpret vast amounts of
information and then predict trends in stock values. Stock analysts
are broken down into two main groups, the fundamentalists who
predict stock values based on analysis of the companies economic
situations, and the technical analysts who predict stock values based
on trends and patterns in the market. Technical analysts spend a
significant amount of their time constructing and interpreting
graphical models that are used to find undervalued stocks that will
give returns in excess of what the market predicts. In this chapter,
your skills in producing and analyzing graphical models will be
extended through the use of differential calculus.
Case Study: Technical Stock Analyst
In order to raise money to expand operations, many
privately owned companies give the public a chance to
own a part of their company through purchasing stock.
Price
Those who buy ownership anticipate obtaining a share in
future profits of the company. Some technical analysts
believe that the greatest profits to be had in the stock
Time
market are through buying brand new stocks and selling
them quickly. A technical analyst predicts that a stocks price over its first several
weeks on the market will follow the pattern shown on the graph. The technical
analyst is advising a person who purchased the stock the day it went on sale.
DISCUSSION QUESTIONS
Make a rough sketch of the graph and answer the following questions:
1. When would you recommend the owner sell her shares? Mark this point on
your graph with an S. What do you notice about the slope, or
instantaneous rate of change, of the graph at this point?
2. When would you recommend the owner get back into the company and buy
shares again? Mark this point on your graph with a B. What do you notice
about the slope, or instantaneous rate of change, of the graph at this point?
3. A concave-down section of a graph is one that opens down, and similarly,
concave up opens up. Mark a C on the graph when the concavity changes
from concave down to concave up. A fellow analyst says that a change in
concavity from concave down to concave up is a signal that a selling
opportunity will soon occur. Do you agree with your fellow analyst? Explain.
At the end of this chapter, you will have an opportunity to apply the tools of
graph sketching to create, evaluate, and apply a model that will be used to
provide advice to clients on when to buy, sell, and hold new stocks.
338 C H A P T E R 9
y
y = x2
1
x
1
x
1
For functions that are both continuous and differentiable, we can determine intervals of increasing and decreasing y-values using the derivative of the function. In
dy
dy
the case of y x2, d
2x. For x 0, d
0, and the slopes of the tangents are
x
x
negative. The interval x 0 corresponds to the decreasing portion of the graph of
9.1 INCREASING AND DECREASING FUNCTIONS
339
dy
EXAMPLE
Use your calculator to obtain graphs of the following functions. Use the graph to
estimate the values of x for which the function (y-values) is increasing, and for
which values of x the function is decreasing. Verify your estimates with an analytic solution.
a. y x3 3x2 2
t chnology
b. y x2ex
Solution
a. Using a calculator, we obtain the graph
of y x3 3x2 2. Using the TRACE
key on the calculator, we estimate that the
function values are increasing on x 2,
decreasing on 2 x 0, and increasing
again on x 0. To verify these estimates
with an analytic solution, we consider the
slopes of the tangents.
The slope of a general tangent to the graph of y x3 3x2 2 is given by
dy
dy
3x2 6x. We first determine values of x for which 0. These values
dx
dx
0, we obtain 3x2 6x 0
Setting d
x
3x(x 2) 0
x 0, x 2
These values of x locate points on the graph at which the slope of the tangent is
zero (i.e., horizontal).
dy
dy
Since d
is defined for all values of x, and since d
0 only at x 2 and
x
x
x 0, it must be either positive or negative for all other values of x. We consider the intervals x 2, 2 x 0, and x 0.
340 C H A P T E R 9
Value of x
Value of
Slope of Tangent
y-Values Increasing
or Decreasing
positive
increasing
negative
decreasing
positive
increasing
dy
3x(x 2)
dx
dy
0
dx
dy
0
dx
dy
0
dx
x 2
2 x 0
x0
xex(2 x)
dy
x0
0x2
x2
Value of
dy
= xex(2 x)
dx
dy
0
dx
dy
0
dx
dy
0
dx
Graph Increasing or
Decreasing
decreasing
increasing
decreasing
341
Exercise 9.1
Part A
Knowledge/
Understanding
Communication
1. Determine the points at which f(x) 0 for each of the following functions:
a. f(x) x3 6x2 1
b. f(x)
x2 4
d. f(x) x 3 (2x 5)
2
3t
b. s
1 t2
d. y 10xex x2ln x
c. y xln x x4
b.
2
x
c.
d.
2
x
t chnology
5. Use a calculator to graph each of the following functions. Inspect the graph to
estimate where the function is increasing and where it is decreasing. Verify
your estimates with an analytic solution.
a. f(x) x3 3x2 1
c. f(x) x 1x
e. f(x) xln(x)
342 C H A P T E R 9
x1
d. f(x)
x2 3
f. f(x) xex
Part B
6. Suppose that f is a differentiable function with derivative
f (x) (x 1)(x 2)(x 3). Determine where the function values of f are
increasing and where they are decreasing.
Application
Application
4
2
b.
y = f(x)
y = f(x)
y = f(x)
2
x
x
4
c.
f (x) is a quadratic
function
f (x) is a quadratic
function
343
12. Use calculus techniques to show that the graph of the quadratic function
f(x) ax2 bx c, a 0, is decreasing on the interval x 2ba and
increasing on the interval x 2b
.
a
Part C
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
344 C H A P T E R 9
(c, f (c))
(c, f (c))
x
f < 0
f > 0
f > 0
f < 0
There are possible implications of f (c) 0 other than the determination of maxima or minima. There are also simple functions for which the derivative does not
exist at certain points. In Chapter 4, we demonstrated three different ways that
this could happen.
EXAMPLE 1
For the function y x4 8x3 18x2, determine all values of x such that
f (x) 0. For each of these values of x, determine whether it gives a relative maximum, a relative minimum, or neither for the function.
Solution
dy
First determine d
.
x
dy
4x3 24x2 36x
dx
4x(x2 6x 9)
4x(x 3)2
dy
9 . 2 C R I T I C A L P O I N T S, R E L AT I V E M A X I M A , A N D R E L AT I V E M I N I M A
345
Both values of x are in the domain of the function. There is a horizontal tangent at
each of these values of x. To determine which of the values of x yield relative
maximum or minimum values of the function, we use a table to analyze the
dy
behaviour of d
and y x4 8x3 18x2.
x
x<0
0<x<3
x>3
dy
dx
0
0
0
y = x4 8x3 + 18x2
decreasing
increasing
increasing
Using the information from the table, we see that at x 0, there is a relative minimum value of the function, since the function values are decreasing before x 0
and increasing after x 0. We can also tell that at x 3 there is neither a relative
maximum nor minimum value, since the function values increase towards this
point and increase away from it.
A calculator gives this graph for
y x4 8x3 18x2, which verifies our
analysis.
EXAMPLE 2
t chnology
Solution
The derivative is f (x) 3x2.
Setting f (x) 0 gives
3x2 0
x 0.
y
y = x3
1
x
1
EXAMPLE 3
t chnology
2
f (x) 23(x 2)
2
1
3
3(x 2)
Note that there is no value of x for which f (x) 0, and f (x) is undefined for
x 2.
2
2
f (x) 1
3(x 2) 3
f (x) 2
3(x 2) 3
2.1
1.43629
1.9
1.43629
2.01
3.09439
1.99
3.09439
2.001
6.6667
1.999
6.66667
2.00001
66.6667
1.99999
66.6667
In this example, the slopes of the tangents to the left of x 2 are approaching
, while the slopes to the right of x 2 are approaching
. Since the
slopes on opposite sides of x 2 are not tending towards the same value, there
is no tangent at x 2 even though there is a point on the graph.
A calculator gives the following graph of
2
y (x 2) 3 . There is a cusp at (2, 0).
9 . 2 C R I T I C A L P O I N T S, R E L AT I V E M A X I M A , A N D R E L AT I V E M I N I M A
347
Notice that in the case of f (x) 0 at a critical point, the slope of the tangent is
zero at that point and the tangent to the graph of y f(x) is horizontal.
dy
348 C H A P T E R 9
2
2
The function f (x) (x 2) 3 has a relative minimum value at x 2, which also
happens to be a critical value of the function.
Every relative maximum or minimum value of a function occurs at a
critical point of the function.
In simple terms, peaks or valleys occur on the graph of a function at places where
the tangent to the graph is horizontal, vertical, or does not exist.
How do we determine whether a critical point yields a relative maximum or minimum value of a function without examining the graph of the function? We use the
first derivative to analyze whether the function is increasing or decreasing on
either side of the critical point.
Algorithm for finding relative maximum and minimum values of a
function f:
1. Find critical points of the function; that is, determine where f (x) 0
and where f (x) is undefined, for x values in the domain of f.
2. Use the first derivative to analyze whether f is increasing or
decreasing on either side of each critical point.
3. Conclude that each critical point locates either a relative maximum
value of the function f, a relative minimum value, or neither.
Exercise 9.2
Part A
Communication
1. Explain what it means to determine the critical points of the graph of a given
function.
9 . 2 C R I T I C A L P O I N T S, R E L AT I V E M A X I M A , A N D R E L AT I V E M I N I M A
349
Knowledge/
Understanding
2. a. For the function y x3 6x2, explain how you would find the critical
points.
b. Determine the critical points for y x3 6x2 and then sketch the graph.
3. For each of the following, find the critical points. Use the first derivative test
to determine whether the critical point is a local maximum, local minimum, or
neither.
a. y x4 8x2
c. y xe4x
2x
b. f(x)
x2 9
d. y ln(x2 3x 4)
4. For each of the parts in Question 3, find the x- and y-intercepts and then
sketch the curve.
5. Find the critical points for each of the following. Determine whether the critical point is a local maximum or minimum and whether or not the tangent is
parallel to the horizontal axis.
a. h(x) 6x3 18x2 3
1
3
t chnology
b. s t2e3t
1
c. y (x 5)
d. f(x) (x2 1) 3
e. g(t) t5 t3
f. y x2 12x 3
1
Knowledge/
Understanding
7. Find the critical points for each of the following functions, and determine
whether the function has a relative maximum value, a relative minimum
value, or neither at the critical points. Sketch the graph of each function.
a. f(x) 2x2 8x 13
c. f(x) 2x3 9x2 12x
b. f(x) 13x3 9x 2
d. f(x) 3x3 5x
x2 2
x2
e. f(x)
g. f(x) ex
h. f(x) x2ln x
350 C H A P T E R 9
b.
2
x
2
x
x
4
14. Suppose that f(x) and g(x) are positive functions such that f(x) has a local
f(x)
has a
maximum and g(x) has a local minimum at x c. Show that h(x)
g(x)
local maximum at x c.
9 . 2 C R I T I C A L P O I N T S, R E L AT I V E M A X I M A , A N D R E L AT I V E M I N I M A
351
y
y = lnx
y = ex
x
horizontal
asymptote
vertical
asymptote
Asymptotes play a significant role in curve sketching. In this section, we will consider vertical and horizontal asymptotes of rational functions and expand our
understanding of asymptotes of exponential and logarithmic functions.
The purpose of this investigation is to examine the occurrence of vertical asymptotes for rational functions.
1
2. Describe the behaviour of each graph as x approaches k from the right and
from the left.
x3
, using the
4. Repeat Questions 1 and 2 for the function f(x)
x2 x k
following values: k 2, 6, and 12.
352 C H A P T E R 9
You can see from this investigation that as x c from either side, the function
values get increasingly large and positive or negative depending on the value of
p(c). We say that the function values approach
(positive infinity) or
(negative infinity). These are not numbers. They are symbols that represent the value
of a function that increases or decreases without limits.
Because the symbol
is not a number, the limits
1
1
and lim
lim
x
c
x
c
xc
xc
do not exist. However, for convenience, we use the notation
lim 1
and
xc x c
lim 1
.
xc x c
x0
These three limits form the basis for determining asymptotes to simple functions.
p(x)
EXAMPLE 1
x
, and describe
Determine any vertical asymptotes of the function f(x)
x2 x 2
the behaviour of the graph of the function for values of x near the asymptotes.
Solution
First determine the values of x for which f(x) is undefined by solving
x2 x 2 0
(x 2)(x 1) 0
x 2 or x 1.
Neither of these values for x makes the numerator zero, so both of these values for
x give vertical asymptotes. The asymptotes are x 2 and x 1.
To determine the behaviour of the graph near the asymptotes, it can be helpful to
use a chart.
limf(x)
x2
x1
f(x)
2
0
0
0
0
2
x-values
xc
0
0
0
0
x 1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
9 . 3 V E RT I C A L A N D H O R I Z O N TA L A S Y M P TOT E S
353
x=1
x
3
xc
xc
xc
xc
lim f (x)
xc
lim f (x)
xc
x
c
lim f (x)
xc
lim f (x)
xc
Horizontal Asymptotes
p(x)
as x increases without
Consider the behaviour of rational functions f(x)
q(x)
bound, in both the positive and negative directions. The following notation is used
to describe this behaviour:
lim f (x) and lim f (x).
x
x
The notation x
is read as x tends to positive infinity and means that the
values of x are positive and growing without bound. Similarly, the notation
354 C H A P T E R 9
x
is read as x tends to negative infinity and means that the values of
x are negative and growing in magnitude without bound.
The value of these limits can be determined by making two observations. The first
is a list of simple limits parallel to those used in determining vertical asymptotes.
1
x
x
lim ex 0.
x
The second observation is that a polynomial can always be written so that the
term of highest degree is a factor.
EXAMPLE 2
Write each of the following so that the term of highest degree is a factor.
a. p(x) x2 4x 1
b. q(x) 3x2 4x 5
Solution
a. p(x) x2 4x 1
b. q(x) 3x2 4x 5
5
3x2 1 34x
3x2
x2 1 4x x12
The value of writing a polynomial in this form is clear. It is easy to see that as x
becomes large, either positive or negative, the value of the second factor always
approaches 1.
We can now determine the limit of a rational function in which the degree of p(x)
is equal to or less than the degree of q(x).
EXAMPLE 3
Solution
a.
2x 3
c. lim
2
x
3x x 4
2
x
b. lim
2
x
x 1
2x
2x 3
f (x)
x1
x 1 1
2x 1 3
21 23x
1 1x
2 lim 1 23x
x
lim f(x)
x
lim 1 1x
x
2(1 0)
10
2
x
g(x)
x2 1
b.
x(1)
1
x2
1 x2
x
x
x
lim 1x
x
0
9 . 3 V E RT I C A L A N D H O R I Z O N TA L A S Y M P TOT E S
355
2x 3
c. p(x)
3x2 x 4
2
Alternate Solution
3
2x21
2 x2
4
3x21 31x
3 x2
3
21
2 x2
4
31 31x
3 x2
lim 1 3
2 x2
x
lim 1 3x
3 x2
x
x+
23
(1 0)
23
(1 0 0)
23
When lim f (x) k or lim f (x) k, the graph of the function is approaching
x
x
1 3
lim 1 x
x
x
x
2x 3
lim
x
1
1
x
2
and, therefore, y 2 is an asymptote for large positive x-values and also for large
negative x-values.
In order to use this knowledge in sketching the graph for this function, we need to
know whether the curve approaches the asymptote from above or from below.
This is answered by considering f (x) k where k is the limit determined. This is
illustrated in the following examples.
EXAMPLE 4
Solution
3x
3x 5
f(x)
2x 1
2x 1 1
3x 1 5
356 C H A P T E R 9
2x
31 35x
21 21x
3 lim 1 35x
x
lim f (x)
x
2 lim 1 21x
x
32
Similiarly, we can show lim f (x) 32. Then y 32 is a horizontal asymptote of
x
the graph f (x) for both large positive and negative values of x. To determine
whether the graph approaches the asymptote from above or below, we consider
very large positive and negative values for x.
3005
, which is greater
If x is large and positive, for example, if x 1000, f (x)
1999
than 32. Therefore, the graph approaches the asymptote y 32 from above.
2995
, which is less
If x is large and negative, for example, if x 1000, f(x)
2000
than 32. This graph approaches the asymptote y 32 from below, as illustrated
in the diagram.
y
1
x
1
EXAMPLE 5
3x
, determine the equations of all horizontal or
For the function f(x)
x2 x 6
vertical asymptotes and illustrate the behaviour of the graph as it approaches the
asymptotes.
Solution
For vertical asymptotes
x2 x 6 0
(x 3)(x 2) 0
x 3 or x 2
There are two vertical asymptotes at x 3 and x 2.
9 . 3 V E RT I C A L A N D H O R I Z O N TA L A S Y M P TOT E S
357
limf(x)
x3
x2
f(x)
3
0
0
0
0
x 3
0
0
0
0
2
0
0
0
0
x 2
0
0
0
0
x-values
x
x
xc
6
1
x21 x x2
3
6
1
x1 x x2
x
of the graph of f (x) for both large positive and negative values of x.
As x becomes large positively, f(x) 0, so the graph is above the asymptote.
As x becomes large negatively, f (x) 0, so the graph is below the asymptote.
This diagram illustrates the behaviour of the graph as it nears the asymptotes:
y
x = 2
2 1
y=0
x=3
Horizontal Asymptotes
If lim f(x) L or lim f(x) L, we say that the line y L is a horizontal
x
x
358 C H A P T E R 9
y=L
y=L
y=L
y=L
x
EXAMPLE 6
2x 3x 1
.
Determine the equations of all asymptotes of the graph of f(x)
x1
2
Solution
Since x 1 0 for x 1 and 2x2 3x 1 0 for x 1, then x 1 is a
vertical asymptote.
2 x 2 x2
2x2 3x 1
lim
Now lim
x
1
x(1 x)
x
lim 2x.
x
This limit does not exist, and by a similar calculation, lim f(x) does not exist,
x
2
point P(x, 2x 1) on the line and Q x, 2x 1
x1
on the curve.
y
P
Q
y= f(x)
9 . 3 V E RT I C A L A N D H O R I Z O N TA L A S Y M P TOT E S
359
2
Then lim QP lim
x1
x
0.
That is, as x gets very large, the curve approaches the line but never touches it.
Therefore, the line y 2x 1 is an asymptote of the curve.
2
0, the line is also an asymptote for large negative values of x.
Since lim
x
x 1
2x 3x 1
. They
In conclusion, there are two asymptotes of the graph of f (x)
x1
are y 2x 1 and x 1.
2
t chnology
2x 3x 1
.
Use the graphing calculator to obtain the graph of f(x)
x1
2
Note that the vertical asymptote x 1 appears on the graph on the left, but the
oblique asymptote y 2x 1 does not. Use the Y2 function to graph the oblique
asymptote y 2x 1.
The techniques for curve sketching developed to this point are described in the
following algorithm. As we develop new ideas, the algorithm will be extended.
Algorithm for Curve Sketching
To sketch a curve, apply the following in the order shown. Add the information
to the diagram step by step.
Step 1: Check for any discontinuities in the domain. Determine if there are
vertical asymptotes and the direction at which the curve approaches
these asymptotes.
Step 2: Find the y-intercept.
Step 3: Find any critical points.
Step 4: Use the first derivative test to determine the type of critical points
that may be present.
Step 5: Extremity tests: Determine lim f(x), lim f(x).
x
360 C H A P T E R 9
x
Exercise 9.3
Part A
Knowledge/
Understanding
1. State the equations of the vertical and horizontal asymptotes of the curves
shown.
a.
b.
y
3
2
1
3
Communication
3
2
1
1
2
3
1
2
3
x
1
2. Under what condition does a rational function have vertical, horizontal, and
oblique asymptotes?
3. Evaluate lim f(x) and lim f(x), using the symbol
when appropriate.
x
2x 3
a. f(x)
x1
5x 3x
c. f(x)
2x2 5
2
x
5x 3
b. f(x)
x2 2
2
2x 3x 5
d. f(x)
3x4 5x 4
5
4. For each of the following, check for discontinuities and state the equation of
any vertical asymptotes. Conduct a limit test to determine the behaviour of the
curve on either side of the asymptote.
x
a. y
x5
x2
b. f(x)
x2
1
c. s
(t 3)2
x x6
d. y
x3
1
e. g(x)
ex 2
f. y xln x
5. For each of the following, determine the equations of any horizontal asymptotes and state whether the curve approaches the asymptote from above or
below.
x
a. y
x4
2x
b. f(x)
x2 1
3t 4
c. g(t)
t2 1
3x 8x 7
d. y
x4
Part B
e
t chnology
6. For each of the following, check for discontinuities and then use at least two
other tests to make a rough sketch of the curve. Verify on a calculator.
x3
a. y
x5
5
b. f(x)
(x 2)2
t 2t 15
c. g(t)
t5
2
9 . 3 V E RT I C A L A N D H O R I Z O N TA L A S Y M P TOT E S
361
15
d. p(x)
6 2ex
(2 x)(3 2x)
e. y
(x2 3x)
10
f. P
n2 4
7. Find the equation of the oblique asymptote for each of the following:
3x 2x 17
a. f(x)
x3
2x 9x 2
b. f(x)
2x 3
x 1
c. f(x)
x2 2x
x x 9x 15
d. f(x)
x2 4x 3
20
c. y
x2 4
d. s(t) t 1t
2x 5x 2
e. g(x)
x3
t 4t 21
, t 7
f. s(t)
t3
ax b
, where a, b, c, and d are constants, a 0, c 0,
10. For the function y
cx d
11. Find constants a and b that guarantee that the graph of the function defined by
ax 5
will have a vertical asymptote at x 5 and a horizontal
f(x)
3 bx
asymptote at y 3.
12. This question will illustrate that we cannot work with the symbol
x 1
and
as though it were a real number. Consider the functions f (x)
x1
2
x 2x 1
.
g(x)
x1
2
x
b. Evaluate lim [ f(x) g(x)] and show that the limit is not zero.
x
13. Use the algorithm for curve sketching to sketch the function
2x2 2x
.
f(x)
x2 9
x 3x 7
.
14. Determine the oblique asymptote of the graph of y
x2
2
362 C H A P T E R 9
INVESTIGATION 1
INVESTIGATION 2
9 . 4 C O N C AV I T Y A N D P O I N T S O F I N F L E C T I O N
363
x
a
x
a
x
a
relative minimum
f(c) > 0
x
relative maximum
f(c) < 0
x
364 C H A P T E R 9
4. A point of inflection occurs at (c, f(c)) on the graph of y f(x) if f (x) changes
sign at x c. That is, the curve changes from concave down to concave up, or
vice versa.
y
y
(c, f(c))
(c, f(c))
c
f< 0 f> 0
c
f> 0 f< 0
d2 y
0
5. All points of inflection of the graph of y f (x) must occur either for
dx2
d2y
, undefined.
or
dx2
In the following examples, we can use these properties to sketch graphs of other
functions.
EXAMPLE 1
(x 3)(x 1) 0
x 3 or x 1.
d2y
6x 6
dx2
d2y
0, we obtain 6x 6 0
Setting
dx2
x 1.
x1
x=1
x1
f(x)
0
0
Graph of f(x)
concave down
point of inflection
concave up
Sketch of f(x)
365
y
(1, 15)
y = x3 3x2 9x + 10
5
x
(3, 17)
EXAMPLE 2
t chnology
x0
x=0
x0
f(x)
0
=0
0
Graph of f(x)
concave up
concave up
Sketch of f(x)
We conclude that the point (0, 0) is not an inflection point because f (x) does not
change sign at x 0.
366 C H A P T E R 9
1
t chnology
Solution
The derivative of f(x) is
EXAMPLE 3
2
3
f (x) 3x
1
3x
23 .
Note that f (0) does not exist, so that x 0 is a critical value of f(x). It is important to determine the behaviour of f (x) as x 0. Since f (x) 0 for all x 0 and
the denominator of f (x) is zero when x 0, we have
lim f (x)
.
x0
f (x) 29x 3 .
5
5
x0
x=0
x0
f(x)
f (x)
EXAMPLE 4
1
.
Determine any points of inflection in the graph of f(x)
x2 3
Solution
1
(x2 3)1 is
The derivative of f(x)
x2 3
f (x) 2x(x2 3)2.
9 . 4 C O N C AV I T Y A N D P O I N T S O F I N F L E C T I O N
367
2(x2
3)2
4x(x2
2
8x2
(x2 3)2
(x2 3)3
2(x2 3) 8x2
(x2 3)3
6x2 6
.
(x2 3)3
3)3(2x)
1
y=
1
x2 + 3
x
x 1
x = 1
1 x 1
x=1
x1
f(x)
0
=0
0
=0
0
Graph of
f (x)
concave up
point of
inflection
concave
down
point of
inflection
concave up
Therefore, 1, 14 and 1, 14 are points of inflection in the graph of f (x).
EXAMPLE 5
y
y = xe x
2
1
x
1 2
x 2
x = 2
x 2
f(x)
0
=0
0
Graph of f (x)
concave down
point of inflection
concave up
368 C H A P T E R 9
Exercise 9.4
Part A
Knowledge/
Understanding
1. For each of the following functions, state whether the value of the second
derivative is positive or negative at each of points A, B, C, and D.
a.
b.
f(x)
g(x)
B
x
C
c.
h(x)
B
C
D
d.
C
D
D
x
A
B
2. Find the critical points for each of the following, and use a second derivative
test to decide if the point is a local maximum, a local minimum, or neither.
a. y x3 6x2 15x 10
c. s t t1
25
b. y
x2 48
d. y (x 3)3 8
3. For Question 2, determine the points of inflection for each of the given functions. In each case, conduct a test to determine the change of sign in the second derivative.
4. Find the value of the second derivative at the value indicated. Determine
whether the curve lies above or below the tangent at this point.
a. f(x) 2x3 10x 3 at x 2
c. s et ln t at t 1
b. g(x) x2 1x at x 1
w
d. p
at w 3
2
w 1
Part B
5. Each of the following graphs represents the second derivative, f (x), of a
function f(x).
9 . 4 C O N C AV I T Y A N D P O I N T S O F I N F L E C T I O N
369
i)
ii)
y
y = f(x)
y = f(x)
x
a. On which intervals is the graph of f (x) concave up, and on which is the
graph concave down?
b. List the x-coordinates of all points of inflection.
c. Make a rough sketch of a possible graph of f (x), assuming that f(0) 2.
Communication
6. Describe how you would use the second derivative to determine the local minimum or maximum.
7. In the algorithm for curve sketching on page 360, reword Step 4 to include
the use of the second derivative to test for local minimum or maximum values.
8. For each of the following functions,
i) determine any points of inflection, and
ii) use the results of part i along with the revised algorithm to sketch each
function.
a. f(x) x4 4x3
c. y
ex
ex
b. y x ln x
4w2 3
w
d. g(w)
3
370 C H A P T E R 9
Part C
b
x 1 has a
11. Find the value of the constant b so that the function f(x)
x
point of inflection at x 3.
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
12. Show that the graph of f(x) ax4 bx3 has two points of inflection. Show
that the x-coordinate of one of these points lies midway between the
x-intercepts.
13. a. Use the algorithm for curve sketching to sketch the function
x3 2x2 4x
x 4
.
y
2
9 . 4 C O N C AV I T Y A N D P O I N T S O F I N F L E C T I O N
371
0.
Step 4: Determine any critical points using d
x
Step 5: Test critical points to see whether they are local maxima, local
minima, or neither.
Step 6: Determine the behaviour of the function for large positive and large
negative values of x. This will identify horizontal asymptotes if they
exist.
Step 7: Test for points of inflection.
Step 8: Determine any oblique asymptotes.
Step 9: Complete the sketch.
In using this algorithm, keep two things in mind:
1. You will not use all steps in every situation. Use only those that are essential.
2. You are familiar with the basic shapes of many functions. Use this knowledge
when possible.
INVESTIGATION
372 C H A P T E R 9
EXAMPLE 1
x4
.
Sketch the graph of f(x)
x2 x 2
Solution
The function is not defined if x2 x 2 0.
or (x 2)(x 1) 0
or x 2 or x 1.
There are vertical asymptotes at x 2 and x 1.
x4
, we examine function values near the asymptotes.
Using f(x)
(x 2) (x 1)
lim f(x)
x1
lim f(x)
x2
lim f(x)
x1
lim f(x)
x2
x 8x 6
(x2 x 2)2
2
(0, 2)
f (x) 0 if x2 8x 6 0
8 210
2
3 2 1
x
(4, 0)
4 10
Since we are sketching, approximate values 7.2 and 0.8 are acceptable. These
values give the points (7.2, 0.1) and (0.8, 1.5).
From the information we already have, we can see that (7.2, 0.1) is probably a
local maximum and (0.8, 1.5) is probably a local minimum. Using the second
derivative test to verify this is a difficult computational task. Instead, we can verify
using the first derivative test, as in the following chart:
x
0.8
7.2
f(x)
0
1
0
0
x
x2 x 2
x4
0, but y 0 always.
lim
x
x2 x 2
373
There is a point of inflection beyond x 7.2 since the curve opens down at that
point but changes as x becomes very large. The amount of work necessary to
determine the point is greater than the information we gain, so we leave it undone
here. (If you wish to check it, it occurs for x 10.4). The finished sketch is given
below, and because it is a sketch, it is not to scale.
y
(0, 2)
(0.8, 1.5)
1
EXAMPLE 2
(7.2, 0.1)
2
4
(4, 0)
7 x
x2 2
x
x0
2
x
lim x
x0
2
x
374 C H A P T E R 9
Exercise 9.5
Part B
Knowledge/
Understanding
1
c. y 3
(x 2)2
x3
i. y
x2 4
x2
1
2
50
, t 0
h. s
1 5e0.01t
x2 3x 6
j. y
x1
k. c tet 5
l. y x(ln x)3
f. y e 2
2x
e. y
x2 25
6x 2
g. y
x3
2
Application
8e
.
3. Sketch the function defined by g(x)
e2x 4
2
a. f(x)
2
x
1
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
t2 4t
t2 t
b. g(t)
8. Show that for any cubic function of the form y ax3 bx2 cx d, there is
a single point of inflection where the slope of the curve at that point is
b2
3a
c .
9.5 AN ALGORITHM FOR GRAPH SKETCHING
375
y
y = x2
4 3 2 1
4
3
2
1
3
2
1
3 2 1
y
y = ex
x
1 2 3 4 5
4
3
2
1
Cubic
x
1 2 3 4 5
y
y = ln x
x
4 3 2 1
y
1
y=
x
x
4
3
2
1
1 2 3 4 5
y=
1 2 3
4 3 2 1
376 C H A P T E R 9
4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5
4 3 2 1
4
3
2
1
1 2 3 4
1
x2 k
wrap-up
C H A P T E R 9 : P R E D I C T I N G S T O C K VA L U E S
In the Career Link earlier in the chapter, you investigated a graphical model used
to predict stock values for a new stock. A brand new stock is also called an Initial
Public Offering, or IPO. Remember that in this model, the period immediately
after the stock is issued offers excess returns on the stock (i.e., the stock is selling
for more than it is really worth). One such model for a class of Internet IPOs
predicts the percentage overvaluation of a stock as a function of time, as
2
R (t) 250et3t ,
where R(t) is the overvaluation in percent and t is the time in months after issue.
Use the information provided by the first derivative, second derivative, and
asymptotes to prepare advice for clients as to when they should expect a signal
to prepare to buy or sell (inflection point), the exact time when they should buy
or sell (max/min), and any false signals prior to an asymptote. Explain your
reasoning. Make a sketch of the function without using a graphing calculator.
377
Review Exercise
1. Determine the derivative and the second derivative for each of the following:
1
b. f(x) ln(x 4) 2
a. y enx
e 1
c. s
et 1
t
d. g(t) ln(t
1 t2)
b.
g(x)
(1, 20)
15
5
4
x
4
4
4
x
(7, 1)
(1, 1)
e
b. g(t)
t2
x3
c. h(x)
x2 7
5. The graph for the function y f(x) has relative extrema at points A, C, and E
and points of inflection at B and D. If a, b, c, d, and e are the x-coordinates
for the points, then state the intervals in which each of the following conditions are true:
a. f (x) 0 and f (x) 0
C
B
D
A
a
378 C H A P T E R 9
e
E
6. For each of the following, check for discontinuities and state the equation of
any vertical asymptotes. Conduct a limit test to determine the behaviour of the
curve on either side of the asymptote.
x5
b. g(x)
x5
2x
a. y
x3
x 2x 15
d. f (x)
x3
2
5
c. s
2ex 8
ln w
a. f(w)
w
b. g(t) tet
ii)
g(x)
g(x)
x
1 0
8 4 2 0
functions given.
REVIEW EXERCISE
379
2x 7x 5
a. f(x)
2x 1
2
4x3 x2 15x 50
b. f(x)
x2 3x
3x 1
b. f(x)
x1
d. y 3x2ln x
x
e. h(x)
x2 4x 4
t 3t 2
f. f(t)
t3
g. s te3t 10
100
h. P
1 50e0.2t
2x 4
will
15. a. Find the conditions on parameter k so that the function f(x)
x2 k2
have critical points.
b. Select a value for k that satisfies the constraint established in part a and
sketch the section of the curve that lies in the domain x k.
380 C H A P T E R 9
Chapter 9 Test
Achievement Category
Questions
Knowledge/Understanding
1, 2, 4, 8, 10
Thinking/Inquiry/Problem Solving
2, 3, 5, 7, 8, 10
Communication
1, 9
Application
3, 6, 9
x
12 8
4 0
12
2. a. Find the critical points for the function g(x) 2x4 8x3 x2 6x.
b. Determine the type of each critical point in part a.
3. Sketch the graph of a function with the following properties:
There are relative extrema at (1, 7) and (3, 2).
There is a point of inflection at (1, 4).
CHAPTER 9 TEST
381
ate tests to determine if asymptotes exist at the discontinuity values. State the
equations of any asymptotes.
5. Find the critical points for the function g(x) e2x(x2 2), and determine the
type of critical point by using an appropriate test.
6. Use at least five curve-sketching techniques to explain how to sketch the
2x 10
. Sketch the graph on squared paper.
graph of the function f(x)
x2 9
d2y
4
33
when x . Determine the
7. The function y kx2 ln(kx) has
11
16
dx2
value of k.
382 C H A P T E R 9
Cumulative Review
CHAPTERS 39
1. Write the first four terms for the sequences defined by the given function and
then find the limit for term tn in the sequence as n
.
a. f (n) 2 51n
1
b. g(k)
k(k 1)
x
2
b. lim
x0 2x x
5 2x
d. lim
2
x
3x 5x
2 n 3n
e. lim
2n
x
4t 3t 2
g. lim
3
t0 t 2t 6
x h x
h. lim
x 8
c. lim
x2 x 2
3
h0
2 x 2
2x
f. lim
x0
x h 3xh h
i. lim
2xh 5h2
2
h0
f(x h) f (x)
4. Use the method of first principles to find the derivative function of each of the
following:
2x
b. y
x2
a. s t2 10t
5. Use either the Product Rule or the Quotient Rule to find the derivative of each
of the following:
a. s (t2 5t)(5t3 2t 7)
x 3x
b. y
x2 2x 5
3
t
c. v ew(1 w)
e e
d. s
et et
e. y (ex)(ln x)
f. s (ln t et)t
6. Use the Chain Rule to find the derivative of each of the following:
a. s(t) et 5t
b. y ln(x2 x 1)
c. w
1x
3x
d. g(t) 3e(2tln t)
e. p loga(2r) 3 ln(5r)
1
2
g. y (a2 x2)
f. exy xy
h. ln(x2y) 2y
7. Find the slope of the tangent to the circle defined by x2 y2 100 at the
point (6, 8).
C U M U L AT I V E R E V I E W C H A P T E R S 3 9
383
8. Use the appropriate derivative rule to find the derivative of each of the
following. In all cases, the values a, b, and c are constants.
a. w r(2r) r2e2r
2 3t
c. s 3
2 3t
b. z w
a bw
d. y ex 2ex
dy
e. Find d
for b2x2 a2y2 a2b2.
x
dy
f. Find d
for x3 3x2y y3 c3.
x
9. Find the equation of the tangent to the curve defined by s tet at the point
where t
.
2
10. Find the value of k in the equation y ekx so that y is a solution of each of the
following:
a. y 3y 2y 0
b. y y 4y 4y 0
11. Use implicit differentiation to find the second derivative of the relation
x2 6xy y2 10.
12. Find the slope of the tangents to the curve defined by y2 e2x 2y e at
the point where y 2.
13. Find the equation of any tangent to the curve represented by
x2 xy 3y2 132 that is parallel to the straight line defined by x y 2.
14. Find the equations of the straight lines through point A(3, 2) that are tangent
to the curve defined by y x2 7.
15. Find the equation of the tangent to the curve defined by y x ln x that is
perpendicular to the line defined by 3x 9y 8.
16. A parachutist jumps out of an airplane. The distance, s, (in metres), through
6t
. Determine
which she falls in t seconds is given by s(t) 10t
t1
a. the distance through which she falls in the first second.
b. the velocity of the parachutist at t 1 and t 2.
c. the acceleration of the parachutist at t 1 and t 2.
d. Find the limit of the velocity as t
. This limit is known as the
terminal velocity.
17. As a particle travels in a linear direction, the distance s from the origin is
given by s 8 7t t2, where t is in seconds and s is in millimetres.
a. Find the velocity after 3 s.
384 C H A P T E R 9
20. A conical cistern 5 m deep and 8 m across the top is being filled with water
flowing in at a rate of 10 000 cm3/min.
a. Explain the significance of the derivatives ddvt , ddrt , and ddth.
b. Use the geometry of the configuration to find a formula for the volume of
the water in terms of the radius of the surface of the water, r.
c. At what rate is the water rising in the cistern when the depth is 3 m?
21. The equation of motion of a particle moving in a straight line is s kv2 ln v,
where k is a constant and v is the velocity. Find an equation that expresses the
acceleration in terms of velocity.
22. A car leaves a small town at 13:00 and travels due south at a speed of
80 km/h. Another car has been heading due west at 100 km/h and reaches the
same town at 15:00. At what time were the two cars closest together?
23. Find the local extreme points and the points of inflection for each of the following:
a. y 2x3 3x2 36x 10
100
b. w 4
z2 25
c. f (x) x2ln x
d. y x3e2x
2
x
4
e. y 5xe
f. n 10pep 2
24. For each of the following, determine the equations of any horizontal, vertical,
or oblique asymptotes and find any local extremes.
8
a. y
x2 9
4x
b. y
x2 1
C U M U L AT I V E R E V I E W C H A P T E R S 3 9
385
25. Use the curve-sketching techniques that you think are appropriate to sketch
each of the following:
2
10n
a. p
n2 25
3x
c. y
x2 4
b. y x ln(3x)
2
x
4
d. y 10
26. A farmer has 750 m of fencing and wants to enclose a rectangular area on all
four sides, then divide it into four pens with fencing parallel to one side of the
rectangle. What is the largest possible area of the four pens?
27. A metal can is made to hold 500 mL of soup. Find the dimensions of the can
that will minimize the amount of metal required. (Assume that the top and
sides of the can are made from metal of the same thickness.)
28. A cylindrical box of volume 4000 cm3 is being constructed to hold Christmas
candies. The cost of the base and lid is $0.005/cm2 and the cost of the side
walls is $0.0025/cm2. Find the dimensions for the cheapest possible box.
29. An open rectangular box has a square base with each side x cm.
a. If the length, width, and depth have a sum of 140 cm, find the depth.
b. Find the maximum possible volume you could have when constructing a
box with these proportions, and find the dimensions to make this maximum volume.
30. The price of x items of a certain type of product is p(x) 50 x2, where
x N. If the total revenue R(x) is given by R(x) xp(x), find the value of x
that corresponds to the maximum possible total revenue.
31. A fish biologist introduced a new species of fish into a northern lake and
studied the growth of the population over a period of ten years. The mathematical model that best described the size of the fish population was
4000
, where t is in years.
p
1 3e0.1373t
a. Find the maximum population that the biologist expects in the lake.
b. Find the year when the rate of change of the growth rate started to
decrease.
c. Sketch the curve for the ten-year period.
d. For how many more years must the biologist collect data to be sure the
mathematical model is valid?
32. Determine values for a, b, c, and d that guarantee that the function
f (x) ax3 bx2 cx d will have a relative maximum at (1, 7) and a
point of inflection at (2, 11).
386 C H A P T E R 9
f (x) 0, when x 2
f (x) 0, when x 2
f (x) 0, when x 2
34. Determine the extreme values of each function on the given interval.
1
e
, 0 x 4
c. f (x)
1 ex
d. f (x) x ln(x), 1 x 5
35. A travel agent booking a tour currently has 80 people signed up. The price of
a ticket is $5000 per person. The agency has chartered a plane seating
150 people at a cost of $250 000. Additional costs to the agency are incidental
fees of $300 per person. For each $30 that the price is lowered, one new person will sign up. How much should the price per person be lowered in order
to maximize the profit to the travel agent?
36. Find the equations of the tangents to the curve defined by x2 xy y2 19
at the points on the curve where y 2.
37. Use the techniques of curve sketching that you think are appropriate to sketch
4
the curve defined by y
x2 4.
38. The Coast Guard is monitoring a giant iceberg in the approximate shape of a
rectangular solid that is five times as long as the width across the front face.
As the iceberg drifts south, the height above water is observed to decrease at
the rate of two metres per week, and the width across the front is shrinking at
three metres per week. Find the rate of loss of volume above water when the
height is 60 m and the width of the face is 300 m.
39. Determine values for a, b, c, and d that guarantee that the function
f (x) ax3 bx2 cx d has a relative maximum value of 3 when x 2
and a relative minimum value of 0 when x 1.
40. Find the equation of the normal to each of the curves defined below, at the
point specified.
a. y x3 2x2 5x 2, when x 1
1
1
2
b. y x 2 x
at (4, 2.5)
C U M U L AT I V E R E V I E W C H A P T E R S 3 9
387
Appendix A
D E R I VAT I V E S O F T R I G O N O M E T R I C F U N C T I O N S
So far in our study of calculus, we have worked with polynomial, rational, power,
exponential, and logarithmic functions. Trigonometric functions are central in
modelling oscillatory phenomena and periodic motion, such as planetary orbits,
the rise and fall of tides, and the current in electrical circuits. In this appendix, we
will develop the derivatives of the trigonometric functions and apply them in various problems.
r
Radian Measure
= 1 radian
xR
Range
1 sin x 1
1 cos x 1
Periodicity
0
1
388 A P P E N D I X A
y = sin x
1
2
y = cos x
3
2
2
Trigonometric Identities
Reciprocal Identities
Pythagorean Identities
1
csc
sin
1
sec
cos
sin2 cos2 1
tan2 1 sec2
1 cot2 csc2
Quotient Identities
Reflection Identities
sin
tan
cos
cos
cot
sin
sin( ) sin
cos( ) cos
1
cot
tan
Exercise
1. With reference to the diagram, state the values of
y P(x, y)
a. sin .
b. cos .
c. tan .
b. 45
c. 90
d. 30
e. 270
f. 120
g. 225
h. 330
y
(0, 1)
b. tan .
d. sin 2 .
(b, a)
f. sin().
(a, b)
x
(1, 0)
4. The value of sin , cos , or tan is given. Find the values of the other two
functions if lies in the given interval.
a. sin 153, 2
D E R I VAT I V E S O F T R I G O N O M E T R I C F U N C T I O N S
389
b. y 2sin 2x
e. y 5sin 6
c. y 3sin(x) 1
f. y 3sin x
b. y 3cos x 2
sin x
tan x sec x
b.
1 sin2x
1
tan x
sec2x
d.
1 sin x
cos x
b. cos2 x cos x 0
c. 2 sin x cos x 0
d. 2 sin2x sin x 1 0
f. 2sin2x 3 cos x 0
sin(x h) sin x
,
lim
h
h0
cos(x h) cos x
.
f (x) lim
h
h0
In order to simplify these limits, we need to derive expansions for sin(x h) and
cos(x h). After doing so, we will establish the derivatives in the next section.
Our intuition is of no help in finding an expansion for cos(A B). A check with
values for A and B shows that
cos(A B) cos A cos B.
For example, if A 4 and B 6, the left side is cos 512 0.2588, whereas
the right side is cos 4 cos 6 0.7071 0.5 1.2071.
Theorem cos(A B) cos A cos B sin A sin B
390 A P P E N D I X A
Proof
Consider a circle, with centre (0, 0) and
M(cos(A + B), sin(A + B))
radius 1, containing angles of measure
1
A, A B, and B, as drawn. By the
definition of sine and cosine, the points
0
M, N, P, and Q have coordinates as shown
in the diagram. Since MOP and NOQ
have equal measure (A B) by construction, and
OM OP ON OQ 1,
NOQ is congruent to MOP.
Then MP NQ.
y
N(cos A, sin A)
A+ B
A
P(1, 0) x
Q(cos(B), sin(B))
Addition Identities
cos(A B) cos A cos B sin A sin B
cos(A B) cos A cos B sin A sin B
sin(A B) sin A cos B cos A sin B
sin(A B) = sin A cos B cos A sin B
tan A tan B
tan(A B)
1 tan A tan B
Complementary Identities
cos2 A sin A
sin2 A cos A
Double-Angle Identities
cos2A cos2 A sin2 A
sin2A 2sin A cos A
2tan A
tan2A
1 tan2 A
D E R I VAT I V E S O F T R I G O N O M E T R I C F U N C T I O N S
391
Example 1
Example 2
Example 3
Example 4
tan A tan B
.
Show that tan(A B)
1 tan A tan B
Solution
L.S. tan(A B)
sin(A B)
cos(A B)
tan A tan B
R.S.
1 tan A tan B
sin A
sin B
co s A
co s B
sin A sin B
1
co s A co s B
L.S.
Example 5
If tan A 32, where 0 A 90, and cos B 35, where 180 B 270,
determine the exact value of sin(A B) without finding the measures of A and
B.
y
Solution
y
Since tan A x 32, let point P be (2, 3).
P(2, 3)
A
4 9 13
.
Then OP
3
13
13
9 y2 25
y
4.
x
5
Q(3, 4)
13
13
9 8
513
17
5
13
Example 6
1
sin W cos W
R.S. 2csc2W
2
sin2W
2
2sinW cosW
1
L.S.
sinW cosW
393
Exercise A1
Part A
1. a. Show that sin(90 W) cos W.
b. Prove cos(90 W) sin W.
2. a. Expand and simplify cos32 R.
3. If sin W 35 and cos T 1123, where both W and T are acute angles, then
a. find the exact value of sin(W T).
b. sin 15
c. cos 105
d. sin 255
b. cosx 34
c. cos4 x
d. sin(2 x)
9. If cos A 13, with 0 A 2, and sin B 14, with 2 < B , calculate
each quantity.
a. cos(A B)
b. sin(A B)
c. cos 2A
d. sin 2B
10. If tan A 13 and A 32, calculate each quantity. In what quadrant does
the angle 2A lie?
a. sin2A
394 A P P E N D I X A
b. cos2A
cos2W
cot W 1
b.
1 sin2W
cot W 1
d. cos 3 4cos3 3cos
Part C
14. For 0 2, determine all solutions of sin cos sin cos .
15. In any acute-angled ABC, prove that b2 sin 2C c2 sin 2B 2bc sin A.
sin Q
to help prove the identity
16. a. Use the identity tan Q
cos Q
tan A tan B
.
tan(A B)
1 tan A tan B
1 tan
2 sec tan .
b. Prove that
1 tan 2
xy
xy
xy
2
2
ab
.
18. In any ABC, prove that
b
sin B
D E R I VAT I V E S O F T R I G O N O M E T R I C F U N C T I O N S
395
S E C T I O N A 2 T H E D E R I VAT I V E S O F T H E S I N E
AND COSINE FUNCTIONS
1. Using your graphing calculator, draw a graph of y sin x with the following
WINDOW settings: Xmin 0, Xmax 9.4, Ymin 3.1, Ymax 3.1.
t chnology
INVESTIGATION 1
dy
dy
y sin x, and record these values in a table such as the following (correct to
four decimal places):
x
sin x
d
sin x
dx
0
.5
1.0
6.5
3. Using your graphing calculator, draw a graph of y cos x with the following
WINDOW settings: Xmin 0, Xmax 9.4, Ymin 3.1, Ymax 3.1.
4. Use the
TRACE
x 0, 0.5, 1.0, .., 6.5, correct to four decimal places, and record them in a
table.
5. Compare the tables that you have computed and make a conclusion.
1. Using your graphing calculator, draw a graph of y cos x with the following
WINDOW settings: Xmin 0, Xmax 9.4, Ymin 3.1, Ymax 3.1.
t chnology
INVESTIGATION 2
dy
dy
for y = cos x, and record these values, correct to four decimal places, in a table
such as the following:
x
0
.5
1.0
6.5
396 A P P E N D I X A
cos x
d
cos x
dx
3. Using your graphing calculator, draw a graph of y sin x with the following
WINDOW settings: Xmin 0, Xmax 9.4, Ymin 3.1, Ymax 3.1.
4. Use the TRACE function to compute the values of sin x for x 0, 0.5, 1.0,
, 6.5, correct to four decimal places, and record them in a table of values.
5. Compare the tables that you have computed and make a conclusion.
We will now confirm the conjectures made in the Investigations using the
definition of the derivative. For f(x) sin x,
f(x h) f(x)
sin(x h) sin x
lim
h
h0
h0
sin h
cos h 1
sin x
lim cos x
h
h
h0
sin h
cos h 1
sin x lim .
cos x lim
h
h
h0
h0
sin h
cos h 1
and lim .
To proceed further, we need the values of the limits lim
h
h
h0
INVESTIGATION 3
e
t chnology
h0
sin x
from x 1 to x 1.
1. On your graphing calculator, graph y
x
(Let Ymin 0.8 and Ymax 1.1.)
2. Using the TRACE function, determine what happens to the value of the function as x gets closer and closer to zero (approaching from the negative and positive sides). Confirm your conclusion by using the TRACE function.
sin x
?
3. What appears to be the value of lim
x
x0
cos x 1
from x 1 to x 1.
4. On your graphing calculator, graph y
x
(Let Ymin 0.5 and Ymax 0.5.)
5. Using the TRACE function, determine what happens to the value of the function as x gets closer and closer to zero (approaching from the negative and positive side). Confirm your conclusion by using the TABLE function.
cos x 1
?
6. What appears to be the value of lim
x
x0
x0
D E R I VAT I V E S O F T R I G O N O M E T R I C F U N C T I O N S
397
By substituting these limits in the expression for the derivative of f(x) sin x, we
obtain
f (x) (cos x)(1) (sin x)(0)
cos x.
d
(sin x) cos x
dx
Example 1
dy
Find d
for each function.
x
b. y sin2x
a. y sin x2
Solution
a. To differentiate this composite function, we use the Chain Rule with
y sin u, where u x2.
dy
dy du
d
Then d
u dx
x
(cos u)(2x)
2x cos x2.
b. Since y sin2x (sin x)2, we use the Chain Rule with y u2, where u sin x.
dy
dy du
d
Then d
u dx
x
(2u)(cos x)
2sin x cos x.
With practice, you can learn to apply the Chain Rule without the intermediate
step of introducing the variable u. For y sin x2, for example, you can skip this
step and immediately write
dy
(cos x2)(2x).
dx
d
(cos x) sin x
dx
Example 2
1.
dy
Find d
for y tan x.
x
Solution
y tan x
sin x
cos x
dy
(cos x)(cos x) (sin x)(sin x)
(cos x)2
dx
cos x sin x
cos2x
2
1
cos2x
sec2x
Example 4
dy
Find d
for y (sin x tan x)4.
x
Solution
y (sin x tan x)4
dy
4(sin x tan x)3(cos x sec2x)
dx
D E R I VAT I V E S O F T R I G O N O M E T R I C F U N C T I O N S
399
Exercise A2
Part A
dy
d. y sin(x3 2x 4)
e. y 2cos( 4x)
f. y x cos x
g. y tan 3x
h. y 3sin(3x 2)
i. y sin2x cos2x
j. y sin1x
k. y cosx
l. y 2x3sin x 3x cos x
m. y 2sin x cos x
cos2x
n. y
x
o. y cos(sin 2x)
sin x
p. y
1 cos x
q. y tan2(x3)
r. y ex(cos x sin x)
Part B
2. Find an equation for the tangent at the given point for each of the following
functions:
a. f(x) sin x, x 3
c. f(x) x sin x, x 0
dy
3. Find d
for each of the following implicitly defined functions:
x
a. x sin y
b. sin(x y) 1
c. tan 2x cos 3y
d. y cos(xy)
e. x sin y cos(x y) 0
4. Derive the result that ddx cos x sin x using the definition of a derivative.
5. Find expressions for the derivatives of csc x, sec x, and cot x by first using
identities to write them in terms of sine or cosine or both.
6. a. Repeat Investigation 3 of this section with the measure of the angle in
degrees rather than radians.
b. What modifications would have to be made to the derivatives
d
d
sin x cos x and cos x sin x if x were the measure of an angle
dx
dx
in degrees instead of radians?
400 A P P E N D I X A
S E C T I O N A 3 A P P L I C AT I O N S O F T R I G O N O M E T R I C
FUNCTIONS
In the previous section, we learned how to differentiate trigonometric functions. In
this section, we will apply this knowledge.
Example 1
Find the maximum and minimum values of the function f(x) cos2x on the
interval 0 x 2.
Solution
By the Algorithm for Extreme Values, the maximum and minimum values occur
at a point on the graph where f (x) 0, or at an end point of the interval. The
derivative of f(x) is
f (x) 2(cos x)(sin x)
2sin x cos x
sin 2x.
Solving f (x) 0 yields
sin 2x 0
2x 0, , 2, 3, or 4
and
We evaluate f(x) at the critical numbers and at the end points of the interval.
x
2
3
2
2
f(x)
f(x)
x
2
3
2
2
The maximum value is 1 when x 0, , or 2, and the minimum value is 0 when
x 2 or 32.
Example 2
Ladder
4
Wall
y
Floor
Solution
Let the distance from the top of the ladder to the floor at any time t seconds be
y metres.
dy
We are given that dt 0.25 m/s
14 m/s.
D E R I VAT I V E S O F T R I G O N O M E T R I C F U N C T I O N S
401
We want to determine the value of ddt when y 3. From the diagram we get
y
sin,
4
so y 4sin.
Differentiating implicitly with respect to t,
dy
d
4cos .
dt
dt
4
3
7
dy
When y 3, cos
, and dt 14.
4
7
d
Therefore, 14 4
4 dt
1
d
.
dt
47
1
Therefore, the angle is decreasing at the rate of rad/s.
47
Example 3
12
y
x
When 4, P 12
12
12
2
2
24
12
2
12 122.
As 0, cos 1, sin 0, and P 12 12 0 24.
, cos 0, sin 1 and P 12 0 12 24.
As
2
Therefore, the maximum value of the perimeter is 12 122 cm, and occurs
when the other two angles are each 4 rad, or 45.
402 A P P E N D I X A
Example 4
A line, L, through point (0, 1) is rotating about point (0, 1) at the rate of one revolution per minute in a clockwise direction. At what rate is the point of intersection
of L and the x-axis moving along the x-axis when x 5?
Solution
Let , in radians, be the angle between the line L
and the y-axis, and x be the distance from the origin
to the point of intersection of L and the x-axis, P,
at any time t minutes, as shown.
y
L
(0, 1)
1
x
0
11
26
y
L
(0, 1)
26
1
0
.
26
52 ddxt .
When P is 5 units to the right of the origin, it is approaching the origin at the rate
of 52 units/min.
Exercise A3
Part B
1. Find the equation of the tangent to the curve y cos x at 2, 0.
D E R I VAT I V E S O F T R I G O N O M E T R I C F U N C T I O N S
403
2. Find the equation of the tangent to the curve cos x sin y 1 at the point
3, 56.
3. Find the local maximum and minimum value of each function on the given
interval. (Verify your results by graphing the functions on a graphing calculator.)
a. y cos x sin x, 0 x 2
b. y x 2cos x, x
4. An object is suspended from the end of a spring. Its displacement from the
equilibrium position is s 8sin(10t). Calculate the velocity and
2
ds
1002s 0.
acceleration of the object at any time t, and show that
dt2
5. The motion of a particle is given by s 5cos 2t 4. What are the
maximum values of the displacement, the velocity, and the acceleration?
6. An irrigation channel is constructed by bending a
sheet of metal that is 3 m wide, as shown in the
diagram. What angle will maximize the
cross-sectional area (and thus the capacity)
of the channel?
1m
1m
1m
7. A fence is 1.5 m high and is 1 m from a wall. A ladder must start from the
ground, touch the top of the fence, and rest somewhere on the wall. Find the
minimum length of such a ladder.
8. A lighthouse is 1 km off shore. A marathoner is running along the shore. The
search light on the lighthouse is rotating at a rate of 16 revolution per minute
when the runner is 3 km from the point on the shore that is closest to the
lighthouse. The runner is illuminated by the beam. How fast is the beam of
light moving along the shore at this moment?
9. An isosceles triangle is inscribed in a circle of radius R.
Find the value of that maximizes the area of the
triangle.
2
Part C
10. A man 2 m tall is watching a street light 6 m high as he jogs toward it at a
rate of 2 m/s. How fast is the angle of elevation of the mans line of sight
increasing at the instant that he is 3 m from the base of the light?
404 A P P E N D I X A
0.8
y
x
1
12. When the rules of hockey were developed, Canada didnt use the metric system. Thus the distance between the goal posts was designated to be six feet
(slightly less than two metres). If Paul Kariya is on the goal line, three feet
outside one of the goal posts, how far should he go out (perpendicular to the
goal line) in order to maximize the angle in which he can shoot at the goal?
Hint: Find the values of x that maximize .
6
3
x
D E R I VAT I V E S O F T R I G O N O M E T R I C F U N C T I O N S
405
Appendix B
A N T I D E R I VAT I V E S
Throughout the text, we have studied the derivatives of functionshow they are
defined, their geometric interpretation, how they are calculated, and how they are
appliedto help solve different types of problems. In this appendix, we are going
to reverse the process. If we were to give an alternative title for this appendix, it
could be called Working Backwards.
S E C T I O N B 1 F I N D I N G A N T I D E R I VAT I V E S
Example 1
406 A P P E N D I X B
Basic Antiderivatives
n1
x
C, n 1
F (x) xn, then F(x)
n1
kx
Finding antiderivatives is mainly a process of taking the rules for derivatives and
using them backwards.
Example 2
4 x12
g(x).
A N T I D E R I VAT I V E S
407
y = x3 + 3
y = x3
y = x3 1
Sometimes a question arises from a context that requires
us to determine not just the general antiderivative, but
a specific antiderivative. In such cases, an extra piece of information is required.
Example 3
The graph of a function f passes through point (0, 4), and the slope of the tangent
at any point on the graph is given by f (x) x ex. Determine the function f.
Solution
We first determine the general antiderivative of
f (x) x ex, which would be
2
f(x) x2 ex C.
This function must pass through point (0, 4),
so f(0) 4. This gives
2
4 02 e0 C
C 3.
Example 4
The rate of change of the cost per metre of drilling a well x metres deep is given
2
by the expression 400 54x 3 . If it costs $5000 to drill a well that is 8 m deep,
determine the cost of drilling a well that is 27 m deep.
Solution
We wish to determine a function C(x) that relates the cost, C, to the depth of the
well, x. We are given information that relates the rate of change of the cost (the
cost per metre) to the depth of the well. The function C(x) relates cost to depth,
while C(x) relates the rate of change of cost to depth.
408 A P P E N D I X B
2
Using C(x) 400 54x 3 , we can determine C(x), the general antiderivative.
C(x) 400x 5435x 3 D
5
5
400x 34x 3 D
Note: We use D to represent the constant in the general antiderivative, so as not to
confuse this quantity with the C used for cost in this example.
In order to find the specific cost function, we use the fact that it costs $5000 to
drill a well that is 8 m deep.
C(8) 5000
5
400(8) 34(8) 3 D 5000
3200 34(32) D 5000
D 1776
Hence, the cost of drilling a well that is x m deep is given by the function
5
The process of finding antiderivatives is often quite complicated. Many antiderivatives are not recognizable simply by a backward application of the rules for differentiation. In future courses in calculus, you will learn techniques that can be used
to find the antiderivatives of complicated functions. For now, we will stick to
functions whose antiderivatives can be found using a backward application of the
derivative rules with which you are familiar. You should always remember to
check your answer by differentiating, to make sure that you have found the correct antiderivative.
Example 5
b. g(x)
cosx
2
x 1
Solution
2x
, we note that the numerator of this
a. To find the antiderivative of f (x)
x2 5
fraction is the derivative of the denominator. We know that when we differentiate the natural logarithm function using the Chain Rule, we obtain a similar
type of fraction.
A N T I D E R I VAT I V E S
409
2x
2
x 1
g(x)
cosx 12(x2 1) 2 (2x) cosx.
2
The antiderivative G is
1
x2 1 sinx C.
G(x) (x2 1) 2 sin x C
Now we differentiate to check our answer:
1
cosx g(x).
G(x) 12(x2 1) 2 (2x) cosx
2
x
1
Finally, we prove that any two different antiderivatives of the same function
differ at most by a constant. From our earlier examples, we know that
y x3 and y x3 4 are both antiderivatives of the function f(x) 3x2.
We see that these two antiderivatives differ by a constant of 4. We now prove
this result for a general function f.
Given a function f and two different antiderivatives, say F and G, show that F
and G differ only by a constant.
Proof
Since F and G are both antiderivatives of f, we know that F(x) f(x) and
G(x) f(x). Subtracting these two equations gives F(x) G(x) 0. Using
our rules for derivatives, we know that F(x) G(x) (F(x) G(x)).
However, if (F(x) G(x)) 0, we have a function F(x) G(x) whose derivative is always zero. This function must be a constant. Thus, F(x) G(x) C,
or F(x) G(x) C, and these two antiderivatives of f differ by only a
constant.
Exercise B1
Part A
1. In the following, determine the general antiderivative of the given function.
410 A P P E N D I X B
a. f(x) 2
b. f(x) 3x 4
c. f(x) 4x3 x2
d. f(x) 2x
g. f(x) 2sin(2x)
h. f(x) xex
i. f(x) x2
x3 1
cosx
j. f(x)
sinx
x
e. f(x)
, F(0) 4
3
x 1
height of 3 m when it was planted. Find its height ten years later.
411
ds
. In many situations, it is more likely that we know the acceleraa(t) ddvt
dt2
tion and we wish to determine velocity and position as functions of time.
Example 1
An object moves along the x-axis with velocity v(t) 6t 3t2, for t 0. If it
starts at the origin, determine its position when t 2 and when it returns to its
initial position.
Solution
Let the position of the object at any time t be s(t).
We are given v(t) s(t) 6t 3t2,
s(t) 3t2 t3 c.
so
s(0) 0
00c0
c 0.
The position of the object at any time t 0 is
s(t) 3t2 t3.
When t 2, s(2) 3(2)2 23
4.
To determine when the object returns to the origin, we solve
s(t) 0
3t2
t3 0
t2(3 t) 0
t 0 or t 3.
The object returns to the origin when t 3.
Example 2
412 A P P E N D I X B
Two rocks fall straight to the earth. If air resistance is ignored, the only acceleration is due to the force of gravity and is equal to 9.81 m/s2. If the first rock is
dropped from a height of 45 m and the second rock is thrown down from a height
of 60 m with an initial velocity of 20 m/s, which rock hits the ground first?
Solution
Let s1(t) and s2(t) be the positions of the rocks above the ground at any time t seconds, where t 0 when both rocks are released. We need to determine the time at
which each rock has reached ground level: s1(t) 0 and s2(t) 0. We will consider the behaviour of each rock separately and compare the times.
Since the only acceleration is due to the force of gravity, we know that
a1(t) 9.81 v1(t).
The velocity, v1, of the first rock is the antiderivative of its acceleration, so
v1(t) 9.81t C.
We are told that the first rock is dropped, not thrown, so we know that the initial
velocity is 0 m/s.
v1(0) 0
9.81(0) C 0
C0
Hence, the velocity of the first rock, at any time t, is v1(t) 9.81t.
The position, s1, of the first rock is the antiderivative of its velocity, so
s1(t) 9.81t2 D
2
4.905t2 D.
We know that the first rock is initially located 45 m above the ground, so
s1(0) 45
2
4.905(0) D 45
D 45.
Thus, the position of the first rock at any time t is s1(t) 4.905t2 45.
To determine when the first rock hits the ground, solve s1(t) 0.
4.905t2 45 0
t2 9.174
t 3.03
Therefore, the first rock hits the ground approximately 3 s after it is dropped.
Now lets consider the second rock. We know that a2(t) 9.81, so the velocity
of the second rock is v2(t) 9.81t K. Since the second rock is thrown downwards with an initial velocity of 20 m/s, we know that v2(0) 20, so
20 9.81(0) K and K 20. Therefore v2(t) 9.81t 20. (If the second rock had been thrown upwards with an initial velocity of 20 m/s, we would
have v2(0) 20.)
The position function of the second rock is s2(t) 4.905t2 20t M. Using
the fact that s2(0) 60, we find M 60, so the position function is
s2(t) 4.905t2 20t 60.
A N T I D E R I VAT I V E S
413
t
t 6.09 or 2.01
The second rock hits the ground after approximately 2 s. Even though the second
rock was initially farther from the ground, it reaches the ground first.
In this question, we ignored any air resistance that might affect the acceleration
of the rocks. It is possible to include a factor for air resistance when setting up
the initial acceleration function, but in such cases the antiderivative becomes
much more difficult to find. These antiderivatives for velocity and position are
often solved using a differential equation. The solving and application of differential equations is a very large branch of calculus. We cover one basic type of differential equation in the next section of this appendix, but we will barely scratch
the surface of this important branch of mathematics.
Example 3
A boat is anchored near the shoreline on a breezy day, bobbing up and down on
the waves. Its vertical acceleration at any time, t, is a(t) 2cos( t) m/s2.
a. Determine the velocity, v, and position, s, of the boat at any time, t. (The position is measured from sea level on a calm day, with positive positions above
sea level and negative positions below sea level.) Assume that the initial
velocity of the boat is 0 m/s and the initial position of the boat is 22 m below
sea level.
b. Determine the position of the boat after 2 s and after 3.5 s.
c. How long does it take for the boat to go from the crest (top) of a wave to the
trough (bottom) of a wave?
Solution
a. Velocity is an antiderivative of acceleration, so the velocity of the boat is
v(t) 2 sin( t) C. We know that v(0) 0, so
0 2sin(0) C
C 0.
D 0.
414 A P P E N D I X B
0.20264.
After 2 s, the boat is approximately 20 cm below sea level.
2
cos(3.5 )
s(3.5)
2
0
After 3.5 s, the boat is at sea level.
2
cos( t) is periodic, with period 2. Hence, it
c. The position function s(t)
2
takes 2 s for the boat to go from crest to crest and 1 s for the boat to go from
crest to trough.
Exercise B2
Part A
1. In the following, find the position function of an object moving with the given
velocity. The initial position is given. (Assume that the object is moving in a
straight line.)
a. v(t) 4t, s(0) 4
1
, s(0) 0
c. v(t) 21
(t 1)2
1
, s(0) 2
b. v(t) 3et
t1
2. In the following, find the velocity and position functions of an object moving
with the given acceleration. The initial velocity and position are given.
(Assume that the object is moving in a straight line.)
a. a(t) 2, v(0) 10, s(0) 0
3t 1, v(0) 0, s(0) 0
b. a(t)
c. a(t) cos(t) sin(t), v(0) 3, s(0) 0
4
, v(0) 0, s(0) 8
d. a(t)
(1 2t)2
Part B
3. The upper observation deck of the CN Tower is 450 m above the ground. If a
stone is dropped from this upper deck,
A N T I D E R I VAT I V E S
415
k
y
for some constant k. Another way to say this is that the rate of growth (or decay)
of the population is proportional to the population itself, or
dy
ky.
dt
dy
dy
dy
unknown function. Large branches of calculus have come about as people use
DEs to describe situations and then search for the function that is a solution of the
equation. It is not our purpose here to learn techniques for solving DEs. The only
DE that we will study has a solution that is fairly easy to guess.
dy
What function y f(t) is a solution to the differential equation dt ky? That is,
what function y f(t) has a derivative that is a constant multiple k of itself? We
know that the exponential function occurs as part of its own derivative, so we
dy
guess that y ekt is a solution to the differential equation dt ky. We verify our
dy
guess by finding dt kekt ky. Hence, y ekt is a function whose derivative is
proportional to itself.
However, y ekt is not the only possible solution to the differential equation
dy
ky. We note that y Cekt is also a solution, for any constant C, since
dt
dy
kCekt ky. Hence, the general function whose derivative is k times itself is
dt
y Cekt. Further study on solving differential equations will prove that this
dy
general function is the only solution to the differential equation dt ky.
If k 0, the function y Cekt models a population with exponential growth.
If k
0, the function y Cekt models a population with exponential decay.
Example 1
A bacterial culture starts with 2000 bacteria, and after three hours there are 7500
bacteria. Assuming that the culture grows at a rate proportional to its size,
a. find the population at any time t.
b. find the number of bacteria present after ten hours.
Solution
Let P represent the population of the bacterial culture after t hours. We are told
that ddPt kP, where k is positive (the culture is growing).
a. The population at any time, t, is given by the function P(t) Cekt. There are
two unknown constants in this equation, k and C. However, we are given some
information about the population at various times. We know P(0) 2000, so
A N T I D E R I VAT I V E S
417
After three days, a sample of radon-222 has decayed to 60% of its original
amount. If radon-222 decays at a rate proportional to its size,
a. find an expression for the amount of radon-222 present at any time t.
b. what is the half-life of radon-222? (That is, how long does it take a sample of
radon-222 to decay to 50% of its original amount?)
Solution
a. If R is the amount of radon-222 present at any time t, then we know that
dR
kR, where k will be negative (since the sample is decaying). The general
dt
solution to this differential equation is R(t) Cekt, where both C and k must be
determined. We are not told the amount of radon-222 that is present initially;
we will call this quantity R0. Hence, we know that R(0) R0, so
R0 Cek(0) C
and the function becomes R(t) R0ekt.
We also know that after three days, the radon-222 has decayed to 60% of its
original quantity. This means R(3) 0.6R0, and
0.6R0 R0ek(3)
0.6 e3k
3k ln(0.6)
ln(0.6)
0.17
k
3
418 A P P E N D I X B
b. The half-life of radon-222 (or any radioactive element) is the amount of time
that it takes for a sample to decay to half of its original amount. Since we do
not know the initial amount, R0, we wish to find t so that R(t) 0.5R0.
0.5R0 R0e0.17t
0.5 e0.17t
0.17t ln(0.5)
ln(0.5)
4.077
t
0.17
The general solution for this differential equation is T(t) S Cekt. We can verify the general solution as follows:
L.S. ddTt
Ckekt
R.S. k(T S)
k(S Cekt S)
kCekt L.S.
A N T I D E R I VAT I V E S
419
dy
dt
k(M y).
y
dy
We rearrange this expression to get the differential equation dt ky(M y).
M
, where C is an
The general solution to this differential equation is y
1 CeMkt
unknown constant, M is the limiting value of the population, and k is the constant
of proportionality. (Further study in calculus will teach you how to find this solution to the differential equation yourself.)
Example 3
A population of animals on Pelee Island is limited by the amount of food available. Studies show that there were 2000 animals present in 1990 and 2500 in
1997, suggesting that a maximum of 6000 animals can be supported by the conditions present on the island. Use the logistic model to predict the animal population in the year 2005.
Solution
Using the given information, we construct the differential equation
dP
kP(6000 P),
dt
where P is the number of animals present on the island after t years. For convenience, we begin measuring time in 1990; that is, t 0 in 1990. (As an exercise,
redo this question with t 0 for any year of your choosing. Verify that the choice
of year for t 0 does not affect the calculations.)
The solution to this differential equation has the general form
6000
,
P(t)
1 Ce6000kt
where we must determine the values of C and k. We know that P(0) 2000, so
6000
2000
1 Ce6000k(0)
1C3
C 2.
6000
. We also know that
The population equation becomes P(t)
1 2e6000kt
P(7) 2500, so
6000
2500
1 2e6000k(7)
420 A P P E N D I X B
6000
.
1 2e0.051t
In the year 2005, t 15 and the animal population on Pelee Island will be
6000
3108.
P(15)
1 2e0.051(15)
Example 4
A thermometer is taken from a room where the temperature is 22C to the outdoors, where the temperature is 8C. After one minute, the thermometer reads
15C.
a. What is the temperature T shown on the thermometer as a function of time t?
b. What will the reading on the thermometer be after one more minute?
c. When will the thermometer read 10C?
Solution
a. Using the given information, we can write the differential equation
dT
k(T 8), where 8C is the temperature of the air surrounding the
dt
thermometer. The general solution to this differential equation is
T(t) 8 Cekt. We must determine the values of C and k. We know that
T(0) 22, since the thermometer was taken from a room where the temperature was 22C, so
22 8 Cek(0)
22 8 C
C 14.
The temperature function becomes T(t) 8 14ekt. We also know that
T(1) 15, so
15 8 14ek(1)
ek 0.5
k ln(0.5) 0.69.
Therefore, the temperature function is T(t) 8 14e0.69t. Notice that the
value of k is negative, which corresponds to the fact that the temperature is
decreasing over time.
b. After one more minute, the reading on the thermometer will be
T(2) 8 14e0.69(2) 11.5C.
A N T I D E R I VAT I V E S
421
ln17
t
0.69
2.8
Therefore, the temperature on the thermometer will read 10C after approximately 2.8 min.
Exercise B3
Part A
1. A bacterial culture starts with 200 bacteria and the population triples every
half-hour. Assuming that the rate of increase is proportional to the number of
bacteria present,
a. find an expression for the number of bacteria present after t hours.
b. find the number of bacteria present after 20 min.
c. when will the bacteria population reach 10 000?
2. A city had a population of 150 000 in 1980 and 250 000 in 2000. Assuming
that the rate of increase is proportional to the population,
a. find an expression for the population of the city after t years.
b. what will the population of the city be in 2010?
3. Polonium-210 has a half-life of 140 days and eventually decays into lead. If a
sample has a mass of 200 mg and we assume that the rate of decay is proportional to the amount of polonium present,
a. find a formula for the mass that remains after t days.
b. find the mass after 50 days.
c. when will the mass be reduced to 5 mg?
Part B
4. The growth rate of the population of Central America is 3.5% per year (one
of the highest in the world). How long does it take the population to double
in size?
422 A P P E N D I X B
5. The population of a small town was 10 000 in 1950 and 12 000 in 1970.
Assuming a lack of housing and services will allow a maximum population of
16 000, what will the population be in 2005?
6. The number of rabbits on Easter Island was estimated to be 20 000 in 1995
and 22 000 in 1998. Assuming that the rabbit population can grow no larger
than 25 000 due to the scarcity of food and abundance of predators, find an
equation for the population of rabbits at any time t.
7. A hot potato at a temperature of 80C cools to 40C in 15 min when the room
temperature is 20C. If hot food tastes best when its temperature remains
above 50C, how long does a restaurant server have to get the potato to a customers table? Use Newtons law of temperature change.
8. When a coil of steel is removed from an annealing furnace, its temperature is
684C. Four minutes later, its temperature is 246C. How long will it take to
reach 100C? Apply Newtons law of temperature change, given that the temperature of the surrounding medium is 27C.
A N T I D E R I VAT I V E S
423
Appendix C
T E C H N I C A L A S S I S TA N C E
OVERVIEW
This appendix provides an overview of the instructions for using a graphing calculator. Use this appendix whenever you are not sure of the next step to take with
your calculator. For more detailed information on using a graphing calculator,
you may wish to refer to a more comprehensive graphing calculator guidebook.
Contents
Instructions for the TI83 Plus Graphing Calculator
Home Screen
Entering an Equation
Changing the Viewing Window
Displaying the Format Settings
Changing the Number of Decimal Places Displayed
Plotting the Function
Free-Moving Cursor
Trace
Zoom
Split Screens
Graphing a Family of Curves
Establishing a Table of Values for a Function
Calculating Roots and Zeroes of a Function
Finding the Intersection of Functions
Exploring Function Transformations
Graphing Functions and Inverses
Graphing Inequalities
Graphing Piecewise Functions and Exploring Continuity
Drawing Line Segments
Drawing Tangents
Using a Table of Values to Explore Limits of Functions
Finding the Numerical Derivative at a Given Point
Calculating Max/Min Values
Instructions for Zap-A-Graph
Technology Extension for Section 8.1
424 A P P E N D I X C
425
425
425
426
427
427
427
428
428
429
432
433
434
435
435
436
437
437
438
440
441
442
443
444
446
447
For example:
2nd
APPS
The alpha function of each key is printed in green above the key. When you press
the green ALPHA key, the alpha character printed in green above the other keys
becomes active for the next keystroke.
ANGLE
For example:
ALPHA
APPS
HOME SCREEN
The home screen is the primary screen. Use this screen to enter instructions and
expressions you want to evaluate. The answer is displayed on the same screen.
QUIT
2nd
MODE
ENTERING AN EQUATION
Press Y= . The Y= editor screen is where you define functions for tables and
graphing.
A highlighted = sign indicates that a function is selected. Use
, , and to clear any unwanted equations.
CLEAR
and
Y1 is not selected
Y2 and Y3 are selected
If any of Plot 1, Plot 2, or Plot 3 at the top of the screen are highlighted,
press and to place the cursor on Plot 1, Plot 2, or Plot 3 and then
press ENTER to change the on/off status of the stat plot.
T E C H N I C A L A S S I S TA N C E
425
If any of Plot 1, Plot 2, or Plot 3 at the top of the screen are highlighted,
press and to place the cursor on Plot 1, Plot 2, or Plot 3 and then
press ENTER to change the on/off status of the stat plot.
Place the cursor beside Y1=. Enter the equation using X.T.A.n to enter the
variable, for multiplication, for division, and ^ to indicate an
exponent. Remember to use ( ) to enter a negative sign. The key is used for
the operation of subtraction.
If you wish to enter more than one equation, move the cursor to Y2= and repeat
the procedure. The calculator stores up to ten functions in the Y= editor to the
variables Y1 through Y9 and Y0.
CHANGING THE VIEWING WINDOW
Press WINDOW to display the window editor, where you can view and edit the
values of the window variables.
Xmin, Xmax, Ymin, and Ymax define the
boundaries of the display.
Xscl and Yscl define the distance between
tick marks on the x- and y-axes. To turn off
tick marks, set Xscl 0 and Yscl 0.
Xres sets the pixel resolution (1 through 8)
for function graphs only. The default value
is l. At Xres 1, functions are evaluated
and graphed at each pixel on the x-axis.
At Xres 8, functions are evaluated at every eighth pixel along the x-axis. Small
Xres values improve graph resolution but may cause the calculator to draw graphs
more slowly.
426 A P P E N D I X C
2nd
Sets
Sets
Sets
Sets
Sets
Sets
Use
, and
ENTER
ZOOM
or
to move the
T E C H N I C A L A S S I S TA N C E
427
, or
The free moving cursor moves from pixel to pixel on the screen. You can move
the cursor so that it appears to be on the function, but the cursor may be on a pixel
that is near the function, yet not actually on the function. The coordinate value
displayed at the bottom of the screen may not be a point on the function. To move
the cursor along a function, use TRACE .
To display the graph with no cursor and no coordinate value, press
ENTER .
CLEAR
or
TRACE
Use the TRACE function to move the cursor from one plotted point to another
along a function.
To begin TRACE, press TRACE . A flashing trace cursor appears on the first selected function in the Y= editor at the middle x value on the screen. The x- and y-coordinates of this point on the curve appear at the bottom of your screen if the CoordOn
format is selected. The equation of the function is displayed in the top-left corner of
the screen if the ExprOn format is selected. To display the coordinates,
428 A P P E N D I X C
FORMAT
press
2nd
ZOOM
To move the trace cursor to any valid x-value on the current function, enter the
value and then press ENTER . This feature is particularly useful when you are looking for the maximum or minimum values of a function or the zeros of a function.
To move the trace cursor from function to function, press or
follows the order of the selected functions in the Y= editor.
. The cursor
If you move the trace cursor beyond the top or bottom of the screen, the coordinate values at the bottom of the screen continue to change. The plot function
must be deselected to scroll beyond the screen.
If you move the trace cursor beyond the left or right side of the screen, the viewing window automatically passes to the left or right. Xmin and Xmax are updated to correspond to the new viewing window. The plot function must be
deselected to scroll beyond the screen.
While tracing, you can press ENTER to adjust the viewing window so that the
cursor location becomes the centre of a new viewing window, even if the cursor is
above or below the display.
ZOOM
To help you find maximum, minimum, roots,
and intersections of functions, you can magnify
the viewing window at a specific location using
the ZOOM menu.
To display the ZOOM menu, press ZOOM .
You can adjust the viewing window in several
ways.
Zbox allows you to define a box on your
graphing screen that will become the new
enlarged window.
Select 1:Zbox from the ZOOM menu. The zoom cursor is displayed at the centre
of your screen. Move the cursor to the upper left corner of your desired box.
Press ENTER .
T E C H N I C A L A S S I S TA N C E
429
Use and to move the cursor to the lower right corner of your desired box.
You will see the box growing on the screen.
CLEAR
Ymin 3.1
Xmax 4.7
Ymax 3.1
Xsci 1
Ysci 1
These values set X and Y each equal to 0.1. The X- and Y-value of each pixel
is one decimal place. The graph is redrawn immediately with the new window
variables. You now have pixels centred at 4.7, 4.6, . . . , 4.7. This is useful if
you want to place the cursor at any of these specific x-values.
430 A P P E N D I X C
ZSquare
ZSquare changes the viewing window so that X Y, which makes the graph
of a circle look like a circle. ZSquare adjusts only one direction. The midpoint of
the current graph is the midpoint of the new graph. The graph is redrawn immediately with the new window variables.
ZStandard
ZStandard updates the window variables to the preset values shown below.
Xmin 10
Ymin 10
Xmax 10
Ymax 10
Xsci 1
Ysci 1
This allows you to return quickly to a standard grid setting. The graph is redrawn
immediately with the new window variables.
ZTrig
ZTrig updates the window variables to preset values that are appropriate for plotting trig functions. These values are shown below in radian mode.
Xmin 6.152285
Ymin 4
Xmax 6.152285
Ymax 4
Xsci 1.5707963
Ysci 1
Y 1
Xsci 10
Ysci 10
T E C H N I C A L A S S I S TA N C E
431
Press
ZOOM
To create
ticks on the
y-axis that
are more
useful, try
setting Yscl=
100 or 200.
You can now see the maximum
and minimum values of the
function.
SPLIT SCREENS
You can split the screen horizontally to display both a graph and its table or the
Y= editor screen.
You can split the screen vertically to display a graph and its table simultaneously.
432 A P P E N D I X C
T E C H N I C A L A S S I S TA N C E
433
. The Y= editor screen is where you define functions for tables and
Enter and/or highlight the function for which you wish a table of values.
TBLSET
Press
TABLE SETUP
TABLE
Press 2nd GRAPH for TABLE. The table of values will appear. You can use
and to scroll up and down the table.
If more than one function is selected in the Y= editor, there will be a list of yvalues in the table for each selected function.
Here we have the table for Y3 1x. The table abbreviates the values if necessary.
Independent variable in
the first column.
Dependent variables in
the other columns.
We tried to divide by
zero.
Current cells full value.
434 A P P E N D I X C
Press 2nd TRACE and select 2:zero. The current graph is displayed with Left Bound?
in the lower corner. Use or to move the
cursor onto the function for which you are seeking a zero. Use or to select the left
bound of the interval. Press ENTER .
In the same way, select the x-value of the right
bound. Indicators on the screen show the
interval you have selected. Use or or
enter a value for the x-value of your guess
in the selected interval. Press ENTER .
The coordinates of the zero are displayed
and the cursor is on the zero.
435
PRGM
To display the DRAW menu, press 2nd
and select 6:DrawF. The home screen appears.
Here you enter an expression for the transformed function.
436 A P P E N D I X C
2nd
PRGM
PRGM
2nd
PRGM
GRAPHING INEQUALITIES
Inequalities can be graphed using the Shade(
operation on the DRAW menu. This operation
shades the area between a lower function and
an upper function.
Shade(lowerfunc, upperfunc)
For example, to graph the inequality
0.5x3 5x 2x 4, enter the smaller side of
the inequality as Y1 and the larger side of the
inequality as Y2.
Adjust the window so that all intersection points
are shown. If the coordinates of the intersection
points are required, see Finding the Intersection
of Functions in a previous section.
T E C H N I C A L A S S I S TA N C E
437
press
2nd
PRGM
5
x4
x3
x3
3x6
x6
MATH
shown on the screen, using 2nd
menu operations to enter the inequality signs.
438 A P P E N D I X C
Press
2nd
ZOOM
Press TRACE . Move the cursor along the curve, observing the value of the coordinates as you approach the point of discontinuity.
T E C H N I C A L A S S I S TA N C E
439
You can also use a table of values to explore the continuity of the function. See
Using a Table of Values to Explore Limits of Functions, in a following section.
DRAWING LINE SEGMENTS
Line segments can be drawn in two ways, using the DRAW menu. The DRAW
instructions draw on top of the graph. Drawings are not interactive. Changing the
mode, format, or window variables and editing or deselecting functions will
remove drawing from the screen.
DRAW
2nd
440 A P P E N D I X C
PRGM
and select
Press 2nd PRGM and select 2:Line. Enter the coordinates of the beginning and
ending points of the line segment. Press ENTER .
DRAWING TANGENTS
Tangents can be drawn in two ways, using the DRAW menu. The DRAW instructions
draw on top of the graph. Drawings are not interactive. Changing the mode,
format, or window variables and editing or deselecting functions will remove
drawing from the screen.
DRAW
2nd
PRGM
and select
Press
2nd
PRGM
ENTER
In Func mode, the x-coordinate at which the tangent was drawn is shown, along
with the equation of the tangent. In all other modes, the value of dy/dx is shown.
Changing the fixed decimal setting on the mode screen will reduce the number of
decimals shown in the tangent equation.
T E C H N I C A L A S S I S TA N C E
441
Press 2nd PRGM and select 5:Tangent. To select the function, press VARS .
Move the cursor to Y-VARS. Press ENTER . Select the required function and press
ENTER . The home screen appears. Enter the x-coordinate at which you wish to
draw the tangent. Press ENTER .
442 A P P E N D I X C
TABLE
GRAPH
Press 2nd
for TABLE. The table of
values will appear. You can use and to
scroll up and down the table. As you scroll
down the table, the value of x approaches 5, the
value at which we are investigating a limit.
Observe the corresponding y-values as x
approaches 5.
Using a split screen, you can see the graph and the table of values simultaneously.
To split a screen vertically, press MODE .
Move the cursor to the bottom line of the
mode screen and select G-T (graph-table mode).
Use the TABLE SETUP window to define the
starting point and increment for the table. To
move from the graph to the table on the split
TABLE
screen, press
2nd
GRAPH
MATH
T E C H N I C A L A S S I S TA N C E
443
This gives an approximate value of the derivative of the expression, with respect
to variable, at a given value of the variable.
Press ENTER and the value of the derivative is displayed.
Finding the numerical derivative of a function
If the function is entered in the Y= editor
screen, it may be easier to use the operation
dy/dx in the CALCULATE menu to find the numerical derivative (slope) of a function at a point.
CALC
MATH
T E C H N I C A L A S S I S TA N C E
445
To graph f , click on the OPTIONS menu and select Derivative. If Show Equation
is selected, the equation of f is displayed.
To graph f , repeat the process.
446 A P P E N D I X C
Enter lower bound, upper bound, and the number of intervals. Click on OK.
The approximate area under the curve is displayed.
By increasing the number of intervalsc you can obtain a better approximation of
the area.
TECHNOLOGY EXTENSION FOR SECTION 8.1DERIVATIVES OF
EXPONENTIAL FUNCTIONS
Using a spreadsheet option
Try the following spreadsheet option for the Investigation on page 300 in Chapter 8.
INVESTIGATION
447
Appendix D
PERFORMANCE ASSESSMENT AND
C A R E E R L I N K L E T T E R H E A D TA S K S
Advanced Functions and Introductory Calculus Student Rubric
End of Chapter Task Generic Rubric
This student rubric may assist you in understanding general assessment criteria and desired levels of performance related to Career Link Wrap-Up tasks and other mathematics assignments. You may wish to
use this general rubric to
However, it is important to note the generic nature of this rubric. You can work with your teachers to develop more specific coaching or scoring criteria. Helpful rubrics are clear rubrics and therefore may involve
many decisions, including defining quality, determining criteria, weighing criteria, setting a standard, determining levels, developing descriptors, and translating levels to marks or grades.
Assessment
Category
Knowledge/
Understanding
LEVEL 1
A mathematical model is
generated with significant
errors
Communication
448 A P P E N D I X D
LEVEL 4
A correct mathematical
model is generated
Demonstrates, through
algorithmic work, some
understanding of concepts
Demonstrates, through
algorithmic work, a
considerable understanding
of concepts
Limited mathematical
reasoning
Some mathematical
reasoning
Considerable mathematical
reasoning
Explanations and
justifications have limited
detail and lack clarity
Explanations and
justifications are partially
understandable, with some
detail
Explanations and
justifications are clear and
understandable
Explanations and
justifications are particularly
clear and thoroughly detailed
Independently applies
concepts and procedures
correctly in an unfamiliar
setting
Independently applies
concepts and procedures in
an unfamiliar setting using
new or modified strategies
Infrequently uses
mathematical symbols,
terminology, and conventions
correctly
Application
LEVEL 3
A mathematical model is
generated with minor errors
Demonstrates, through
algorithmic work, a limited
understanding of concepts
Thinking/Inquiry/
Problem Solving
LEVEL 2
A correct mathematical
model is generated and
verified
Demonstrates, through
algorithmic work, a thorough
understanding of concepts
Thorough mathematical
reasoning extended to the
general case
Sequences and selects tools
efficiently and effectively
HealthLink
Health-Care Consultants
322 Transdermal Drive
Ste. 405
Sudbury, ON
P3C IA7
P E R F O R M A N C E A S S E S S M E N T A N D C A R E E R L I N K L E T T E R H E A D TA S K S
449
I have collected the information in the tables below to assist in developing the
models:
(in thousands)
10 299.6
10 427.6
10 570.5
10 690.4
10 827.5
10 964.9
11 100.9
11 249.5
11 384.4
11 513.8
f = forecast
Source: Canadian Institute for Health
Information, Table C6.1 (www.cihi.ca)
Good luck and thank you in advance for all your work.
Yours truly,
Jeannine Truscott
President
P E R F O R M A N C E A S S E S S M E N T A N D C A R E E R L I N K L E T T E R H E A D TA S K S
451
VIRTU-OSITY INC.
1594 Burton St.
Edmonton, AB
T0G 1M0
Re: Optimal Production Levels for CD-ROM Games
Dear Advanced Functions and Introductory Calculus Student:
I am the president of a discount computer game company. Our
sales have been suffering for the last year because our
average production cost has risen to $9.60 per game,
exceeding our sales price of $9.40 each. We currently sell
1000 units per day. In addition to losing money, we are in
some other serious trouble because our financial controller
took a job with a competitor, and subsequently all of our costaccounting records mysteriously disappeared.
About a month before the controller left, he proposed that we
could get out of the red by dropping our price to $7.90 per
game. He indicated that by dropping our price, we would be
able to secure additional customers that would result in sales
increasing to 2000 units per day. In turn, he said, we would
start garnering profits of $200 per day at the 2000-unit sales
level. Of course I immediately dismissed his idea because the
$7.90 price is $1.70 less than our average cost. To me it
seemed obvious that this price decrease would only
exacerbate our losses. In hindsight, however, I am wondering
if maybe our controller was right after all. That is why I am
bringing you into the picture.
P E R F O R M A N C E A S S E S S M E N T A N D C A R E E R L I N K L E T T E R H E A D TA S K S
453
Thomas B. LaRivire
President and CEO
2
Glossary
Absolute Value the positive value for a real num-
metic sequence.
Assumption a statement that is to be accepted as
f (a h) f (a)
quotient
h. The average rate of
x
change of the function f (x) over the interval x a to
x a h.
Axiom a statement assumed to be true without formal proof. Axioms are the basis from which other
theorems and statements are deduced through proof.
Axis of Symmetry a line that passes through a figure in such a way that the part of the figure on one
side of the line is a mirror reflection of the part on the
other side; an exact correspondence of form or shape
on opposite sides of the line.
Base in the exponential expression bp, b is called the
base and p is the exponent.
Calculus a branch of mathematics, discovered independently by Sir Isaac Newton and Gottfried Wilhelm
von Leibniz, that deals with the instantaneous rate of
change of a function (Differential Calculus) and the
area under a function (Integral Calculus).
Cardioid a plane curve traced by a point on a circle
rolling on the outside of a circle of equal radius.
Cartesian Coordinate System a reference system
in 2-space, consisting of two axes at right angles, or
3-space (three axes) in which any point in the plane is
located by its displacements from these fixed lines
(axes). The origin is the common point from which
each displacement is measured. In 2-space, a set of
two numbers or coordinates is required to uniquely
define a position; in 3-space, three coordinates are
required.
G L O S S A RY
455
456 G L O S S A RY
xa
an object.
457
Result
Action
am an
amn
a0
am
an
amn
an
(am)n
amn
ba
1
an
bn
an
(ab)m
ambm
ba
,b0
am
m
b
Result
p
q
(a)p or
ap
f(a h) f(a)
h0
dy
Leibniz Notation for example, is Leibniz notadx
tion for the derivative of y with respect to x. The notation we use in everyday calculus is attributable primarily to Leibniz.
Limit (of a Function) the notation lim f (x) L
xa
implies that as x approaches closer and closer to the
value a, the value of the function approaches a limiting value of L.
Linear Equation an equation where the highest
degree term is that of the first degree, for example,
3x 4 0.
Linear Relation (Function) a relation between two
variables that, when graphed on a Cartesian coordinate
system, results in a straight line.
Local Maximum a function f(x) has a local maximum at x0 if and only if there exists some interval I
containing x0 such that f(x0) f(x) for all x in I.
Local Minimum a function f(x) has a local minimum at x0 if and only if there exists some interval I
containing x0 such that f(x0) f(x) for all x in I.
Logarithm the exponent to which a base must be
raised to get the number.
Logarithm (Common) logarithms of numbers
459
Mantissa the positive fractional part of the representation of a logarithm; in the expression
log10 643 2.808, the mantissa is .808. See
Characteristic.
Mapping a rule that assigns to every element of one
set a unique element of another set. For example, a
function has a 1 for 1 mapping between its domain
and range. See Relation.
Maximum the largest value of a function on a given
interval of values.
Minimum the smallest value of a function on a given
interval of values.
Monic Polynomial a polynomial in one variable.
Normal Line the line drawn at a point on a graph of
f(x), perpendicular to the tangent line drawn at that
point.
Oblique (Slant) Asymptote the line y ax b is
a slant or oblique asymptote of f(x) if and only if
lim f(x) ax b.
x
460 G L O S S A RY
Range (of a Relation) the set of second coordinates of the order pairs of the relation. See Domain.
Ratio a number or quantity compared with another.
It is usually written as a fraction or with the symbol
: .
Rational Number a number that can be expressed
as an integer or as a quotient of integers (a fraction).
Real Number any rational or irrational number.
Reflection a transformation of a point, line, or figure
that results in a mirror image of the original.
Relation a mapping of one set to another set so that
each element in the first set (the domain) corresponds
to one or more elements in the second set (the range).
When the correspondence between domain and range
is 1 to 1, the mapping is defined as a function.
Remainder Theorem if f(x) is divided by (x p),
giving a quotient q(x) and a remainder r, then the
remainder is given by r f(p).
Richter Scale a method of comparing the intensities
x
f(a h) f(a)
given by lim
lim h.
x
h0
h0
value of velocity.
Sum Rule if functions p(x) and q(x) are differentiable and f (x) p(x) q(x), then
f (x) p(x) q(x). In Leibniz notation:
df
dp
dq
.
dx
dx
dx
Tangent a line segment drawn to a figure that
G L O S S A RY
461
Answers
C H A P T E R 1 P O LY N O M I A L F U N C T I O N S
Review of Prerequisite Skills
1. a. (P r)2 b. (4n 1)2 c. (3u 5)2 d. (v 3)(v 1)
e. (2w 1)(w 1) f. (3k 1)(k 2) g. (7y 1)(y 2)
h. (5x 1)(x 3) i. (3v 5)(v 2)
2. a. (5x y)(5x y) b. (m p)(m p) c. (1 4r)(1 4r)
d. (7m 8)(7m 8) e. (pr 10x)(pr 10x)
f. 3(1 4y)(1 4y) g. (x n 3)(x n 3)
h. (7u x y)(7u x y) i. (x2 4)(x 2)(x 2)
3. a. (k p)(x y) b. (f g)(x y) c. (h 1)(h2 1)
d. (x d)(1 x d) e. (2y z 1)(2y z 1)
f. (x z y)(x z y)
4. a. 2(2x 3)(x 1) b. 4(7s 5t)(s t)
c. (y r n)(y r n) d. 8(1 5m)(1 2m)
e. (3x 2)(2x 3) f. (y 1)(y2 5) g. 10(3y 4)(2y 3)
h. 2(5x2 19x 10) i. 3(3x 4)(3x 4)
5. a. (12x 4y 5u)(12x 16y 5u) b. g(1 x)(1 x)
c. (y 1)(y4 y2 1) d. (n2 w2)2
e. (x 14y z)(7x 2y 7z) f. (u 1)(4u 3)(2u 1)
g. (p 1 y z)(p 1 y z) h. (3y2 2)2
1 2
Exercise 1.2
1. f(x) x2 5x 4
2. f(x) 3x 4
3. f(x) 2x2 5x 3
4. f(x) 2x2 7x 4
5. f(x) 2x3 5x2 21x 36
6. f(x) x3 15x 20
7. f(x) x3 x2 14x 24
8. f(x) 2x3 x2 13x 6
9. f(x) x4 10x3 35x2 52x 24
10. f(x) 2x1
11. a. V 0.0374t3 0.1522t2 0.1729t
b. maximum volume of 0.8863 L at 3.2 s
12. a. f(t) t3 27t2 3t 403t b. 1999 c. 57 000
Exercise 1.3
1. a. 17 5(3) 2 b. 42 7(6) 0 c. 73 12(6) 1
d. 90 6(15) 0 e. 103 10(10) 3 f. 75 15(5) 0
2. a. The remainder is not zero. b. The remainder is zero.
c. possible solution from Question 1: 1.d. 15; 1.f. 5
d. 15 f. 5
3. The dividend equals the product of the divisor and the quotient
added to the remainder of the division.
4. a. x 2 b. x2 3x 2 c. 5 d. x3 x2 8x 9
5. f(x) 3x2 8x2 8x 26
6. f (x) x4 x2
7. a. x3 3x2 x 2 (x 2)(x2 5x 11) 20
b. x3 4x2 3x 2 (x 1)(x2 5x 2)
c. 2x3 4x2 3x 5 (x 3)(2x2 2x 3) 14
d. 3x3 x2 x 6 (x 1)(3x2 2x 1) 7
462 A N S W E R S
b.
y
x
x
3
c.
d.
x
0
x
2
e.
f.
C H A P T E R 2 P O LY N O M I A L
E Q U AT I O N S A N D I N E Q U A L I T I E S
g.
4 3
h.
b. x 6
x
2
x
1
i.
j.
k.
3 4
l.
x
3
2. a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
3. a.
b.
c.
d.
4. a.
5. a.
b.
c.
6. a.
x
2
Chapter 1 Test
1. a. 2(3x 56)(3x 56) b. (pm 1)(m2 1)
c. 2(3x 2)(2x 3) d. (x y 3)(x y 3)
2. a.
b.
y
y
x
2
x
0
4.5
2 1
d. x 2
x
c. x 4.5
x
2
3. a.
4. a.
5. a.
d.
g.
6. a.
g.
7. a.
0 b. 15 c. 10 d. 0
53
2 b. 13 c. 52 d. 8
(x 6)(x 8) b. (y 2)(y 1) c. (3x 7)(x 1)
3(x 5)(x 5) e. (3x 1)(2x 3) f. x(x 8)(x 7)
4x(x 5) h. 3x(x 2)(x 2) i. 2(3x 2)(x 3)
4
0, 4 b. 3, 2 c. 3, 2 d. 6, 3 e. 5, 3 f. 1, 7
7
1
1, 3 h. 3, 0, 3 i. 3 , 4
1 i35
1.5, 5.5 b. 2.3, 0.6 c.
d. 5.7, 0.7
6
3 i31
e. 3, 0.5 f. 1.5, 0.7 g.
h. 6, 1 i. 8.3, 0.7
4
Exercise 2.1
1. 0
2. a. (x 5) b. Divide.
3. (x 1), (x 2), (x 3)
4. a. Yes. b. No. c. Yes. d. No. e. No. f. Yes.
5. b. x 3 c. x2 x 1
6. b. x 2 c. x2 4x 3
7. a. (x 1)(x2 x 3) b. (x 2)(x 1)(x 1)
c. (y 1)(y2 20y 1) d. (x 1)(x2 x 4)
e. (y 2)(y2 y 1) f. (x 4)(x2 5x 2)
g. (x 2)(x 3)(x2 7x 2) h. (x 2)(x 8)(x2 1)
8. 2.5
9. 1.5
10. a. (x 3)(x2 3x 9) b. (y 2)(y2 2y 4)
c. (5u 4r)(25u2 20ur 16r2)
d. 2(10w y)(100w 10wy y2)
e. (x y uz)(x2 2xy y2 xuz yuz u2z2)
f. (5)(u 4x 2y)(u2 4ux 2uy 16x2 16xy 4y2)
12. b. x3 x2y xy2 y3 c. (x 3)(x3 3x2 9x 27)
13. b. x4 x3y x2y2 xy3 y4
c. (x 2)(x4 2x3 4x2 8x 16)
14. b. xn1 xn2y xn3y2 ... yn1
17. If n is odd.
18. (x y)(x4 x3y x2y2 xy3 y4)
19. No.
Exercise 2.2
1
5
1 2
1
1
1. a. 2, 2, 1, 5 b. 3, 3 c. 1, 2, 2, 4
1
1
1
1
3
d. 1, 2, 4, 2, 4, 8 e. 1, 3, 2, 2,
1
ANSWERS
463
4. a.
c.
e.
g.
5. a.
Exercise 2.3
1. the factors of 8
2. (x 1)(x 2)(x 4) 0
3. a. f(x) kx(x 2)(x 3) b. f(x) 2x(x 2)(x 3)
4. a. f(x) k(x 1)(x 1)(x 2)
1
b. f(x) 2(x 1)(x 1)(x 2)
5. a. f(x) k(x 2)(x 1)(x 1)(x 3)
1
b. f(x) 2(x 2)(x 1)(x 1)(x 3)
16. x1 x2 x3 x4 a,
c
x1x2 x1x3 x1x4 x2x3 x2x4 x3x4 a,
d
Exercise 2.5
1. a. f(x) 0 for x 3, 0 x 4 f(x) 0 for 3 x 0,
x 4 b. f(x) 0 for 2 x 1, x 4 f(x) 0
for x 2, 1 x 4 c. f(x) 0 for x 3, 0 x 2
f(x) 0 for 3 x 0
2. a. 0 x 2 b. 3 x 1 c. 2 x 5
d. x 3 or x 0.5 e. x 2 f. x 3, 0 x 3
g. x 1, 1 x 5 h. x 2, 0.5 x 1
i. 3.1 x .2 or x
3.3 j. R
3. a.
b. t 59.15 C c. t 270.50 C
30
6. (x 1)(x 2)(5x 3) 0
7. 2
8. a. 4, 5 b. 1 3i c. 0, 2, 5 d. 0, 2, 2 e. 1, 0, 1
10
3 3 3i3
f. i, 1 g. 1, 0, 4 h. 2,
i. 2, 3, 3
4
30
1 33
n. 2,
2
7 17
1
3
1
9. a. 1,
b. 4, 1, 4 c. 2, 3 5 d. 0, 2, 2
4
7 13
1 3i
e. 3, 2 f. i, 7 g. 2,
h. 2,
2
2
1 23
10. a. 1, i, 3, i3 b. 2, 1, 1 3i,
2
1 34
1 2
1
1
c. 2, 1, 2, 3 d. 3, 4, 3, 4 e.
,
3
3
f. 8, 2, 3 i21
11. 5 cm
12. a. 7.140, 0.140 b. 2.714, 1.483, 3.231 c. 1, 0.732, 2732
d. 2.278, 1.215, 1.215, 2.278
13. 3 cm, 4 cm, 5 cm
14. 6.64 m
15. 3.1 s
Exercise 2.4
5 9
7 8
1. a. 5, 11 b. 2, 2 c. 3, 3
2. a. x2 3x 7 0 b. x2 6x 4 0 c. 25x2 5x 2 0
d. 12x2 13x 3 0 e. 3x2 33x 2 0
3. a. x2 10x 21 0 b. x2 3x 40 0
c. 3x2 10x 3 0 d. 8x2 10x 3 0
e. 125x2 85x 12 0 f. x2 4x 5 0
4. 6
5. 6, k 21
6. x2 4x 13 0
7. 2x2 37x 137 0
8. x2 7x 9 0
9. 16x2 97x 4 0
10. x2 10x 5 0
11. 4x2 40x 1 0
c
b.
2
2 x 2
c.
d.
4
4 x 4
3. a.
x 3 or x 3
0
x
2 or x 2
b.
3 f(x)
5 g(x)
c.
d.
5 h(x)
6 m(x)
x
x
2
5 2.5
e.
f.
f(x)
1 g(x)
4
3
4. a.
b.
y
x
x
2
d.
464 A N S W E R S
Exercise 2.6
1. a. 10 b. 19 c. 4 d. 6
2. a.
c.
b
x
0
e.
f.
y
(1, 1)
(1, 1)
x
x
1
6. a.
b.
x
3
c.
y
x
1
4 8
7. a. x 4, 3 b. x 3, 3 c. 6 x 12
1
d. x
1 or x 9 e. 2 x 2 f. no solution
4
9. none
10.
f(x)
x
2
Review Exercise
1. a. (x 3) b. (3x 2)
2. a. y a(x 4)(x 1)(x 2) b. y (x 4)(x 1)(x 2)
3. a. No. b. Yes.
4. (x 5)(x2 x 1)
3
35
5. a. 4 b. 3
3
6. a. (x 1)(x2 x 1)
b. (x 1)(x 2)(x 3) c. (2x 3y)(4x2 6xy 9y2)
d. 3(x 2x pr)(x2 4xw 4w2 prx 2wpr p2r2)
8. a. (2x 3)(x2 x 1) b. (x 1)(3x 5)(3x 1)
9. a. Yes b. No
10. a. (3x 1)(x2 x 1) b. (2x 5)(x2 3x 1)
c. (5x 1)(3x 1)(2x 1)
11. a. 2.5 b. 0, 5, 5 c. 2, 1 i3 d. 1, 3, 3
1 i3
3 21
e. -4, 4, 2i f. 1,
g. 2,
2
2
3 3i3 1 i3
h. 1, 3,
,
i. 1 5, 1 i2
2
2
12. a. x 1.414 b. x 10.196, 0.196
c. x 1.377, 0.274, 2.651 d. x 1.197
e. x 2.857, 1.356 f. x 5.67
13. x2 3 and k 1
14. x2 5x 2 0
1
15. a. x1 x2 2, x1x2 2 b. 15x2 x 2 0
2
c. x2 6x 13 0 d. x2 3, k 1
2
2
e. x x 4 0 f. 4x x 2 0
16. a. 4 x 2 b. x 2 or x
1 c. x 0
d. 1 x 1 or x 2 e. x 0 f. R
CHAPTER 3 INTRODUCTION TO
CALCULUS
Review of Prerequisite Skills
2
2
5
1. a. 3 b. 2 c. 12 d. 1 e. 3 f. 3 g. 4 h. 4 i. 6
4
1
j. 1 k. 1
0 l. 1
2. a. y 4x 2 b. y 2x 5
c. y 5 0 d. 2x 3y 12 0 e. 6x 5y 36 0
f. x y 2 0 g. 6x y 2 0 h. 4x y 0
i. 7x y 27 0 j. 3x y 6 0 k. x 3 0
l. y 5 0
5
5
3
3. a. 52 b. 13 c. 0 d. 5
2
4. a. 6 b. 3 c. 9
1
5. a. 2 b. 1 c. 5 d. 1 e. 106
52
63
6 43
6
3 3
6. a.
b.
c.
d.
2
3
3
6
57 20
15 103
e. f. 6 43 g.
2
9
66
152
20 25
h.
i.
13
19
9
13
2
3
7. a.
b.
c. d.
52
63
6
57 4
66 152
1
1
e. f.
3
7
8. a.
d.
g.
i.
9. a.
e.
i.
l.
23 7
Exercise 3.1
5
1
1. a. 3 b. 3 c. 3
1
7
2. a. 3 b. 13
ANSWERS
465
3. a.
d.
4. a.
d.
x y 0 b. y 8x 6 c. 3x 5y 15 0
x50
4 h b. 75 15h h2 c. 108 54h 12h2 h3
1
3
2
1
1 h e. 6 3h f. 12 6h h g. 4(4 h) h. 4 2h
1
1
h5
5. a. b.
c.
2
16 h 4
h 5
h42
5 h 5
1
6. a. 6 3h b. 3 3h h2 c.
9h3
7. a. P(2, 8)
Q
b.
8. a.
9. a.
Slope of PQ
(3, 27)
19
(2.5, 15.625)
15.25
(2.1, 9.261)
12.61
(2.01, 8.120601)
12.0601
(1, 1)
(1.5, 3.375)
9.25
(1.9, 6.859)
11.41
(1.99, 7.880599)
11.9401
1
1
10. a. 2 b. 2 c.
25
1
1
3
1
1
11. a. 1 b. 1 c. 9 d. 4 e. 10 f. 4 g. 6 h. 16
5
16. 4
Exercise 3.2
1. 0 s and 4 s
2. a. slope of the secant between two points (2, s(2)) and (9, s(9))
b. slope of the tangent at (6, s(6))
3. slope of the tangent to y x at (4, 2)
4. a. between A and B b. greater
7. a. 5 m/s, 25 m/s, 75 m/s b. 55 m/s c. 20 m/s
8. a. i) 72 km/h ii) 64.8 km/h iii) 64.08 km/h c. 64 km/h
9. a. 15 terms b. 16 terms/h
1
10. a. 3 mg/h
1
11. 5
0 s/m
12
12. 5C/km
13. 2 s, 0 m/s
14. a. $4800 b. $80/ball c. 0 x 8
1
15. a. 6 b. 1 c. 1
0
2
18. 200 m /m
Exercise 3.3
8
1. a. 1
1 b.
4. a. 5 b. 10 c. 100 d. 8 e. 4 f. 8
5. 1
6. a. 0 b. 2 c. 1 d. 2
7. a. 2 b. 1 c. does not exist
466 A N S W E R S
Exercise 3.4
100
4. a. 1 b. 1 c. 9 d. 53 e. 2 f. 3
5. a. 2 b. 2
7
7
1
1
1
7. a. 4 b. 4 c. 7 d. 1 e. 3 f. 27 g. 0 h. 2 i. 2 j. 4 k. 4
1
1
3
l. m. 2 n. 4 o. 16
7
12 c. 12 6h h2 d. 12
12 b. 5 c. 12
1 b. 1 c. 5
2
4
6
8. a. 8 b. 2 c. 2
9. 5
1
1
10. a. 0 b. 0 c. 5 d. 2 e. 5 f. does not exist
11. a. does not exist b. 2 c. 2 d. does not exist
13. m 3, b 1
14. a 3, b 2, c 0
1
1
15. b. 6, 4 c. 2000 d. 22 years after the spill, or 82 years in total.
1
1
1
1
1
8. a. 1
2 b. 27 c. 6 d. 2 e. 12 f. 12
2
1
3
1
9. a. 0 b. 0 c. 4 d. 1 e. 0 f. 3 g. 16 h. 4 i. 2 j. 2
1
k. 2x l. 3
2
10. a. does not exist b. does not exist c. does not exist d. 0
V 22
.4334
11. b. V 0.08213T 22.4334 c. T
0.08213
13. a. 27 b. 1 c. 1
14. a. 0 b. 0
1
15. a. 0 b. 0 c. 2
16. 2
17. No.
18. b 2
19. m 6, b 9
Exercise 3.5
4. a. 3 b. 0 c. 0 d. 3 e. 3, 2 f. 3
5. a. x R b. x R c. x 0, 0 x 5, x 5, x R
d. x
2, x R e. x R f. x R
7. continuous everywhere
8. No.
9. 0, 100, 200, and 500
10. Yes.
11. discontinuous at x 2
12. k 16
13. a 1, b 6
14. a. 1, 1, does not exist b. discontinuous at x 1
Review Exercise
1. a. 3 b. 7 c. 2x y 5 0
1
1
1
5
2. a. 3 b. 2 c. 27 d. 4
3. a. 2 b. 2
4. a. 5 m/s; 15 m/s b. 40 m/s c. 60 m/s
5. a. 0.0601 g b. 6.01 g/min c. 6 g/min
6. a. 7 105 tonnes b. 1.8 105 tonnes/year
c. 1.5 105 tonnes/year d. 7.5 years
7. a. 10 b. 7, 0 c. t 3, t 4
9. a. x 1, x 1 b. do not exist
10. not continuous at x 3
2
x2
37
C H A P T E R 4 D E R I VAT I V E S
1
13. 3
1
b. 2
x
f(x)
f(x)
1.9
0.34483
0.9
0.52632
1.99
0.33445
0.99
0.50251
1.999
0.33344
0.999
0.50025
2.001
0.33322
1.001
0.49975
2.01
0.33223
1.01
0.49751
2.1
0.32258
1.1
0.47619
14.
x
f(x)
0.1
0.29112
0.01
0.28892
0.001
0.2887
0.001
0.28865
0.01
0.28843
0.1
0.28631
15. a.
x
f(x)
2.1
0.24846
2.01
0.24984
2.001
0.24998
2.0001
0.25
1
c. 4
3
17. a. 2 b. 5a2 3a 7 c. does not exist d. 1 e. 12 f. 4
3
2
1
3
3
3
g. 3 h. 10a i. 7 j. 5 k. 1 l. 1 m. 2 n.
2
1
1
o. p. 3 q. 0 r. 16 s. 48 t. 4 u. 2
5
Chapter 3 Test
5. 13
4
6.
3
7. 2
8. x y 2 0
9. a. does not exist b. 1 c. 1 d. 1, 2
10. a. 1.8 105 b. 4000 people/year
11. a. 1 km/h b. 2 km/h
16 h 4
12.
13. 31
7
3
1
1
14. a. 12 b. 5 c. 4 d. 4 e. 6 f. 1
2
18
15. a 1, b 5
17. k 8
7
2
2. a. x 6 b. 4x4 c. a 3
3. a.
4. a.
5. a.
c.
3
3
b. 2 c. d. 1
2
5
x 2y 5 0 b. 3x 2y 16 0 c. 4x 3y 7 0
2x2 5xy 3y2 b. x3 5x2 10x 8
12x2 36x 21 d. 13x 42y e. 29x2 2xy 10y2
15x
y5
8
6. a. 2, x 2, 0 b.
4y2(y 2) , y 5 c. 9 , h k
2
8x 7
4x 7
11x
d.
f.
(x y)2 , x y e. 2x(x 1)
(x 2)(x 3)
7. a. 2a(5a 3) b. (2k 3)(2k 3) c. (x 4)(x 8)
2
d.
g.
i.
8. a.
b.
c.
d.
32
43
6
30 172
11 46
9. a.
b.
c.
d.
2
3
23
5
Exercise 4.1
1. a. x R, x 2 b. x R, x 2 c. x R d. x R, x 1
e. x R f. x 2, x R
1
4. a. 2 b. 9 c. 2
3
3
2
d.
5. a. 2x 3 b.
(x 2)2 c.
x3
2
3x 2
2
6. a. 7 b.
(x 1)2 c. 6x
7. 4, 0, 4
8. 8 m/s, 0 m/s, 4 m/s
9. x 6y 10 0
10. a. 0 b. 1 c. m d. 2ax b
12. a and e, b and f, c and d
13. 1
14. f (0) 0
15. 3
1
16. f (x) (x 3) 3 , answers will vary
Exercise 4.2
1
2. a. 4 b. 0 c. 4x 1 d. e. 12x2 f. 3x2 2x g. 2x 5
2x
3
1
3 j. 18x k. x l. 3x4
h.
3 2 i. x
4
3
x
dy
3. a. d
2x 3 b. f (x) 6x2 10x 4
x
2
c. v(t) 18t2 20t4 d. s(t) t3, t 0 e. f (x) 6x5
ds
f. h(x) 4x 11 g. dt 4t3 6t2 h. g(x) 20x4
dy
3
i. d
x4 x2 x j. g(x) 40x7 k. s(t) 2t3 2
x
d
y
21
m
l. g(x) 7f (x) m. h(x) x
8 n.
dx
4
2
1
3
2
3
5
2x
4
3
3x
1
3
1
1
ANSWERS
467
3
8. a. 9 b. 2 c. 4 d. 7
9. a. 6x y 4 0 b. 18x y 25 0 c. 9x 2y 9 0
d. x y 3 0 e. 7x 2y 28 0 f. 5x 6y 11 0
10. x 18y 125 0
11. 8 or 8
12. No
14. (1, 0)
15. (2, 10), (2, 6)
17. a. y 3 0, 16x y 29 0;
b. 20x y 47 0, 4x y 1 0
18. 7
19. a. 50 km b. 0.12 km/m
20. 0.29 min, 1.71 min
21. 20 m/s
22. (1, 3), (1, 3)
23. (0, 0)
1
25. 1 n, approaches 1
26. a. f (x)
2x,1, xx 33
6x, x 2
b. f (x) 6x, 2 x 2
6x, x 2
f (x) does not exist at (2, 0), (2, 0).
1, x 1
1, 1 x 0
c. f (x)
1, 0 x 1
1, x 0
f (x) does not exist at (1, 0), (0, 1), (1, 0).
Exercise 4.3
1. a. 2x 4 b. 6x2 2x c. 12x 17 d. 8x 26
e. 45x8 80x7 2x 2 f. 8t3 2t
2. a. 15(5x 1)2(x 4) (5x 1)3
b. 6x(3 x3)5 15x2(3x2 4)(3 x3)4
c. 8x(1 x2)3(2x 6)3 6(1 x2)4(2x 6)2
4. a. 9 b. 4 c. 9 d. 6 e. 36 f. 22 g. 671 h. 12
5. 10x y 8 0
6. a. (14, 450) b. (1, 0)
7. a. 3(x 1)2(x 4)(x 3)2 (x 1)3(x 3)2
2(x 1)3(x 4)(x 3)
b. 2x(3x2 4)2(3 x3)4 12x3(3x2 4)(3 x3)4
12x4(3x2 4)2(3 x3)3
8. 30
9. a. f (x) g(x)g2(x) ... g11(x) g1(x) g2(x) g3(x) ... g11(x)
g1(x) g2(x) g3(x) ... g11(x) ...
n(n 1)
g1(x) g2(x) ... gx1(x) g11(x) b. 2
10. f(x) 3x2 6x 5
11. a. 1 b. f (x) 2x, x 1 or x 1;
f (x) 2x, 1 x 7 c. 4, 0, 6
468 A N S W E R S
Exercise 4.4
1
1 dy
ds
8x, dt 1
2. f (x) 1, g(x) 2x 3 , h(x)
2x6 , d
x
1
x 2x
13
7
2x 3x
4. a.
(x 1)2 b. (x 1)2 c. (t 5)2 d. (x 3)2 e. (2x2 1)2
2
2x
5x 6x 5
x 4x 3
x 6x 1
h.
f.
(x2 3)2 g. (1 x2)2
(x2 3)2 i. (3x2 x)2
2
13
7
200
7
5. a. 4 b. 2
5 c. 841 d. 3
6. 9
Exercise 4.5
1. a. 0 b. 0 c. 1 d. 15
e.
x2 1 f. x 1
2. a. f(g(x)) x, x
0; g(f(x)) x, x R; f g g f
1
1
b. f(g(x))
x2 1 , x R; g(f(x)) x2 1, x 0; f g g f
1
1
2x
1
c. f(g(x)) , x 2; g(f(x))
x , x 2 or
x2
x 0; f g g f
1
3. a. 3x 1 b. c. (3x 1)3
x1
d.
x3
1
1
e. f. 3x3 1 g. h. 3xx 1
3x 2
x 1
1
i. 3
(x 1)
Exercise 4.6
2. a. 8(2x 3)2 b. 6(5 x)5 c. 6x(x2 4)2 d. 15x2(7 x3)4
e. 4(4x 3)(2x2 3x 5)3 f. 5(5x x2)4(5 2x)
g. 6x(2 x2)2 h. 4(1 2x 3x2)(1 x x2 x3)3
2
5
i. 12(2 x)3[(2 x)4 16]2 j. k.
4x 1
2
5x 7
x
x
1
10x
l.
m.
o. 2
(x2 16)6 n.
x2 3
x2 43
2x(x 1)
1
2(x 2)2(x 1)
2(1 u 3 )5
p.
q. 3
2x 5 r. x
3 2
2
u
6
6
1
2x
8
6x
3. a. x
3 b.
x4 c. (x 1)2 d. (x2 4)2 e. x3 f. (9 x2)2
(1 x)2(x 2)
10x
1
4(2x
1)
g.
x3
(5x2 x)2 h. (x2 x 1)5 i.
(3x 1)(x 3)
4. a. 3(3x 5)(x 4)2(x 3)5 b.
(1 x2)2
2(x
3x 1)
d.
e. 3x2 (3x 5)(4x 5)
(x2 1)2
2
(2x 1)(2x 5)
g. 4x3(1 4x2)2(1 10x2)
f.
(x 2)4
92
92
14. c. (0, 0), 32,
,
2 , 32
2 d. 14
48x(x2 3)3
3
2
2 3
h.
(x2 3)5 i. 6x(2x 3x 3)(x 3) (x 3)
1
j.
k. 12(4 3t3)3(1 2t)5(9t3 3t2 4)
3
(1 x2) 2
15. a. 50
3.68 b. 1
16. a. 9, 19 b. 1.7 words/min, 2.3 words/min
30t
17. a.
2 3 b. Yes. The limit of N(t) as t 0 is 0.
(
9t )
1
l. 2
18. a. x2 40 b. 6 gloves/week
(1 x)
1x
91
7
5. a. 3
6 b. 48
5
20. 4
6. x 0, x 1
Chapter 4 Test
3. f (x) 1 2x
1
1
2
4. a. x2 15x6 b. 60(2x 9)4 c. 3
3
2
1
7. 4
8. 60x y 119 0
9728
3
1
9. a. 52 b. 78 c. 54 d. 320 e. 2
7 f. 8 g. 48608
10. 10
42
11. 2
5
12. 6
13. a. h(x) p(x)g(x)r(x) p(x)q(x)r(x) p(x)q(x)r(x)
b. 344
2x(x 3x 1)(1 x)
15.
(1 x)4
2
6x
7
5. 14
40
6. 3
7. 60x y 61 0
75
8. 3
2 p.p.m./year
9. 4,
256
1
1 32
11. a 1, b 1
Technology Extension
3
b. i) 6 ii) 3 iii) 32 iv) 6 v) 4 vi) 4 vii) 6 viii) 1
Review Exercise
1
4
2. a. 4x 5 b. c.
(4 x)2
1
4
3. a. 2x 5 b. 3x2 c. 4x
y
x
2
x6
28
1
d. 20x5 e.
3x5 f. (x 3)2
1
7x 2
2x
12x
j.
g.
(x2 5)2 h. (3 x2)3 i. 2
2x
7x2
4x 1
4
6x
k. 60x3(5x4 )2 l. x
5
7
2
5(x3 4) 5
32
4
x
5
2x
3x
2
2
4. a. x
b.
e.
3
2 (7x 3) c. x2x d.
(3x 5)2
x3
3x 1
x
1
f. g.
h.
i. 1, x 4
3
2
x1
x2 9
3x (
x
2)5
j. 2x 6
2x2 1
(2x 5)3(2x 23)
5. a. 20x3(x 1)(2x 6)5 b.
c.
2
(x 1)4
x 1
318(10x
1)5
12x(x2
1)2
15
1
3
d.
e.
f.
4
(3x 5)7
(x2 1)4 g. 2
3(x2 5) 3
(x 1) 2
x2
x
x
16x3 14x
5(x2 6)4(3x2 8x 18)
4x5 1
8x 8
d.
e.
3
2
2 f.
(3x 4)6
x5
x 5
9. 2 23, 5, 1
3
10. a. i. 2, 0 ii. 0, 1,
3
11. a. 160x y 16 0 b. 60x y 61 0
12. 5x y 7 0
13. (2, 8), b 8
3. y 2x3 3x2 24
4. a. x2 x 2 b. 3x2 13x 50, R: 153
c. x2 x 5, R: 5x 4
5. 27
6. 6
7. 3
8. (x 2) is a factor.
9. (x 3) and (x 1)
10. a. (x 4)(x 2)(x 5) b. (x 2)(x 2)(x 5)
c. (2x 1)(x 2)(x 2) d. (5x 2)(x2 2x 5)
1
11. a. 1, 2, 2 b. 2, 2, 3i, 3i c. 1, 2, 3 d. 1, 1, 2
1
1
3i
e. 1, 1, 3 f. 3, 2
5
12. 4, 2
13. x2 77x 4 0
14. a. 2 x 3 b. 2 x 1, x
3
15. a. 3 x 7
17
b. 1 x 4 c. x 5 or x 3
16. a. 13 m/s b. 15 m/s
17. 5
18. a. 3 b. 1 c. 3 d. 2 e. No.
19. Answers will vary.
20. at x 2
21. 2
22. x3
ANSWERS
469
23. a.
24. a.
25. a.
d.
5 b. does not exist c. 9 d. 2 e. 1
2 f. 4
6x 1 b. x2
1
8x 5 b. 3x2(2x3 1) 2 c. 6(x 3)2
4x(x2 3)(4x5 5x 1) (20x4 5)(x2 3)2
ii) 1 t 3, 7 t 9 iii) 3 t 7
5. v(t) t2 4t 3, a(t) 2t 4, direction changes at t 3
and t 1 returns to original position at t 3
6. a. positive at t 1, negative at t 4
b. neither at t 1, positive at t 4
c. negative at t 1, positive at t 4
7. a. 2t 6 b. 3 s
8. a. t 4 b. 80 m
9. a. 3 m/s b. 2 m/s2
35
28.
(x3 2)2 (x3 2) 5
(x3 2)2
18
29. 3
30. a. 4t 6 b. 46 people/year c. 2002
C H A P T E R 5 A P P L I C AT I O N S O F
D E R I VAT I V E S
Review of Prerequisite Skills
14
1
5. a. 5 b. 13 c. 3, 1 d. 2, 3 e. 2, 6 f. 3, 0, 1 g. 0, 4
h.
6. a.
7. a.
8. a.
c.
9. a.
b.
1 1
500010
d. r 510
cm, V
cm3
3
9
13x
2y x2
2x
i. j.
k. , y 0
g.
2y 5
48y h. 6xy2
y2 2x
x
3x2y y3
y
1
n. o.
l.
1 5y4 m.
3y2 x3
x
x
3. a. 2x 3y 13 0 b. 2x 3y 25 0
c. 33x 5y 15 0 d. 11x 10y 81 0
4. (0, 1)
35
35
5. a. 1 b.
5,
5
5 ,
5 ,
6. 10
7. 7x y 11 0
8. x 2y 3 0
3x2
8xy
9. a.
4x2 3
10. a. 1 b. 1 c. 1 d. 2
12. x 4 0, 2x 3y 10 0
15. x2 y2 8x 2y 1 0, x2 y2 4x 10y 11 0
Exercise 5.2
1 3
2. a. 90x8 90x4 b. 4x 2 c. 2
3. a. v(t) 10t 3, a(t) 10 b. v(t) 6t2 3b, a(t) 12t
c. v(t) 1 6t2, a(t) 12t3 d. v(t) 2t 6, a(t) 2
1
1
3
27
54
f. v(t)
(t 3)2 , a(t) (t 3)3
4. a. i) t 3 ii) 1 t 3 iii) 3 t 5 b. i) t 3, t 7
470 A N S W E R S
3
5
105
1
35
3
7. km/h
4
8. 9 m/s
9. 8 m/min
10. 214 m/s
13 km/h
11. 5
1
12. a.
72 cm/s b. 0.01 cm/s c. 0.04 cm/s
1
13.
2 m/min, 94 min
15. 0.46 m3/a
2
16. cm/min
53
17. V s2 (s-side of triangle)
2
3
18.
4 m/min
y2
22. x2 y2 4, k2
(l k)2 1
23. 96 m/s
Exercise 5.4
1. a. Yes. The function is continuous.
b. No. There is a discontinuity at x 2.
c. No. The left side of the domain is not defined.
d. Yes. The function is continuous on the domain given.
2.
Absolute Maximum
Absolute Minimum
a.
8
12
b.
30
5
c.
d.
3. a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
f.
100
100
30
20
maximum 3 at x 0, minimum 1 at x 2
maximum 4 at x 0, minimum 0 at x 2
maximum 0 at x 0, 3, minimum 4 at x 1, 2
maximum 0 at x 0, minimum 20 at x 2
maximum 8 at x 1, minimum 3 at x 2
16
maximum 3 at x 4, minimum 0 at x 0
52
Exercise 5.5
1. L W 25 cm
2. If the perimeter is fixed, then the figure will be a square.
3. 300 m 150 m
4. L 82.4 cm, W 22.4 cm, h 8.8 cm
5. 10 cm 10 cm 10 cm
6. 100 cm2
7. a. r 5.4 cm, h 10.8 cm b. h:d 1:1
8. a. 15 cm2 b. 30 cm2 c. The largest area occurs when the
length and width are each equal to one-half of the sides adjacent
to the right angle.
9. a. AB 20 cm, BC AD 20 cm b. 153 104 cm3
10. a. h 1.085 m, equal sides 0.957 m b. Yes. All the wood
would be used for the outer frame.
11. t 0.36 h
50
14. a. r cm and no square b. r 7 cm, w 14 cm
17
15.
2
16. Both slopes
ab.
25
17. 2
43k
18.
9
3
Exercise 5.6
1. a. $1.80/L b. $1.07/L c. 5625 L
2. a. 15 terms b. 16 term/h c. 20 terms/h
3. a. t 1 min b. 1.5 d. maximum e. decreasing
4. h 15 000 m, C $6000/h
5. 375 m 250 m
6. W 24.0 m, L 40.8 m, h 20.4 m
7. r 43 mm, h 172 mm
8. 10 586 m south of the power plant
9. $22.50
10. 6 nautical miles/h
11. 139 km/h
3x2
2xy
1. a.
3 c.
5y4 b. x
3y2(x 1)2 d.
3x2 y4
2
5
3
5
y 5x 2
14x6y
, y 0 f.
e.
3
7y2 10x7
5
3x
5
2. a. 4 b. 0
4
3. 5, 5
4. f (x) 4x3 4x5, f (x) 12x2 20x6
5. 72x7 42x
1
1
7. v(t) 2t , a(t) 2 3
2t 3
(2t 3
)
10
1
3
18. a.
4 m/h b. 50 m/h
19. 2 cm2/s
20. 210
cm3/s
85
21.
5
1.
y 2x
2. 3x 4y 7 0
ANSWERS
471
3 2
2
2 1
25
2
x
b
3 12
4
3. a.
3y3 b. c. x d. x y e. 3 f 7
6. 1.6 cm2/min
6. a. x2 x x
9
7.
20 m/min
6. b. i) compressed by 2
ii) stretched by a factor of 2
c. vertical stretch by factor of 3
and shifted upwards 25 units
d. c 0, a reflection in the
x-axis
0 c 1, a compression of a
factor of c
c 1, a stretch of a factor of c
y1
y2
x
y3
y
y2
Exercise 6.1
1
100
1. a. 49 b. 0.16 c. 81 d. 125 e. 4 f. 64 g. 16 h. 1 i. 9
1
1
1
j. 1 k. 6561 l. 3 m. 2 n. 210
1024 o. 729
8
x
x
9a
5x
3 6
b
2. a. y2 b. x4y4 c. b
4 d.
gh2 e. x y f. c g. 2y6 h. 4y2
6
3
3
1
a b
8
b
i.
25x4y2 j. c3 k. a6 l. b
2
472 A N S W E R S
3p5 1
3t2 2
1
2
x 1
4x x
b.
c. x 3 d.
x2
(am)n
amn,
x
1
6
1
1
so 64 (82) 6 8 3 .
i)
ii)
a.
decreasing
0 b 1
iii)
iv)
b.
increasing
b1
v)
y
1
2
1
2
x 1, y
x 1, y 2
x 1, y 4
y 4x
c.
decreasing
0 b 1
d.
increasing
b1
y
1
3
1
3
x 1, y
x 1, y 3
y2
y3
x1
x 1, y 8
y 8x
1
8
y3
y1
(p q2)3
4 f.
5. a. 12 b. a b c. q d.
2x4 e.
t
p7
x 1, y
y1
7. a.
19
1
4
1
3
64
9
3. a. 2
5 b. 2 c. 27 d. 4
1
4. a. 2 b. 3 c. 2
7
x 1, y
1
5
1
9
5
2. a. x7 b. m2 c.
27b3 d. w e. 4
6. a.
x y
Exercise 6.2
1.
3a b
5
5. a.
a
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
f.
Function Is
y-intercept
y 5
increasing
y4
increasing
4
5
y0
decreasing
y2
decreasing
y 1
increasing
y1
decreasing
12. 5 h b. 320
14. a. 783 000 b. 2032
15. $1075
16. B
Exercise 6.5
1. b. y 996.987(1.143)x c. 3794 d. 17 h 15 min
2. a. y 0.660(1.462)x b. 6.45 billion c. 2061
3. a. y 283.843(1.032)x b. 317 348 c. 2062
4. a. y 9.277(2.539)x b. 105 c. 1977
5. Answers will vary.
6. graphing, finite differences
1
2
6. $10 330
7. 2729
8. 3.5 min
9. a. y .660(1.462)x b. 43 billion c. 4.65 m2/person
d. Answers will vary.
10. a. f(x) 2x 3
9
1
1
25
2. a. 8 b. 2
5 c. 2 d. 8
1
5
3
4. a. 1 x 1 x or x2(x 5)(x 3) b. x 2 (1 x)(1 x)
1
1
4
3
c. x3(x 4)(x 3) or x 1 x (1 x) d. x 2 (x 5)(x 5)
1 x
5. a. y 8x b. y 3
asymptote:
y = 5
72
1
1. a. 1
7 b. 6 c. 27 d. 400
1
y-intercept
of 3
Review Exercise
1 2
2
4
6
1 2
1
2. a. 53 125 b. 70 1 c. 52 2
5 d. 7 7 e. 3 9
3
2
f. 9 27
3. a. 1.5682 b. 0.6198 c. 3 d. 1.7160 e. 0.1303 f. 4.7214
4.
5.
y = 5x
y = 5x
y = log5x
y=3
8. 1 638 400
9. 8 days
10. a. y 29040.595(1.0108)x b. 34 487
c. 2011 11. a. i) 0.8 million/year ii) 3.79 million/year
iii) fivefold increase b. i) 0.38 million/year
ii) 2.77 million/year iii) sevenfold increase
Chapter 6 Test
5
1
1. a. 8 b. 25 c. 8 d. 16 e. 6 f. 5
y = log 1 x
5
5
1
3
12
4
7. a. 0 b. c. d. e. f.
2
2
4
5
3
1
8. a. 125 b. 16 c. 3 d. 3 e. f. 16
3
10.
2
5
4
y
8
1
1
1
2
6. a. 3 b. 2 c. 4 d. 2 e. 3 f. 3 g. h. 4 i.
1
2
3. x 4
4. positive, b 1, increases; 0 b 1, decreases; b 1,
constant
y = 3x + 3x
2
x
4
11. 23
ANSWERS
473
Exercise 7.2
1. a. logax logay b. logmp logmq
2. a. loga(xw) b. loga(sr)
3. a. logbx logby b. logar logas
1
3
4. a. 4log613 b. 2log51.3 c. log7x d. loga6
3
4
5. a. logbx logby logbz b. logax logay logaz
6.
y
c)
b)
5
4
3
2
1
a)
d)
1
7.
6
5
4
3
2
1
9 x
c)
b)
Exercise 7.4
2. 10 times
3. 60 dB
4. 5.06
5. 100 times
6. 40 000 times
7. a. 5 times
8. 5 times
9. 32 000 times
10. 10 000
11. 10 000
12. 13
13. 3.2 107 mol/L
14. 3.2 107 mol/L
Exercise 7.5
1. a. 1.892 b. 2.477 c. 0.656 d. 1.116
3. a.
b. y
y
1
a)
d)
1
x
1
8. a.
9. a.
10. a.
3 b. 5 c. 2 d. 2 e. 5 f. 3
1 b. 3 c. 2 d. 3 e. 4 f. 7 g. 3 h. 2 i. 3
2
4
1
3
logax logay b. logax logay logaw
2
11. a.
f.
12. a.
13. a.
h.
3
3
2
23
11
5
3
c. logax logay d. logax logay
8
3
4
4
xy
14. a. loga[
log5w3
5 2 ] b. log5
2
w
x4
y
12
474 A N S W E R S
c.
d.
y
2
2
x
1
x
2
11
3. a. 8 b. 2 c. 8 d. 3 or 2
4. twice as intense
5. 100 000 times
6. 2.4 106 mol/L
7. vertical stretch by a factor 2, translated 2 units up
8. a. 1.894 b. 2.202
Chapter 7 Test
1
2
1. a. 3 b. 3 c. 4 d. 4 e. t f. 3
2. a. 4 b. 2
3. vertically stretch by factor 2, translated 2 units up
4. a. 8 b. 4 c. 2 d. 3
5. Log of a negative number does not exist.
6. 16.87 h
7. 6.3 times
8. 1000 times
9. 4.90 109 mol/L
Cumulative ReviewChapters 57
x
5 2x
4x y
y2
d. e.
1. a. y b. 4
c.
f. 3
y
32y 4
x2
x2
2. a. 2x 3y 13 0 b. 27x 11y 59 0
c. x y 2 0 d. 25x 6y 37 0
12
4
3. a. 5x4 15x2 1; 20x3 30x b. x3 ; x
4
3
5
3
11. Radius is decreasing at
64 cm/min and surface area is
decreasing at
2.5cm2/min.
12.
10 m/h
15. a. 3 b. 1, 3 c. 9 d. 2, 3 e. 0 f. 0
16. a. 19 940 b. 80 000
17. 26
18. a. C(t) P(1.05)t, 0 t 10 b. $65.07 c. $24.95
19. a. V(t) 30 000(0.75)t, t
0 b. $16 875 c. 8 years
20. y 1200(0.6)t, 0 t 4
1
3
22. a. 2 b. 4 c. 5 d. 3 e. 3 f. 2 g. 1 h. 0.342
1
4
i. 2 j. 7 k.
l.
a
310
23. a. log 2 log 3 b. log x log y log z c. log 5
1
1
d. 2log(x 1) 2log(x 1)
e. 4[log(x2 4) 5logx] f. loga4 5
x3y2
x
x1
3
24. a. log
c. log
d. log
4
3 x b. log2z
x2 1
x5
e. 1.29 f. 3.91
25. a. 3.58 b. 0.63 c. 1.89 d. 0.6
24
26. a. 3 b. 2 c. 51 d. 10 e. 2 f. 1
1 g. 2.8 h. 1 i. 14
5
2
j. 10 , 10
27. a. 74 dB b. Yes. c. 1.0 107 W/m2 d. 0.1 W/m2
C H A P T E R 8 D E R I VAT I V E S O F
EXPONENTIAL AND LOGARITHMIC
FUNCTIONS
Review of Prerequisite Skills
1
1
9
1. a. 9 b. 4 c. 9 d. 4.
1
2. a. log5625 4 b. log41
6 2 c. logx3 3
d.
3. a.
4. a.
5. a.
Exercise 8.1
1. The graphs are identical.
2. The Power Rule is valid only when the function has the variable
x in the base and a constant for the exponent.
3. a. y 3e3x b. s 3e3t5 c. y 20e10t1 d. y 3e3x
2
1
e. y (2x 6)e56xx f. y 2e x x 2
2e2t
g. p (1 ew)ewe h. g(t)
(1 e2t)2
w
dN
x4
2x 1
2x
e. f (x) ex
f. h(t) 2tet 3et
t
Exercise 8.2
1. A natural logarithm has base e; a common logarithm has base 10.
n
100
10 000
100 000
109
2.
(n + n1)n
2.70481
2.71815
2.71827
2.7182818
5
1
x
5
3t
4t
2
1
3. a.
5x 8 b. x2 1 c. t d. 2(x 1) e. t3 2t2 5
2
2z
3
f.
2(z2 3z)
1 2 ln x
4. a. 1 ln x b. x
c. 1 d. x e. et t ln t
3
z
3(ln x)2
u
lnu
e
ze
e (t ln
t 1)
1
f.
h.
2 u u
t(ln t)2
ez zez g.
t
x 2x 1
i.
(x2 1)(x 1)
1
5. a. g(1) 2e b. f (5) 10 c. g(1) 2e 5.436563657. The
CALC button produces a value g(1) 5.43657, which is
accurate to only 4 decimal places. For f (5), the CALC button
produces in the first approximation x 5.042553 and
f (x) 0.0983198. The theoretical result is 0.1. The ZOOM
must be used to improve the accuracy.
6. a. 0 b. no solution c. 0,
e1
7. a. x 3y 1 0 c. The first approximation answer on a
window with domain 1 x 4 is y 0.31286x 0.31286.
This can be improved by using the ZOOM feature. Notice the
equation is not as easy to use as the theoretical result.
8. x 2y (2 ln 2 4) 0
9. a. (1, 0), (e1, e2) c. The theoretical approach gives more
accurate values in less time.
10. x 2y 2 ln 2 0
90
90
c. km/h/s d. 6.36 s
11. a. 90 km/h b.
3t 1
7
12. a. 4.2 b. 1.16
2
(2 ln 2)
b. 9
14. a.
2
ANSWERS
475
15. 2
16. b. S3 2.5, S4 2.6, S5 2.7083, S6 2.716, S7 2.71805
1
2
17. a. x b.
2x 1 c. 2x ln x x
Exercise 8.3
1. a. 3 ln 2(23x) b. ln 3.1(3.1x) 3x2 c. 3 ln 10(103t5)
2
3x 4x
d. ln 10(2n 6)(1056nn ) e.
ln 5(x3 2x2 10)
2
2t 3
t
f.
ln 10(1 x2) g. 2(ln 7)t(7 ) h. 2 ln 2(t2 3t)
2
i. 2(ln 3)x(3x
3)
x2
2t 1)
2 ln 5
ln 4
2
2
2. a. t2 b.
ln 3
x ln 2 [xlog2x(ln 2) 1] c.
2t(ln
3 [x ln 3 4]
t
d. 2t log10(1 t)
2x3
(1 t)ln 10 x e.
log(3x2)
2
x1
(x 1)1
f.
x ln 5
2
x1
5
1
3. a.
52 ln 2 b. 24 ln 2 ln 3
3ln 10
4. 4
5. a. y 20 ln 10
ln 10 x 10 520 ln 10 ln 10
7
2
0.3849
3
3
2
e1
1 ln 12
3
e
2
0
e
2e8
c.
d.
6 ln 10 ln 101 ln 99
2.810 08
3. a. 5 b. 20 c. (54.9, 10) e. P grows exponentially to point I,
then the growth rate decreases and the curve becomes concave
down.
476 A N S W E R S
(ln b ln a)
10. t
(b a)
x
2
4. a. 1001 b. 500
5. five hundred units
6. 0.61
3
7. at t 4h
8. 47.25% when t 0.46h
9. b. Growth rate in 1967 4.511 times growth rate in 1947.
c. Growth rate in 1967 is 7.5% of total invested.
d. total $59.537 billion, growth rate 4.4849 billion per
annum. e. $62.5 billion, error was 3.5% f. Total
$570.48959 billion and the rate of growth will be
$42.97498 billion.
Exercise 8.5
1) b. 152
10x (10
1. a.
x (321) c. t(1)
(e1)
x
d. ex
e
2 ln x
(x 1)(x
3)2 1 2 3
2. a. x x ln x b.
x 1 x 3 x 2
(x 2)3
ln x
x
1
c. x x
d. tt (1 ln t)
2x
x
4
3. a. 2ee b. e(e 2e1) c. 2
7
4. 32(1 2 ln2)x y 16(3 8 ln 2) 0
1
1
5. 3
6
1
6. (e, e e )
7. (1, 1) and (2, 4 4 ln 2)
32(1 ln 4)2
8.
(2 ln 4)
1
t t (1 ln t)
tt
t
9. a. v
a 4 (1 ln t)1 ln t 2t
2
1 ln t
1
b. t e and a e e 3)
10. e e
Review Exercise
2
3t
3x2 6
x6
3x 5x
1. a. 2e2x3 b.
t3 1 c. x3 3x2 6x d. (5 6x)e
2
x
e e
x
e
e.
ex ex f. (ln 2)e 2
x
2t3 ln (3t)
2 t4
x ln x 1 1
2. a. ex(x 1) b. e
x x x ln x 1 c.
4
t
2t
12
(x 2)(x
4) 1 5
x
2e
d.
(2x3 1)2 x 2 x 4 2x3 1
e. (et 1)2
5
x
f. ex
x2 3 e
x2 3
x2 3 ln
x
2x
[1 y(x y)exy]
30
g. x (2 ln 30 2 2 ln x) h.
[x(x y)exy 1]
3 23
3 23
3. a. 1 b.
,
3
3
1 10(ln 10)2
109 b. 0
4. a.
ln10
1
5. a. t b. 10e10x(10x 2)
6. (1 ln 4)x 8y (8 ln 4 4) 0
8. a. 7 b. 4, 4 c. 3, 0, 4
9. 3x y 2 ln 2 2 0
10. x 1
11. a. day 20 b. 42
12. 2.718 h
13. highest at 4 years, lowest at 0.368 years
14. a. c2 b. c1
0.10536
1
15. a. T (x) 10(0.9x)0.10536 x x2 b. 2.62
ln 2
16. a. 2 b. 2ln 2 1
1
8x
2x
2
d. 2(3e3x 3e3x) e.
(2x 1)ln 10 (12x 1)log10(2x 1)
3
x
3 ln(x 4)
x4
f.
x4
13
2. 1
4
3. 2
2xy 1 ln x
4.
3 x2
5. 1
6. 2, 1
7. x (1 28 ln 3)y (4 84 ln 3) 0
ln 2
8. b. 10 cm/s c. t k, a 5k cm/s2
9. a. $87.70 b. $9426.76
1 1
3
7
c. 4, 4e is local maximum d. 2, ln4 is local minimum
4.
x-Intercept
y-Intercept
0
a.
22, 22, 0
b.
0
0
c.
0
0
d.
none
ln 4
5. a. (0, 3) is a local minimum, tangent parallel to x-axis; (2, 27)
is a local maximum, tangent parallel to x-axis
b. (0, 0) is a local maximum, tangent parallel to t-axis;
x1
ANSWERS
477
4.
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
f.
5. a.
b.
c.
d.
7. a.
8. a.
b.
10. a.
Discontinuities
Vertical Asymptotes
x 5
x 5
x2
x2
t 3
t 3
x3
none
x ln 2
x ln 2
x0
no asymptotes
y 1 from below as x , from above as x
y 0 from above as x , from below as x
y 3 from above as t , from below as t
no horizontal asymptote
y 3x 7 b. y x 3 c. y x 2 d. y x 3
As x f(x) is above the line.
As x f(x) is below the line.
a
d
y c b. x c, c 0 and ax b k(cx d)
9
above d.
1000 , curve is below
5. b. i) 1 ii) 0, 2
6. For any y f(x)
(1) evaluate y f (x) and solve f (x) 0 to get at least one
solution, x1.
(2) evaluate y f (x) and calculate f (x1).
(3) if f (x1) 0, then curve is concave down; if f (x1) 0 then
curve is concave up.
7. Step 4: Determine the type of critical point by using either the
first derivative test or the second derivative test.
8. a. i) (2, 16), (0, 0) b. i) none c. i) none
3
3 102
102
d. i) , , ,
2
2
11. 6
4
12. inflection points are (0, 0), 2
a , 16a3
b
b4
Exercise 9.5
1
2. y 4x3 3x
7. a. y 1 as x , y 1 as x
3
3
b. y 2 as x , y 2 as x
Review Exercise
1
1. a. y nenx, y n2enx b. f (x)
2(x 4) ,
2et
2et(1 et)
1
t
d. g(t) 2 , g(t)
3
1t
2.
a.
b.
4. a.
b.
c.
(1 t2) 2
Increasing
Decreasing
Derivative 0
x 1
x1
x1
x 3 or x 7
1 x 3
x 1, x 7
or 3 x 1
or 3 x 7
(0, 20), is a local minimum; tangent is parallel to x-axis.
(3, 47) is a local maximum; tangent is parallel to x-axis.
(1, e2) is a local minimum; tangent is parallel to x-axis.
1, 12 is a local minimum; tangent is parallel to x-axis.
17
1 15
17
11
7. k 4
8. a. f(x) x3 3x2 2
10. k 3
Cumulative Review Chapters 39
1
1
1
1
1 1 1 1
1. a. 2 5, 2 52 , 2 53 , 2 54 , ... 2 b. 2, 6, 1
2 , 20 ; 0
1
2
1
2
1
1
x
2. a. 3 b. 2 c. 12 d. 5 e. 0 f. 4 g. 3 h. i. 2
2x
3. 3x2 10x 10
x4
4. a. 2t 10 b. x
3
478 A N S W E R S
d2S
f(x)
2(x 4)2 c. s (et 1)2 , s dt2 (et 1)3
34.
x4 4x3 18x2 15
4
b.
c. ew(2 w) d.
(x2 2x 5)2
(et et)2
1
x
t
e. e ln x x f. (1 ln t) e (1 t)
3x2 1
2x 1
2
6. a. (2t 5)e(t 5t) b.
x2 x 1 c. 2x32
3x2 1
2a 3bw
8. a. 2r(1 r ln 2) 2e2r(r2 r) b.
b2x
(2 3t) 2 (2 3t) 2
x(x 2y)
f.
(x2 y2)
9. e (1 22)x y 23e 0
x2)
11.
(y 3x)3
12. e
13. x y 12 0 or x y 12 0
14. 10x y 32 0 and 2x y 8 0
15. 6x 2y (2 ln 2 2) 0
16. a. 7 m b. 8.5 m/s, 9.3 m/s c. 1.5 m/s2, 0.4 m/s2 d. 10 m/s
17. a. 1 mm/s b. 0 c. 2 mm/s2
18. a. 112 mm2/s b. 56 mm/s2
33
19.
m/s
2
dr
dv
20. a. dt is rate of increase of volume; dt is rate of increase of
dh
5r3
radius; dt is rate of increase of height b. V 1
2
1
c.
9 cm/min
1
21. a
k(1 2ln v)
23. a. (3, 91), (2, 34); 2, 282 b. (0, 3.6); , 1,
5
3e3
3
3 27e3
2
c. , 2
e e , 2 d. 2 , 8 ; (0, 0),
e
3
1
2
3
2
26. 14 062.5 m2
27. r 4.3 cm, h 8.6 cm
28. r 6.8 cm, h 27.5 cm
29. a. h 140 2x b. V 101 629.5 cm3; x 46.7 cm,
h 46.6 cm
30. 4
31. a. 4000 b. 8 d. 6
32. f(x) 2x3 12x2 18x 15
x
1. a. r b. r c. x
3
2. a. 2 b. 4 c. 2 d. 6 e. 2
b
3. a. b b. a c. a d. a e. b f. b
12
11
4. a. cos
1
3 , tan
12
5
5
b. sin
3 , tan
2
2
1
c. sin
, cos
5
5
11
56
3. a. 6
5
5. c. 1 2 sin2A
3
1
3
1
1 3
3 1
7. a. b. c. d.
22
3 3
(3 3 3
)
, e 3 1
2
8
e. 2, 52e , (2, t2e ), (0, 0), 6, 56e ,
6, 56e f. (1, 10e1 2); (2, 20e2 2)
8
24. a. x 3, x 3, y 0; 0, 9 b. x 1, x 1, y 4x;
1
2
Exercise A1
2. a. sin R
22. 14:13
5
, 1
3
1
2
10. a. 1, 2 b. 1, 2, 2
e4
1 e4
Review Exercise
6xy
c.
A P P E N D I X A D E R I VAT I V E S O F
TRIGONOMETRIC FUNCTIONS
18
c.
d. ex 2ex e.
1
3
a2y
10(y2
Absolute Minimum
2
2
2
a bw
Absolute Maximum
82
1
93
d.
6.61
35. $1140
36. 8x y 38 0, 8x 7y 38 0
38. 901 800 m3/week
2
1
4
7
39. f(x) 9x3 3x2 3x 9
y exy
1
3
1
d. 3 2 t e(2tlnt) e.
r ln a r f. exy x
3
2y
g. x(a2 x2) 2 h.
2xy x
3
7. 4
a.
b.
3
2
22
22
22
3
cos x sin x
cos x sin x
cos x sin x
8. a. b. c.
2
2
2
d. sin x
15
22
230
1
15
7
9. a.
b.
c. 9 d.
12
12
8
3
ANSWERS
479
cos x
p. 2 q. 6x2 sec2x3 tan x3 r. 2ex cos x
(1 cos x)
3
1
2. a. y
2 2 x 3 b. y 1 2x 4 c. y 2x
3
d. y 3x 2 e. y
2 x 4
b.
c.
d.
sin y sin(x y)
e.
x cos y sin(x y)
5. csc x cot x; sec x tan x; csc2x
d
sin x
6. a. lim x
180 b. dx sin x 180 cos x
d co
sx
dx 180 sin x
A P P E N D I X B A N T I D E R I VAT I V E S
Exercise B1
3
1
1. a. 2x c b. 2x2 4x c c. x4 3x3 c d. 2ln x c
3
1
1
3
2
1
2
4
e. 2x 3x c f. x
2x2 3x3 c g. cos 2x c
3
1
2
h. 2ex c i. 9(x3 1) 2 c j. ln(sin x) c
3
3 4
3
2
2. a. 4x 12x x 5 b. 2x 2 cos x 1 c. 4x 4x 3 8
2
10
sin5 x
x3 1 3 f. 1
d. 3e3x 2 ln x 3e3 e. 3
5
3. 10 051
4. 200 min
5. a. 10e0.002t 9 cm b. 0.94 cm c. 52.7 years
6. 8.75 m
480 A N S W E R S
Exercise B3
1. a. 200e22t b. 416 c. 1.8 h
2. a. 150 000e0.026t b. 327 221
3. a. 200e0.005t b. 156 mg c. 738 days
4. 20 years
5. 14 296
25000
6.
1
6
3 ln 11 t
1 0.25e
7. 9.5 min
8. 8 min
3
5
2
2 4
2
4
(3t 1) 2 , (3t 1) 2 t
9
9 135
9
135
x0
Exercise A3
1. y x 2
3
d. sin (t) 1
y sin (xy)
1
2se
c 2x
3. a.
cos y b. 1 c. 3 sin 3y d.
1 x sin(xy)
2
Exercise B2
8 3
1
1. a. 3t 2 4 b. 3et ln(t 1) 1 c. 2t
t 1 2
HARCOURT MATHEMATICS 12
AUTHORS
Ronald Dunkley
Enzo Carli
Ronald Scoins
Ruth Malinowski
Dean Murray
Jeffrey Shifrin
Loraine Wilson
ISBN 0-7747-1454-9
HARCOURT MATHEMATICS 12
Advanced Functions and Introductory Calculus
EDITORS